]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
957009e4b34d6cb6ea5e71322a27ed2315ea52ac
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual.''
26 @end quotation
27 @end copying
28
29 @iftex
30 @iflatex
31 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33 \usepackage{pagestyle}
34 \usepackage{epsfig}
35 \usepackage{pixidx}
36 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39 \else
40 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
42 \pdfcompresslevel=9
43 \fi
44
45 \makeindex
46 \begin{document}
47
48 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
49 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
50 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58 \else
59 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60 \fi
61 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109 }
110
111 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114 {\mbox{}}
115 }
116
117 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118 \gnusdimen 0pt
119
120 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121 \gnuscleardoublepage
122 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123 \chapter{#2}
124 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126 \thispagestyle{empty}
127 \hspace*{-2cm}
128 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131 \end{picture}
132 \clearpage
133 }
134
135 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136 \begin{figure}
137 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138 #3
139 \end{picture}
140 \caption{#1}
141 \end{figure}
142 }
143
144 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164 \section{#1}
165 }
166
167 \newenvironment{codelist}%
168 {\begin{list}{}{
169 }
170 }{\end{list}}
171
172 \newenvironment{asislist}%
173 {\begin{list}{}{
174 }
175 }{\end{list}}
176
177 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178 {\begin{list}{}{
179 \labelwidth=0cm
180 }
181 }{\end{list}}
182
183 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184 {\begin{list}{}{
185 }
186 }{\end{list}}
187
188 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
189 {\begin{list}{}{
190 }
191 }{\end{list}}
192
193 \newenvironment{samplist}%
194 {\begin{list}{}{
195 }
196 }{\end{list}}
197
198 \newenvironment{varlist}%
199 {\begin{list}{}{
200 }
201 }{\end{list}}
202
203 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
204 {\begin{list}{}{
205 }
206 }{\end{list}}
207
208 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213 {
214 {
215 \ifodd\count0
216 {
217 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218 }
219 \else
220 {
221 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222 }
223 }
224 \fi
225 }
226 }
227 {
228 \ifodd\count0
229 \mbox{} \hfill
230 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231 \else
232 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233 \hfill \mbox{}
234 \fi
235 }
236
237 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238 {
239 {
240 \ifodd\count0
241 {
242 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243 }
244 \else
245 {
246 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247 }
248 \fi
249 }
250 }
251 {
252 \ifodd\count0
253 \mbox{} \hfill
254 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255 \else
256 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257 \hfill \mbox{}
258 \fi
259 }
260
261 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
262 {
263 {
264 \ifodd\count0
265 {
266 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267 }
268 \else
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271 }
272 \fi
273 }
274 }
275 {
276 \ifodd\count0
277 \mbox{} \hfill
278 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279 \else
280 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281 \hfill \mbox{}
282 \fi
283 }
284
285 \pagenumbering{roman}
286 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288 @end iflatex
289 @end iftex
290
291 @iftex
292 @iflatex
293
294 \begin{titlepage}
295 {
296
297 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299 \parindent=0cm
300 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304 \vfill
305 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306 \vfill
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309 \newpage
310 }
311
312 \mbox{}
313 \vfill
314
315 \thispagestyle{empty}
316
317 @c @insertcopying
318 \newpage
319 \end{titlepage}
320 @end iflatex
321 @end iftex
322
323 @dircategory Emacs network features
324 @direntry
325 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
326 @end direntry
327 @iftex
328 @finalout
329 @end iftex
330
331
332 @titlepage
333 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335 @end ifset
336 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
337 @title Gnus Manual
338 @end ifclear
339
340 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341 @page
342 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343 @insertcopying
344 @end titlepage
345
346 @summarycontents
347 @contents
348
349 @node Top
350 @top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352 @ifinfo
353
354 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357 luck.
358
359 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
360 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
361
362 @ifnottex
363 @insertcopying
364 @end ifnottex
365
366 @end ifinfo
367
368 @iftex
369
370 @iflatex
371 \tableofcontents
372 \gnuscleardoublepage
373 @end iflatex
374
375 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379 being accused of plagiarism:
380
381 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384 can even read news with it!
385
386 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391 the program.
392
393 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
394 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
395
396 @heading Other related manuals
397 @itemize
398 @item Message manual: Composing messages
399 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
401 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
402 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
403 @end itemize
404
405 @end iftex
406
407 @menu
408 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
415 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
416 * Various:: General purpose settings.
417 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421 * Key Index:: Key Index.
422
423 Other related manuals
424
425 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
426 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
427 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
428 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
429 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
430
431 @detailmenu
432 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
433
434 Starting Gnus
435
436 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
437 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
438 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
439 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
440 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
441 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
442 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
443 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
444 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
445 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
446
447 New Groups
448
449 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
450 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
451 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
452
453 Group Buffer
454
455 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
456 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
457 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
458 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
459 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
460 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
461 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
462 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
463 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
464 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
465 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
466 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
467 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
468 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
469 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
470 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
471 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
472 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
473
474 Group Buffer Format
475
476 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
477 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
478 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
479
480 Group Topics
481
482 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
483 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
484 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
485 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
486 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
487
488 Misc Group Stuff
489
490 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
491 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
492 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
493 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
494 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
495
496 Summary Buffer
497
498 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
499 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
500 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
501 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
502 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
503 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
504 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
505 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
506 * Threading:: How threads are made.
507 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
508 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
509 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
510 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
511 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
512 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
513 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
514 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
515 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
516 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
517 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
518 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
519 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
520 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
521 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
522 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
523 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
524 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
525 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
526 or reselecting the current group.
527 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
528 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
529 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
530 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
531
532 Summary Buffer Format
533
534 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
535 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
536 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
537 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
538
539 Choosing Articles
540
541 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
542 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
543
544 Reply, Followup and Post
545
546 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
547 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
548 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
549 * Canceling and Superseding::
550
551 Marking Articles
552
553 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
554 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
555 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
556 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
557 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
558 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
559
560 Threading
561
562 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
563 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
564
565 Customizing Threading
566
567 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
568 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
569 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
570 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
571
572 Decoding Articles
573
574 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
575 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
576 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
577 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
578 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
579 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
580
581 Decoding Variables
582
583 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
584 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
585 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
586
587 Article Treatment
588
589 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
590 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
591 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
592 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
593 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
594 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
595 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
596 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
597 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
598 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
599 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
600
601 Alternative Approaches
602
603 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
604 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
605
606 Various Summary Stuff
607
608 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
609 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
610 * Summary Generation Commands::
611 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
612
613 Article Buffer
614
615 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
616 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
617 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
618 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
619 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
620
621 Composing Messages
622
623 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
624 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
625 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
626 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
627 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
628 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
629 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
630 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
631 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
632
633 Select Methods
634
635 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
636 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
637 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
638 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
639 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
640 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
641 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
642 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
643 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
644
645 Server Buffer
646
647 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
648 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
649 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
650 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
651 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
652 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
653 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
654
655 Getting News
656
657 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
658 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
659
660 @acronym{NNTP}
661
662 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
663 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
664 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
665
666 Getting Mail
667
668 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
669 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
670 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
671 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
672 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
673 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
674 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
675 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
676 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
677 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
678 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
679 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
680 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
681
682 Mail Sources
683
684 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
685 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
686 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
687
688 Choosing a Mail Back End
689
690 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
691 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
692 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
693 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
694 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
695 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
696 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
697
698 Browsing the Web
699
700 * Archiving Mail::
701 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
702 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
703 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
704
705 Other Sources
706
707 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
708 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
709 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
710 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
711 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
712
713 Document Groups
714
715 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
716
717 Combined Groups
718
719 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
720
721 Email Based Diary
722
723 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
724 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
725 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
726
727 The NNDiary Back End
728
729 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
730 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
731 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
732
733 The Gnus Diary Library
734
735 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
736 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
737 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
738 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
739
740 Gnus Unplugged
741
742 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
743 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
744 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
745 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
746 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
747 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
748 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
749 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
750 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
751 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
752 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
753 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
754 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
755 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
756
757 Agent Categories
758
759 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
760 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
761 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
762
763 Agent Commands
764
765 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
766 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
767 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
768
769 Scoring
770
771 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
772 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
773 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
774 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
775 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
776 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
777 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
778 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
779 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
780 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
781 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
782 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
783 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
784 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
785 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
786 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
787
788 Advanced Scoring
789
790 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
791 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
792 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
793
794 Searching
795
796 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
797 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
798
799 nnir
800
801 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
802 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
803 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
804
805 Setting up nnir
806
807 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
808
809 Various
810
811 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
812 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
813 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
814 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
815 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
816 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
817 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
818 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
819 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
820 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
821 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
822 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
823 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
824 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
825 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
826 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
827 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
828 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
829 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
830
831 Formatting Variables
832
833 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
834 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
835 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
836 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
837 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
838 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
839 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
840 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
841
842 Image Enhancements
843
844 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
845 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
846 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
847 meant to be shown.
848 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
849 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
850 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
851
852 Thwarting Email Spam
853
854 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
855 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
856 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
857 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
858
859 Spam Package
860
861 * Spam Package Introduction::
862 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
863 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
864 * Spam and Ham Processors::
865 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
866 * Spam Back Ends::
867 * Extending the Spam package::
868 * Spam Statistics Package::
869
870 Spam Statistics Package
871
872 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
873 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
874 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
875
876 Appendices
877
878 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
879 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
880 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
881 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
882 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
883 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
884 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
885 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
886 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
887
888 History
889
890 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
891 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
892 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
893 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
894 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
895 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
896 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
897 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
898
899 New Features
900
901 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
902 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
903 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
904 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
905 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
906 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
907 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
908 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
909
910 Customization
911
912 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
913 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
914 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
915 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
916
917 Gnus Reference Guide
918
919 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
920 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
921 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
922 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
923 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
924 * Group Info:: The group info format.
925 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
926 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
927 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
928
929 Back End Interface
930
931 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
932 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
933 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
934 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
935 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
936 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
937
938 Various File Formats
939
940 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
941 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
942
943 Emacs for Heathens
944
945 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
946 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
947
948 @end detailmenu
949 @end menu
950
951 @node Starting Up
952 @chapter Starting Gnus
953 @cindex starting up
954
955 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
956 Heathens} first.
957
958 @kindex M-x gnus
959 @findex gnus
960 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
961 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
962 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
963 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
964 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
965 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
966
967 @findex gnus-other-frame
968 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
969 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
970 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
971
972 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
973 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
974 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
975
976 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
977 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
978
979 @menu
980 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
981 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
982 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
983 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
984 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
985 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
986 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
987 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
988 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
989 @end menu
990
991
992 @node Finding the News
993 @section Finding the News
994 @cindex finding news
995
996 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
997 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
998 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
999 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1000 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1001 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1002 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1003 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1004
1005 @vindex gnus-select-method
1006 @c @head
1007 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1008 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1009 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1010 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1011 secondary or foreign groups.
1012
1013 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1014 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1015
1016 @lisp
1017 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1018 @end lisp
1019
1020 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1021
1022 @lisp
1023 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1024 @end lisp
1025
1026 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1027 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1028 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1029 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1030
1031 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1032 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1033 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1034 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1035 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1036 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1037 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1038 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1039 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1040
1041 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1042 @kindex B (Group)
1043 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1044 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1045 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1046 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1047 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1048 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1049
1050 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1051 @c @head
1052 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1053 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1054 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1055 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1056 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1057 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1058 groups are.
1059
1060 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1061 you would typically set this variable to
1062
1063 @lisp
1064 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1065 @end lisp
1066
1067
1068
1069 @node The Server is Down
1070 @section The Server is Down
1071 @cindex server errors
1072
1073 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1074 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1075 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1076
1077 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1078 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1079 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1080 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1081 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1082 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1083 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1084
1085 @findex gnus-no-server
1086 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1087 @c @head
1088 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1089 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1090 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1091 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1092 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1093 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1094 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1095
1096
1097 @node Slave Gnusae
1098 @section Slave Gnusae
1099 @cindex slave
1100
1101 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1102 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1103 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1104 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1105
1106 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1107 @file{.newsrc} file.
1108
1109 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1110 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1111 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1112 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1113 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1114 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1115 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1116
1117 @findex gnus-slave
1118 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1119 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1120 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1121 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1122 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1123 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1124 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1125 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1126
1127 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1128 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1129
1130 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1131 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1132 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1133 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1134 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1135
1136
1137
1138 @node New Groups
1139 @section New Groups
1140 @cindex new groups
1141 @cindex subscription
1142
1143 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1144 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1145 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1146 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1147 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1148 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1149 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1150 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1151 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1152
1153 @menu
1154 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1155 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1156 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1157 @end menu
1158
1159
1160 @node Checking New Groups
1161 @subsection Checking New Groups
1162
1163 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1164 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1165 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1166 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1167 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1168 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1169 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1170 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1171 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1172 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1173 command.
1174
1175 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1176 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1177 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1178 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1179 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1180 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1181 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1182 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1183 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1184 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1185 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1186
1187 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1188 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1189 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1190 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1191 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1192 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1193
1194
1195 @node Subscription Methods
1196 @subsection Subscription Methods
1197
1198 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1199 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1200 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1201
1202 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1203 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1204
1205 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1206
1207 @table @code
1208
1209 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1210 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1211 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1212 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1213 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1214 (with @kbd{u}).
1215
1216 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1217 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1218 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1219 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1220
1221 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1222 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1223 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1227 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1228 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1229 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1230 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1231 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1232 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1233 up. Or something like that.
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1237 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1238 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1239 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1243 Kill all new groups.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1247 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1248 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1249 topic parameter that looks like
1250
1251 @example
1252 "nnml"
1253 @end example
1254
1255 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1256 that topic.
1257
1258 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1259 top-level topic.
1260
1261 @end table
1262
1263 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1264 A closely related variable is
1265 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1266 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1267 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1268 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1269 hierarchy or not.
1270
1271 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1272 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1273 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1274 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1275
1276
1277 @node Filtering New Groups
1278 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1279
1280 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1281 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1282 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1283
1284 @example
1285 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1286 @end example
1287
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1289 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1290 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1291 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1292 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1293 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1294 subscribing these groups.
1295 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1296 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1297
1298 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1299 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1300 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1301
1302 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1303 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1304 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1305 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1306 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1307 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1308 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1309 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1310
1311 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1312 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1313 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1314 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1315 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1316 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1317 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1318 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1319 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1320 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1321 variable to @code{nil}.
1322
1323 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1324 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1325 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1326 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1327 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1328 should be subscribed automatically.
1329
1330 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1331 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1332
1333
1334 @node Changing Servers
1335 @section Changing Servers
1336 @cindex changing servers
1337
1338 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1339 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1340 very flaky and you want to use another.
1341
1342 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1343 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1344
1345 @emph{Wrong!}
1346
1347 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1348 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1349 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1350 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1351 worthless.
1352
1353 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1354 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1355 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1356 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1357 Use with caution.
1358
1359 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1360 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1361 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1362 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1363
1364 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1365 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1366 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1367 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1368 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1369 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1370 cache for all groups).
1371
1372
1373 @node Startup Files
1374 @section Startup Files
1375 @cindex startup files
1376 @cindex .newsrc
1377 @cindex .newsrc.el
1378 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1379
1380 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1381 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1382 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1383 read.
1384
1385 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1386 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1387 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1388 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1389 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1390 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1391 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1392
1393 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1394 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1395 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1396 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1397 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1398 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1399
1400 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1401 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1402 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1403 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1404 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1405 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1406 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1407 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1408 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1409 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1410 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1411 news reader.
1412
1413 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1414 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1415 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1416 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1417 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1418 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1419 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1420 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1421 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1422 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1423 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1424 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1425
1426 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1427 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1428 @vindex version-control
1429 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1430 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1431 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1432 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1433 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1434 @code{version-control} variable.
1435
1436 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1437 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1438 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1439 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1440 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1441 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1442 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1443 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1444 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1445 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1446
1447 @lisp
1448 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1449 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1450
1451 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1452 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1453 @end lisp
1454
1455 @vindex gnus-init-file
1456 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1457 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1458 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1459 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1460 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1461 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1462 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1463 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1464 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1465 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1466 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1467 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1468 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1469
1470
1471 @node Auto Save
1472 @section Auto Save
1473 @cindex dribble file
1474 @cindex auto-save
1475
1476 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1477 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1478 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1479 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1480 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1481 this file.
1482
1483 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1484 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1485 saved.
1486
1487 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1488 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1489 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1490
1491 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1492 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1493 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1494 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1495 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1496 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1497
1498 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1499 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1500 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1501
1502
1503 @node The Active File
1504 @section The Active File
1505 @cindex active file
1506 @cindex ignored groups
1507
1508 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1509 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1510 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1511
1512 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1513 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1514 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1515 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1516 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1517 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1518 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1519
1520 @c This variable is
1521 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1522 @c if you set it to anything else.
1523
1524 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1525 @c @head
1526 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1527 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1528 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1529
1530 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1531 you actually subscribe to.
1532
1533 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1534 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1535 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1536 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1537
1538 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1539 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1540 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1541 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1542 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1543 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1544
1545 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1546 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1547 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1548 variable.
1549
1550 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1551 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1552 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1553 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1554 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1555 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1556
1557 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1558 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1559
1560 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1561 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1562
1563 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1564 secondary select methods.
1565
1566
1567 @node Startup Variables
1568 @section Startup Variables
1569
1570 @table @code
1571
1572 @item gnus-load-hook
1573 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1574 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1575 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1576 times you start Gnus.
1577
1578 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1579 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1580 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1581
1582 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1583 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1584 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1585
1586 @item gnus-startup-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1588 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1589
1590 @item gnus-started-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1592 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1593 successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1597 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1598 generating the group buffer.
1599
1600 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1601 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1602 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1603 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1604 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1605 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1606 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1607 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1608
1609 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1610 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1611 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1612 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1613 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1614 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1615
1616 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1617 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1618 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1619
1620 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1621 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1622 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1623 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1624 group operation some.
1625
1626 @end table
1627
1628
1629 @node Group Buffer
1630 @chapter Group Buffer
1631 @cindex group buffer
1632
1633 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1634 @c
1635 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1636 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1637 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1638 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1639 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1640 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1641 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1642 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1643 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1644 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1645 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1646 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1647 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1648 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1649 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1650 @c human rights at 9...
1651
1652
1653 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1654 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1655 long as Gnus is active.
1656
1657 @iftex
1658 @iflatex
1659 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1660 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1661 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1662 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1663 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1664 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1665 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1666 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1667 }
1668 @end iflatex
1669 @end iftex
1670
1671 @menu
1672 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1673 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1674 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1675 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1676 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1677 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1678 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1679 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1680 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1681 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1682 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1683 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1684 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1685 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1686 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1687 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1688 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1689 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1690 @end menu
1691
1692
1693 @node Group Buffer Format
1694 @section Group Buffer Format
1695
1696 @menu
1697 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1698 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1699 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1700 @end menu
1701
1702 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1703 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1704 available in Emacs.
1705
1706 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1707 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1708 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1709 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1710 Emacs version.
1711
1712 @node Group Line Specification
1713 @subsection Group Line Specification
1714 @cindex group buffer format
1715
1716 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1717 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1718
1719 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1720
1721 @example
1722 25: news.announce.newusers
1723 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1724 @end example
1725
1726 Quite simple, huh?
1727
1728 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1729 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1730 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1731 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1732
1733 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1734 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1735 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1736 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1737 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1738 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1739
1740 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1741
1742 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1743 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1744 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1745 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1746 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1747
1748 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1749 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1750 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1751
1752 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1753
1754 @table @samp
1755
1756 @item M
1757 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1758
1759 @item S
1760 Whether the group is subscribed.
1761
1762 @item L
1763 Level of subscribedness.
1764
1765 @item N
1766 Number of unread articles.
1767
1768 @item I
1769 Number of dormant articles.
1770
1771 @item T
1772 Number of ticked articles.
1773
1774 @item R
1775 Number of read articles.
1776
1777 @item U
1778 Number of unseen articles.
1779
1780 @item t
1781 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1782 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1783
1784 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1785 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1786 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1787 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1788 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1789 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1790 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1791
1792 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1793 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1794 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1795 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1796 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1797 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1798 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1799
1800 @item y
1801 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item i
1804 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1805
1806 @item g
1807 Full group name.
1808
1809 @item G
1810 Group name.
1811
1812 @item C
1813 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1814 comment element in the group parameters.
1815
1816 @item D
1817 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1818 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1819 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1820 command.
1821
1822 @item o
1823 @samp{m} if moderated.
1824
1825 @item O
1826 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1827
1828 @item s
1829 Select method.
1830
1831 @item B
1832 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1833
1834 @item n
1835 Select from where.
1836
1837 @item z
1838 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1839 used.
1840
1841 @item P
1842 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1843
1844 @item c
1845 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1846 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1847 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1848 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1849 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1850
1851 @item m
1852 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1853 @cindex %
1854 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1855 the group lately.
1856
1857 @item p
1858 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1859
1860 @item d
1861 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1862 Timestamp}).
1863
1864 @item F
1865 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1866 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1867 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1868 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1869
1870 @item u
1871 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1872 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1873 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1874 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1875 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1876 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1877 specifier.
1878 @end table
1879
1880 @cindex *
1881 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1882 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1883 group, or a bogus native group.
1884
1885
1886 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1887 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1888 @cindex group mode line
1889
1890 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1891 The mode line can be changed by setting
1892 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1893 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1894
1895 @table @samp
1896 @item S
1897 The native news server.
1898 @item M
1899 The native select method.
1900 @end table
1901
1902
1903 @node Group Highlighting
1904 @subsection Group Highlighting
1905 @cindex highlighting
1906 @cindex group highlighting
1907
1908 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1909 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1910 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1911 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1912 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1913
1914 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1915 background is dark:
1916
1917 @lisp
1918 (cond (window-system
1919 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1920 (defface my-group-face-1
1921 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1922 (defface my-group-face-2
1923 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1924 "Second group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-3
1926 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-4
1928 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-5
1930 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1931
1932 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1933 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1934 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1935 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1936 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1937 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1938 @end lisp
1939
1940 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1941
1942 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1943 include:
1944
1945 @table @code
1946 @item group
1947 The group name.
1948 @item unread
1949 The number of unread articles in the group.
1950 @item method
1951 The select method.
1952 @item mailp
1953 Whether the group is a mail group.
1954 @item level
1955 The level of the group.
1956 @item score
1957 The score of the group.
1958 @item ticked
1959 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1960 @item total
1961 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1962 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1963 @item topic
1964 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1965 topic being inserted.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1969 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1970 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1971
1972 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1973 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1974 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1975 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1976
1977
1978 @node Group Maneuvering
1979 @section Group Maneuvering
1980 @cindex group movement
1981
1982 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1983 expected, hopefully.
1984
1985 @table @kbd
1986
1987 @item n
1988 @kindex n (Group)
1989 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1990 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1991 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1992
1993 @item p
1994 @itemx DEL
1995 @kindex DEL (Group)
1996 @kindex p (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1998 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1999 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2000
2001 @item N
2002 @kindex N (Group)
2003 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2004 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2005
2006 @item P
2007 @kindex P (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2009 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2010
2011 @item M-n
2012 @kindex M-n (Group)
2013 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2014 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2015 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2016
2017 @item M-p
2018 @kindex M-p (Group)
2019 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2020 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2021 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2022 @end table
2023
2024 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2025
2026 @table @kbd
2027
2028 @item j
2029 @kindex j (Group)
2030 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2031 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2032 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2033 like living groups.
2034
2035 @item ,
2036 @kindex , (Group)
2037 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2038 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2039 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2040
2041 @item .
2042 @kindex . (Group)
2043 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2044 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2045 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2046 @end table
2047
2048 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2049 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2050 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2051 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2052 is @code{t}.
2053
2054 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2055 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2056 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2057 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2058 @code{t}.
2059
2060 @node Selecting a Group
2061 @section Selecting a Group
2062 @cindex group selection
2063
2064 @table @kbd
2065
2066 @item SPACE
2067 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2068 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2069 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2070 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2071 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2072 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2073 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2074 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2075 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2076 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2077
2078 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2079 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2080 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2081
2082 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2083 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2084 ones.
2085
2086 @item RET
2087 @kindex RET (Group)
2088 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2089 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2090 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2091 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2092 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2093 entry.
2094
2095 @item M-RET
2096 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2097 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2098 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2099 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2100 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2101 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2102 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2103 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2104 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2105 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2106
2107 @item M-SPACE
2108 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2109 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2110 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2111 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2112 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2113
2114 @item C-M-RET
2115 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2116 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2117 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2118 doing any processing of its contents
2119 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2120 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2121 manner will have no permanent effects.
2122
2123 @end table
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2126 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2127 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2128 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2129 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2130 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2131 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2132 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2133 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2134 most recently will be fetched.
2135
2136 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2137 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2138 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2139 newsgroups.
2140
2141 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2142 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2143 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2144 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2145 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2146 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2147 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2148 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2149 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2150 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2151 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2152 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2153 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2154 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2155 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2156 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2157 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2158
2159 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2160 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2161 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2162 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2163 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2164 Which article this is controlled by the
2165 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2166 variable are:
2167
2168 @table @code
2169
2170 @item unread
2171 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2172
2173 @item first
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2175
2176 @item unseen
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2178
2179 @item unseen-or-unread
2180 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2181 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2182 unread article.
2183
2184 @item best
2185 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2186
2187 @end table
2188
2189 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2190 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2191
2192 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2193 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2194 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2195 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2196 selected.
2197
2198
2199 @node Subscription Commands
2200 @section Subscription Commands
2201 @cindex subscription
2202
2203 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2204 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2205 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2206 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2207 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2208
2209 @table @kbd
2210
2211 @item S t
2212 @itemx u
2213 @kindex S t (Group)
2214 @kindex u (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2216 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2217 Toggle subscription to the current group
2218 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2219
2220 @item S s
2221 @itemx U
2222 @kindex S s (Group)
2223 @kindex U (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2225 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2226 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2227 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2228
2229 @item S k
2230 @itemx C-k
2231 @kindex S k (Group)
2232 @kindex C-k (Group)
2233 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2234 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2235 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2236
2237 @item S y
2238 @itemx C-y
2239 @kindex S y (Group)
2240 @kindex C-y (Group)
2241 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2242 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2243
2244 @item C-x C-t
2245 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2247 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2248 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2249 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2250
2251 @item S w
2252 @itemx C-w
2253 @kindex S w (Group)
2254 @kindex C-w (Group)
2255 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2256 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2257
2258 @item S z
2259 @kindex S z (Group)
2260 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2261 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2262
2263 @item S C-k
2264 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2265 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2266 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2267 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2268 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2269 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2270 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2271 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2272 @file{.newsrc} file.
2273
2274 @end table
2275
2276 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2277
2278
2279 @node Group Data
2280 @section Group Data
2281
2282 @table @kbd
2283
2284 @item c
2285 @kindex c (Group)
2286 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2287 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2288 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2289 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2290 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2291 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2292 the group buffer.
2293
2294 @item C
2295 @kindex C (Group)
2296 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2297 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2298 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2299
2300 @item M-c
2301 @kindex M-c (Group)
2302 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2303 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2304 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2305
2306 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2307 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2308 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2309 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2310 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2311 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2312 caution.
2313
2314 @end table
2315
2316
2317 @node Group Levels
2318 @section Group Levels
2319 @cindex group level
2320 @cindex level
2321
2322 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2323 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2324 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2325 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2326 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2327
2328 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2329
2330 @table @kbd
2331
2332 @item S l
2333 @kindex S l (Group)
2334 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2335 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2336 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2337 prompted for a level.
2338 @end table
2339
2340 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2341 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2342 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2343 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2344 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2345 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2346 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2347 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2348 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2349 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2350 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2351 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2352 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2353 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2354 reasons of efficiency.
2355
2356 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2357 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2358
2359 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2360 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2361 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2362 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2363 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2364 groups are hidden, in a way.
2365
2366 @cindex zombie groups
2367 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2368 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2369 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2370 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2371 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2372 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2373
2374 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2375 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2376 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2377 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2378 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2379 list of killed groups.)
2380
2381 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2382 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2383 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2384
2385 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2386 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2387 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2388 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2389 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2390 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2391 relevant valid ranges.
2392
2393 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2394 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2395 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2396 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2397 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2398 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2399 rest.
2400
2401 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2402 one with the best level.
2403
2404 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2405 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2406 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2407 by default.
2408 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2409 be called and the result will be used as value.
2410
2411
2412 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2413 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2414 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2415 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2416 listed.
2417
2418 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2419 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2420 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2421 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2422
2423 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2424 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2425 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2426 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2427 to 5. The default is 6.
2428
2429
2430 @node Group Score
2431 @section Group Score
2432 @cindex group score
2433 @cindex group rank
2434 @cindex rank
2435
2436 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2437 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2438 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2439 reason?
2440
2441 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2442 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2443 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2444 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2445 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2446 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2447 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2448 least significant part.))
2449
2450 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2451 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2452 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2453 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2454 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2455 action after each summary exit, you can add
2456 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2457 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2458 slow things down somewhat.
2459
2460
2461 @node Marking Groups
2462 @section Marking Groups
2463 @cindex marking groups
2464
2465 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2466 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2467 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2468 bidding on those groups.
2469
2470 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2471 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2472 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2473
2474 @table @kbd
2475
2476 @item #
2477 @kindex # (Group)
2478 @itemx M m
2479 @kindex M m (Group)
2480 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2481 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2482
2483 @item M-#
2484 @kindex M-# (Group)
2485 @itemx M u
2486 @kindex M u (Group)
2487 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2488 Remove the mark from the current group
2489 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2490
2491 @item M U
2492 @kindex M U (Group)
2493 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2494 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2495
2496 @item M w
2497 @kindex M w (Group)
2498 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2499 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2500
2501 @item M b
2502 @kindex M b (Group)
2503 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2504 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2505
2506 @item M r
2507 @kindex M r (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2509 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2510 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2511 @end table
2512
2513 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2514
2515 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2516 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2517 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2518 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2519 the command to be executed.
2520
2521
2522 @node Foreign Groups
2523 @section Foreign Groups
2524 @cindex foreign groups
2525
2526 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2527 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2528 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2529 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2530 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2531 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2532 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2533 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2534
2535 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2536 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2537 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2538 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2539 consulted.
2540
2541 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2542 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2543 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2544
2545 @table @kbd
2546
2547 @item G m
2548 @kindex G m (Group)
2549 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2550 @cindex making groups
2551 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2552 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2553 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2554
2555 @item G M
2556 @kindex G M (Group)
2557 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2558 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2559 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2560
2561 @item G r
2562 @kindex G r (Group)
2563 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2564 @cindex renaming groups
2565 Rename the current group to something else
2566 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2567 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2568 on some back ends.
2569
2570 @item G c
2571 @kindex G c (Group)
2572 @cindex customizing
2573 @findex gnus-group-customize
2574 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2575
2576 @item G e
2577 @kindex G e (Group)
2578 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2579 @cindex renaming groups
2580 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2581 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2582
2583 @item G p
2584 @kindex G p (Group)
2585 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2586 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2587 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2588
2589 @item G E
2590 @kindex G E (Group)
2591 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2592 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2593 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2594
2595 @item G d
2596 @kindex G d (Group)
2597 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2598 @cindex nndir
2599 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2600 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2601
2602 @item G h
2603 @kindex G h (Group)
2604 @cindex help group
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2606 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2607
2608 @item G D
2609 @kindex G D (Group)
2610 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2611 @cindex nneething
2612 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2613 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2614 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2615
2616 @item G f
2617 @kindex G f (Group)
2618 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2619 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2620 @cindex nndoc
2621 Make a group based on some file or other
2622 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2623 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2624 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2625 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2626 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2627 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2628 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2629 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2630 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2631
2632 @item G u
2633 @kindex G u (Group)
2634 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2635 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2636 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2637 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2638
2639 @item G w
2640 @kindex G w (Group)
2641 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2642 @cindex Google
2643 @cindex nnweb
2644 @cindex gmane
2645 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2646 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2647 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2648 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2649 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2650 @xref{Web Searches}.
2651
2652 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2653 to a particular group by using a match string like
2654 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2655
2656 @item G R
2657 @kindex G R (Group)
2658 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2659 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2660 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2661 @xref{RSS}.
2662
2663 @item G DEL
2664 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2665 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2666 This function will delete the current group
2667 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2668 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2669 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2670 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2671 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2672
2673 @item G V
2674 @kindex G V (Group)
2675 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2676 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2677 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2678
2679 @item G v
2680 @kindex G v (Group)
2681 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2682 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2683 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2684 @end table
2685
2686 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2687 methods.
2688
2689 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2690 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2691 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2692 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2693 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2694 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2695 newsgroups.
2696
2697
2698 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2699 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2700
2701 @table @code
2702 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2703 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2704 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2705 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2706 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2707 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2708 the article range.
2709
2710 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2711 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2712 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2713 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2714 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2715 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2716 @url{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2717 @url{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2718 @url{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2719 @url{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2720
2721 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2722 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2723 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2724 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2725 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2726
2727 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2728 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2729 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2730 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2731 @end table
2732
2733 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2734 Buttons}.
2735
2736 Here is an example:
2737 @lisp
2738 (require 'gnus-art)
2739 (add-to-list
2740 'gnus-button-alist
2741 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2742 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2743 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2744 @end lisp
2745
2746
2747 @node Group Parameters
2748 @section Group Parameters
2749 @cindex group parameters
2750
2751 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2752
2753 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2754 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2755 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2756 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2757 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2758 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2759 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2760
2761 Here's an example group parameter list:
2762
2763 @example
2764 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2765 (auto-expire . t))
2766 @end example
2767
2768 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2769 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2770 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2771 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2772
2773 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2774 is an alist of regexps and values.
2775
2776 The following group parameters can be used:
2777
2778 @table @code
2779 @item to-address
2780 @cindex to-address
2781 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2782
2783 @example
2784 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2785 @end example
2786
2787 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2788 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2789 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2790 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2791 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2792
2793 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2794 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2795 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2796 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2797 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2798 list address instead.
2799
2800 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2801
2802 @item to-list
2803 @cindex to-list
2804 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2805
2806 @example
2807 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2808 @end example
2809
2810 It is totally ignored
2811 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2812 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2813
2814 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2815 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2816 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2817 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2818 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2819
2820 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2821 @cindex mail list groups
2822 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2823 entering summary buffer.
2824
2825 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2826
2827 @anchor{subscribed}
2828 @item subscribed
2829 @cindex subscribed
2830 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2831 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2832 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2833 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2834 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2835 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2836 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2837 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2838
2839 @lisp
2840 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2841 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2842 @end lisp
2843
2844 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2845 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2846
2847 @item visible
2848 @cindex visible
2849 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2850 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2851 of whether it has any unread articles.
2852
2853 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2854 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2855
2856 @item broken-reply-to
2857 @cindex broken-reply-to
2858 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2859 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2860 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2861 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2862 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2863 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2864
2865 @item to-group
2866 @cindex to-group
2867 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2868 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2869
2870 @item newsgroup
2871 @cindex newsgroup
2872 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2873 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2874 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2875 news group.
2876
2877 @item gcc-self
2878 @cindex gcc-self
2879 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2880 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2881 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2882 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2883 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2884 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2885 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2886
2887 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2888 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2889 doesn't accept articles.
2890
2891 @item auto-expire
2892 @cindex auto-expire
2893 @cindex expiring mail
2894 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2895 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2896 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2897
2898 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2899
2900 @item total-expire
2901 @cindex total-expire
2902 @cindex expiring mail
2903 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2904 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2905 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2906 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2907 expiry.
2908
2909 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2910
2911 @item expiry-wait
2912 @cindex expiry-wait
2913 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2914 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2915 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2916 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2917 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2918 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2919 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2920
2921 @item expiry-target
2922 @cindex expiry-target
2923 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2924 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2925
2926 @item score-file
2927 @cindex score file group parameter
2928 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2929 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2930 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2931
2932 @item adapt-file
2933 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2934 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2935 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2936 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2937
2938 @item admin-address
2939 @cindex admin-address
2940 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2941 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2942 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2943 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2944
2945 @item display
2946 @cindex display
2947 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2948 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item all
2952 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2953
2954 @item an integer
2955 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2956 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2957
2958 @item default
2959 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2960 ticked articles.
2961
2962 @item an array
2963 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2964
2965 Here are some examples:
2966
2967 @table @code
2968 @item [unread]
2969 Display only unread articles.
2970
2971 @item [not expire]
2972 Display everything except expirable articles.
2973
2974 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2975 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2976 responded to.
2977 @end table
2978
2979 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2980 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2981 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2982 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2983 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2984
2985 @end table
2986
2987 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2988 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2989 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2990
2991 @item comment
2992 @cindex comment
2993 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2994 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2995 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2996
2997 @item charset
2998 @cindex charset
2999 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3000 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3001 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3002
3003 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3004
3005 @item ignored-charsets
3006 @cindex ignored-charset
3007 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3008 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3009 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3010
3011 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3012
3013 @item posting-style
3014 @cindex posting-style
3015 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3016 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3017 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3018 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3019 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3020
3021 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3022 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3023 like this in the group parameters:
3024
3025 @example
3026 (posting-style
3027 (name "Funky Name")
3028 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3029 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3030 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3031 @end example
3032
3033 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3034 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3035 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3036 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3037 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3038 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3039 to.
3040
3041
3042 @item post-method
3043 @cindex post-method
3044 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3045 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3046
3047 @item mail-source
3048 @cindex mail-source
3049 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3050 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3051 mail source for this group.
3052
3053 @item banner
3054 @cindex banner
3055 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3056 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3057 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3058 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3059 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3060
3061 @item sieve
3062 @cindex sieve
3063 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3064 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3065 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3066 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3067
3068 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3069 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3070 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3071 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3072
3073 @example
3074 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3075 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3076 @}
3077 @end example
3078
3079 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3080 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3081 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3082 like the following is generated:
3083
3084 @example
3085 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3086 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3087 @}
3088 @end example
3089
3090 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3091 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3092
3093 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3094 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3095
3096 @item (agent parameters)
3097 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3098 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3099 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3100 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3101 minimize the configuration effort.
3102
3103 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3104 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3105 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3106 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3107 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3108 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3109 @code{eval}ed there.
3110
3111 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3112 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3113 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3114 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3115 form needs to be set to it.
3116
3117 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3118 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3119 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3120 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3121 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3122 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3123 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3124
3125 @lisp
3126 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3127 @end lisp
3128
3129 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3130 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3131 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3132
3133 @example
3134 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3135 @end example
3136
3137 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3138 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3139 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3140 into the group parameters for the group.
3141
3142 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3143 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3144 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3145 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3146 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3147
3148 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3149 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3150 following is added to a group parameter
3151
3152 @lisp
3153 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3154 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3155 @end lisp
3156
3157 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3158 expired.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @vindex gnus-parameters
3163 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3164 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3165 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3166 For example:
3167
3168 @lisp
3169 (setq gnus-parameters
3170 '(("mail\\..*"
3171 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3172 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3173 (gnus-summary-line-format
3174 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3175 (gcc-self . t)
3176 (display . all))
3177
3178 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3179 (to-group . "\\1"))
3180
3181 ("mail\\.me"
3182 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3183
3184 ("list\\..*"
3185 (total-expire . t)
3186 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3187 @end lisp
3188
3189 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3190 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3191 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3192 override the first.
3193
3194 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3195 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3196
3197 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3198 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3199 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3200 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3201 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3202 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3203 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3204 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3205 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3206 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3207 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3208 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3209
3210 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3211 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3212 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3213 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3214 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3215 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3216 weekly news RSS feed
3217 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3218 @xref{RSS}.
3219
3220 @lisp
3221 (setq
3222 gnus-parameters
3223 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3224 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3225 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3226 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3227 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3228 ("nnrss.*debian"
3229 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3230 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3231 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3232 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3233 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3234 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3235 @end lisp
3236
3237
3238 @node Listing Groups
3239 @section Listing Groups
3240 @cindex group listing
3241
3242 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3243
3244 @table @kbd
3245
3246 @item l
3247 @itemx A s
3248 @kindex A s (Group)
3249 @kindex l (Group)
3250 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3251 List all groups that have unread articles
3252 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3253 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3254 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3255 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3256 groups).
3257
3258 @item L
3259 @itemx A u
3260 @kindex A u (Group)
3261 @kindex L (Group)
3262 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3263 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3264 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3265 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3266 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3267 unsubscribed groups).
3268
3269 @item A l
3270 @kindex A l (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3272 List all unread groups on a specific level
3273 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3274 with no unread articles.
3275
3276 @item A k
3277 @kindex A k (Group)
3278 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3279 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3280 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3281 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3282 from the server.
3283
3284 @item A z
3285 @kindex A z (Group)
3286 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3287 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3288
3289 @item A m
3290 @kindex A m (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3292 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3293 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3294
3295 @item A M
3296 @kindex A M (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3298 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3299
3300 @item A A
3301 @kindex A A (Group)
3302 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3303 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3304 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3305 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3306 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3307 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3308 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3309 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3310
3311 @item A a
3312 @kindex A a (Group)
3313 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3314 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3315 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3316
3317 @item A d
3318 @kindex A d (Group)
3319 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3320 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3321 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3322
3323 @item A c
3324 @kindex A c (Group)
3325 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3326 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3327
3328 @item A ?
3329 @kindex A ? (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3331 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3332
3333 @item A !
3334 @kindex A ! (Group)
3335 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3336 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3337
3338 @item A /
3339 @kindex A / (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3341 Further limit groups within the current selection
3342 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3343 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3344 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3345 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3346 articles.
3347
3348 @item A f
3349 @kindex A f (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3351 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3352
3353 @item A p
3354 @kindex A p (Group)
3355 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3356 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3361 @cindex visible group parameter
3362 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3363 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3364 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3365 get the same effect.
3366
3367 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3368 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3369 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3370 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3371 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3372
3373
3374 @node Sorting Groups
3375 @section Sorting Groups
3376 @cindex sorting groups
3377
3378 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3379 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3380 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3381 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3382 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3383 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3384 include:
3385
3386 @table @code
3387
3388 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3390 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3391
3392 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3394 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3395
3396 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3397 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3398 Sort by group level.
3399
3400 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3402 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3403
3404 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3405 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3406 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3407 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3408
3409 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3410 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3411 Sort by number of unread articles.
3412
3413 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3414 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3415 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3416
3417 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3418 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3419 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3420
3421
3422 @end table
3423
3424 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3425 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3426 the last one.
3427
3428
3429 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3430 some sorting criteria:
3431
3432 @table @kbd
3433 @item G S a
3434 @kindex G S a (Group)
3435 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3436 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3437 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3438
3439 @item G S u
3440 @kindex G S u (Group)
3441 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3442 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3443 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3444
3445 @item G S l
3446 @kindex G S l (Group)
3447 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3448 Sort the group buffer by group level
3449 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3450
3451 @item G S v
3452 @kindex G S v (Group)
3453 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3454 Sort the group buffer by group score
3455 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3456
3457 @item G S r
3458 @kindex G S r (Group)
3459 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3460 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3461 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3462
3463 @item G S m
3464 @kindex G S m (Group)
3465 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3466 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3467 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3468
3469 @item G S n
3470 @kindex G S n (Group)
3471 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3472 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3473 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3474
3475 @end table
3476
3477 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3478 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3479
3480 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3481 commands will sort in reverse order.
3482
3483 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3484
3485 @table @kbd
3486 @item G P a
3487 @kindex G P a (Group)
3488 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3489 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3490 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3491
3492 @item G P u
3493 @kindex G P u (Group)
3494 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3495 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3496 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3497
3498 @item G P l
3499 @kindex G P l (Group)
3500 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3501 Sort the groups by group level
3502 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3503
3504 @item G P v
3505 @kindex G P v (Group)
3506 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3507 Sort the groups by group score
3508 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3509
3510 @item G P r
3511 @kindex G P r (Group)
3512 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3513 Sort the groups by group rank
3514 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3515
3516 @item G P m
3517 @kindex G P m (Group)
3518 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3519 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3520 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3521
3522 @item G P n
3523 @kindex G P n (Group)
3524 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3525 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3526 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3527
3528 @item G P s
3529 @kindex G P s (Group)
3530 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3531 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3532
3533 @end table
3534
3535 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3536 move groups around.
3537
3538
3539 @node Group Maintenance
3540 @section Group Maintenance
3541 @cindex bogus groups
3542
3543 @table @kbd
3544 @item b
3545 @kindex b (Group)
3546 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3547 Find bogus groups and delete them
3548 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3549
3550 @item F
3551 @kindex F (Group)
3552 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3553 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3554 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3555 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3556 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3557 zombies.
3558
3559 @item C-c C-x
3560 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3561 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3562 @cindex expiring mail
3563 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3564 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3565 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3566 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3567
3568 @item C-c C-M-x
3569 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3570 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3571 @cindex expiring mail
3572 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3573 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3574
3575 @end table
3576
3577
3578 @node Browse Foreign Server
3579 @section Browse Foreign Server
3580 @cindex foreign servers
3581 @cindex browsing servers
3582
3583 @table @kbd
3584 @item B
3585 @kindex B (Group)
3586 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3587 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3588 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3589 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3590 @end table
3591
3592 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3593 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3594 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3595 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3596
3597 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3598
3599 @table @kbd
3600 @item n
3601 @kindex n (Browse)
3602 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3603 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3604
3605 @item p
3606 @kindex p (Browse)
3607 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3608 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3609
3610 @item SPACE
3611 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3612 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3613 Enter the current group and display the first article
3614 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3615
3616 @item RET
3617 @kindex RET (Browse)
3618 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3619 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3620
3621 @item u
3622 @kindex u (Browse)
3623 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3624 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3625 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3626 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3627 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3628 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3629 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3630
3631 @item l
3632 @itemx q
3633 @kindex q (Browse)
3634 @kindex l (Browse)
3635 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3636 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3637
3638 @item d
3639 @kindex d (Browse)
3640 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3641 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3642
3643 @item ?
3644 @kindex ? (Browse)
3645 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3646 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3647 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3648 @end table
3649
3650
3651 @node Exiting Gnus
3652 @section Exiting Gnus
3653 @cindex exiting Gnus
3654
3655 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3656
3657 @table @kbd
3658 @item z
3659 @kindex z (Group)
3660 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3661 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3662 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3663 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3664
3665 @item q
3666 @kindex q (Group)
3667 @findex gnus-group-exit
3668 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3669 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3670
3671 @item Q
3672 @kindex Q (Group)
3673 @findex gnus-group-quit
3674 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3675 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3679 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3680 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3681 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3682 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3683 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3684 exiting Gnus.
3685
3686 Note:
3687
3688 @quotation
3689 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3690 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3691 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3692 plastic chair.
3693 @end quotation
3694
3695
3696 @node Group Topics
3697 @section Group Topics
3698 @cindex topics
3699
3700 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3701 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3702 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3703 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3704 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3705 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3706
3707 @iftex
3708 @iflatex
3709 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3710 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3711 }
3712 @end iflatex
3713 @end iftex
3714
3715 Here's an example:
3716
3717 @example
3718 Gnus
3719 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3720 3: comp.emacs
3721 2: alt.religion.emacs
3722 Naughty Emacs
3723 452: alt.sex.emacs
3724 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3725 Misc
3726 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3727 13: comp.sources.unix
3728 @end example
3729
3730 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3731 @kindex t (Group)
3732 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3733 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3734 is a toggling command.)
3735
3736 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3737 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3738 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3739 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3740 Hot and bothered?
3741
3742 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3743 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3744 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3745
3746 @lisp
3747 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3748 @end lisp
3749
3750 @menu
3751 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3752 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3753 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3754 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3755 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3756 @end menu
3757
3758
3759 @node Topic Commands
3760 @subsection Topic Commands
3761 @cindex topic commands
3762
3763 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3764 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3765 definitions slightly.
3766
3767 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3768 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3769 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3770 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3771 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3772 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3773
3774 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3775 the way you like.
3776
3777 @table @kbd
3778
3779 @item T n
3780 @kindex T n (Topic)
3781 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3782 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3783 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3784
3785 @item T TAB
3786 @itemx TAB
3787 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3788 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3789 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3790 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3791 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3792 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3793
3794 @item M-TAB
3795 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3796 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3797 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3798 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3799
3800 @end table
3801
3802 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3803 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3804 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3805 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3806
3807 @table @kbd
3808
3809 @item C-k
3810 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3811 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3812 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3813 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3814
3815 @item C-y
3816 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3817 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3818 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3819 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3820 before all groups.
3821
3822 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3823 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3824 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3825 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3826 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3827
3828 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3829 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3830
3831 @end table
3832
3833 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3834 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3835 key.
3836
3837 @table @kbd
3838
3839 @item RET
3840 @kindex RET (Topic)
3841 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3842 @itemx SPACE
3843 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3844 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3845 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3846 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3847 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3848 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3849
3850 @end table
3851
3852 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3853
3854 @table @kbd
3855
3856 @item T m
3857 @kindex T m (Topic)
3858 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3859 Move the current group to some other topic
3860 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3861 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3862
3863 @item T j
3864 @kindex T j (Topic)
3865 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3866 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3867
3868 @item T c
3869 @kindex T c (Topic)
3870 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3871 Copy the current group to some other topic
3872 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3873 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3874
3875 @item T h
3876 @kindex T h (Topic)
3877 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3878 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3879 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3880
3881 @item T s
3882 @kindex T s (Topic)
3883 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3884 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3885 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3886
3887 @item T D
3888 @kindex T D (Topic)
3889 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3890 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3891 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3892 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3893 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3894 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3895 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3896 topic.
3897
3898 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3899 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3900
3901 @item T M
3902 @kindex T M (Topic)
3903 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3904 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3905 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3906
3907 @item T C
3908 @kindex T C (Topic)
3909 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3910 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3911 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3912
3913 @item T H
3914 @kindex T H (Topic)
3915 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3916 Toggle hiding empty topics
3917 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3918
3919 @item T #
3920 @kindex T # (Topic)
3921 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3922 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3923 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3924 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3925
3926 @item T M-#
3927 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3928 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3929 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3930 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3931 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3932
3933 @item C-c C-x
3934 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3935 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3936 @cindex expiring mail
3937 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3938 expiry process (if any)
3939 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3940
3941 @item T r
3942 @kindex T r (Topic)
3943 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3944 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3945
3946 @item T DEL
3947 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3948 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3949 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3950
3951 @item A T
3952 @kindex A T (Topic)
3953 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3954 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3955 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3956
3957 @item T M-n
3958 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3959 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3960 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3961
3962 @item T M-p
3963 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3964 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3965 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3966
3967 @item G p
3968 @kindex G p (Topic)
3969 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3970 @cindex group parameters
3971 @cindex topic parameters
3972 @cindex parameters
3973 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3974 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3975
3976 @end table
3977
3978
3979 @node Topic Variables
3980 @subsection Topic Variables
3981 @cindex topic variables
3982
3983 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3984 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3985
3986 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3987 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3988 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3989 Valid elements are:
3990
3991 @table @samp
3992 @item i
3993 Indentation.
3994 @item n
3995 Topic name.
3996 @item v
3997 Visibility.
3998 @item l
3999 Level.
4000 @item g
4001 Number of groups in the topic.
4002 @item a
4003 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4004 @item A
4005 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4006 @end table
4007
4008 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4009 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4010 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4011 The default is 2.
4012
4013 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4014 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4015
4016 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4017 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4018 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4019
4020
4021 @node Topic Sorting
4022 @subsection Topic Sorting
4023 @cindex topic sorting
4024
4025 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4026 commands:
4027
4028
4029 @table @kbd
4030 @item T S a
4031 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4032 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4033 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4034 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4035
4036 @item T S u
4037 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4038 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4039 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4040 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4041
4042 @item T S l
4043 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4044 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4045 Sort the current topic by group level
4046 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4047
4048 @item T S v
4049 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4050 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4051 Sort the current topic by group score
4052 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4053
4054 @item T S r
4055 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4056 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4057 Sort the current topic by group rank
4058 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4059
4060 @item T S m
4061 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4062 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4063 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4064 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4065
4066 @item T S e
4067 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4068 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4069 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4070 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4071
4072 @item T S s
4073 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4074 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4075 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4076 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4077 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4078
4079 @end table
4080
4081 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4082 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4083 sorting.
4084
4085
4086 @node Topic Topology
4087 @subsection Topic Topology
4088 @cindex topic topology
4089 @cindex topology
4090
4091 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4092
4093 @example
4094 @group
4095 Gnus
4096 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4097 3: comp.emacs
4098 2: alt.religion.emacs
4099 Naughty Emacs
4100 452: alt.sex.emacs
4101 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4102 Misc
4103 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4104 13: comp.sources.unix
4105 @end group
4106 @end example
4107
4108 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4109 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4110 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4111 follows:
4112
4113 @lisp
4114 (("Gnus" visible)
4115 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4116 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4117 (("Misc" visible)))
4118 @end lisp
4119
4120 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4121 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4122 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4123 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4124 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4125 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4126
4127 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4128 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4129 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4130
4131
4132 @node Topic Parameters
4133 @subsection Topic Parameters
4134 @cindex topic parameters
4135
4136 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4137 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4138 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4139 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4140 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4141
4142 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4143 parameters:
4144
4145 @table @code
4146 @item subscribe
4147 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4148 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4149 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4150 topic.
4151
4152 @item subscribe-level
4153 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4154 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4155 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4156
4157 @end table
4158
4159 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4160 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4161 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4162 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4163
4164 @example
4165 @group
4166 Gnus
4167 Emacs
4168 3: comp.emacs
4169 2: alt.religion.emacs
4170 452: alt.sex.emacs
4171 Relief
4172 452: alt.sex.emacs
4173 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4174 Misc
4175 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4176 13: comp.sources.unix
4177 452: alt.sex.emacs
4178 @end group
4179 @end example
4180
4181 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4182 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4183 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4184 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4185 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4186 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4187
4188 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4189 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4190 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4191 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4192 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4193
4194 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4195 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4196 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4197 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4198 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4199 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4200 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4201 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4202
4203
4204 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4205 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4206 @cindex non-ascii group names
4207
4208 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4209 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4210 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4211 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4212 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4213 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4214 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4215 back end.
4216
4217 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4218 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4219 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4220 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4221 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4222 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4223 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4224 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4225
4226 @table @code
4227 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4228 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4229 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4230 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4231 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4232
4233 @lisp
4234 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4235 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4236 @end lisp
4237
4238 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4239 ones specified for the same groups with the
4240 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4241
4242 A select method can be very long, like:
4243
4244 @lisp
4245 (nntp "gmane"
4246 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4247 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4248 (nntp-open-connection-function
4249 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4250 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4251 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4252 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4253 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4254 @end lisp
4255
4256 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4257 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4258 the server name.
4259
4260 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4261 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4262 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4263 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4264 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4265 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4266
4267 @lisp
4268 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4269 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4270 (".*" . utf-8)))
4271 @end lisp
4272
4273 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4274 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4275 @end table
4276
4277 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4278 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4279 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4280 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4281 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4282 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4283
4284 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4285 names:
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4289 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4290 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4291 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4292 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4293 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4294
4295 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4296 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4297 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4298 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4299 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4300
4301 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4302 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4303 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4304 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4305 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4306 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4307
4308 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4309 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4310 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4311 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4312
4313 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4314 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4315 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4316 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4317
4318 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4319 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4320 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4321 typical case where you have to customize
4322 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4323 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4324 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4325 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4326 @end table
4327
4328 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4329 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4330 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4331 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4332
4333
4334 @node Misc Group Stuff
4335 @section Misc Group Stuff
4336
4337 @menu
4338 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4339 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4340 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4341 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4342 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4343 @end menu
4344
4345 @table @kbd
4346
4347 @item v
4348 @kindex v (Group)
4349 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4350 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4351 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4352
4353 @lisp
4354 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4355 (lambda ()
4356 (interactive)
4357 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4358 @end lisp
4359
4360 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4361 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4362
4363 @item ^
4364 @kindex ^ (Group)
4365 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4366 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4367 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4368
4369 @item a
4370 @kindex a (Group)
4371 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4372 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4373 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4374 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4375 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4376 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4377 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4378
4379 @item m
4380 @kindex m (Group)
4381 @findex gnus-group-mail
4382 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4383 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4384 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4385 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4386
4387 @item i
4388 @kindex i (Group)
4389 @findex gnus-group-news
4390 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4391 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4392 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4393
4394 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4395 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4396 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4397 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4398 for this to work though.
4399
4400 @item G z
4401 @kindex G z (Group)
4402 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4403
4404 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4405 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4406 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4407 count.
4408
4409 @end table
4410
4411 Variables for the group buffer:
4412
4413 @table @code
4414
4415 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4416 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4417 is called after the group buffer has been
4418 created.
4419
4420 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4421 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4422 is called after the group buffer is
4423 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4424 unnatural way.
4425
4426 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4427 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4428 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4429 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4430
4431 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4432 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4433 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4434 whether they are empty or not.
4435
4436 @end table
4437
4438 @node Scanning New Messages
4439 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4440 @cindex new messages
4441 @cindex scanning new news
4442
4443 @table @kbd
4444
4445 @item g
4446 @kindex g (Group)
4447 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4448 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4449 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4450 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4451 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4452 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4453 back end(s).
4454
4455 @item M-g
4456 @kindex M-g (Group)
4457 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4458 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4459 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4460 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4461 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4462 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4463 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4464
4465 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4466 @cindex activating groups
4467 @item C-c M-g
4468 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4469 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4470
4471 @item R
4472 @kindex R (Group)
4473 @cindex restarting
4474 @findex gnus-group-restart
4475 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4476 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4477 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4478
4479 @end table
4480
4481 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4482 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4483
4484 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4485 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4486 news.
4487
4488
4489 @node Group Information
4490 @subsection Group Information
4491 @cindex group information
4492 @cindex information on groups
4493
4494 @table @kbd
4495
4496
4497 @item H d
4498 @itemx C-c C-d
4499 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4500 @kindex H d (Group)
4501 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4502 @cindex describing groups
4503 @cindex group description
4504 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4505 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4506 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4507
4508 @item M-d
4509 @kindex M-d (Group)
4510 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4511 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4512 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4513
4514 @item H v
4515 @itemx V
4516 @kindex V (Group)
4517 @kindex H v (Group)
4518 @cindex version
4519 @findex gnus-version
4520 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4521
4522 @item ?
4523 @kindex ? (Group)
4524 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4525 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4526
4527 @item C-c C-i
4528 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4529 @cindex info
4530 @cindex manual
4531 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4532 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4533 @end table
4534
4535
4536 @node Group Timestamp
4537 @subsection Group Timestamp
4538 @cindex timestamps
4539 @cindex group timestamps
4540
4541 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4542 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4543 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4544
4545 @lisp
4546 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4547 @end lisp
4548
4549 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4550
4551 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4552 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4553
4554 @lisp
4555 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4556 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4557 @end lisp
4558
4559 This will result in lines looking like:
4560
4561 @example
4562 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4563 0: custom 19961002T012713
4564 @end example
4565
4566 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4567 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4568 something like:
4569
4570 @lisp
4571 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4572 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4573 @end lisp
4574
4575 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4576 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4577 trick:
4578
4579 @lisp
4580 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4581 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4582 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4583 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4584 (if time
4585 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4586 "")))
4587 @end lisp
4588
4589 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4590 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4591 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4592 either.
4593
4594
4595 @node File Commands
4596 @subsection File Commands
4597 @cindex file commands
4598
4599 @table @kbd
4600
4601 @item r
4602 @kindex r (Group)
4603 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4604 @vindex gnus-init-file
4605 @cindex reading init file
4606 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4607 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4608
4609 @item s
4610 @kindex s (Group)
4611 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4612 @cindex saving .newsrc
4613 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4614 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4615 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4616
4617 @c @item Z
4618 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4619 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4620 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4621
4622 @end table
4623
4624
4625 @node Sieve Commands
4626 @subsection Sieve Commands
4627 @cindex group sieve commands
4628
4629 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4630 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4631 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4632 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4633 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4634
4635 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4636 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4637 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4638 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4639 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4640 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4641 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4642 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4643 regenerate the Sieve script.
4644
4645 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4646 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4647 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4648 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4649 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4650 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4651 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4652 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4653 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4654 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4655
4656 @example
4657 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4658 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4659 stop;
4660 @}
4661 @end example
4662
4663 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4664
4665 @table @kbd
4666
4667 @item D g
4668 @kindex D g (Group)
4669 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4670 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4671 @cindex generating sieve script
4672 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4673 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4674
4675 @item D u
4676 @kindex D u (Group)
4677 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4678 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4679 @cindex updating sieve script
4680 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4681 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4682 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4683
4684 @end table
4685
4686
4687 @node Summary Buffer
4688 @chapter Summary Buffer
4689 @cindex summary buffer
4690
4691 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4692 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4693
4694 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4695 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4696
4697 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4698
4699 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4700 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4701 available in Emacs.
4702
4703 @kindex v (Summary)
4704 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4705 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4706 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4707 @lisp
4708 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4709 @end lisp
4710
4711 @menu
4712 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4713 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4714 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4715 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4716 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4717 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4718 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4719 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4720 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4721 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4722 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4723 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4724 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4725 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4726 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4727 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4728 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4729 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4730 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4731 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4732 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4733 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4734 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4735 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4736 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4737 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4738 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4739 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4740 or reselecting the current group.
4741 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4742 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4743 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4744 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4745 @end menu
4746
4747
4748 @node Summary Buffer Format
4749 @section Summary Buffer Format
4750 @cindex summary buffer format
4751
4752 @iftex
4753 @iflatex
4754 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4755 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4756 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4757 }
4758 @end iflatex
4759 @end iftex
4760
4761 @menu
4762 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4763 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4764 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4765 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4769 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4770 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4771 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4772 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4773 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4774 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4775 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4776 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4777 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4778 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4779
4780 @lisp
4781 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4782 'mail-extract-address-components)
4783 @end lisp
4784
4785 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4786 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4787 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4788 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4789
4790
4791 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4792 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4793
4794 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4795 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4796 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4797 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4798 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4799
4800 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4801 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4802 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4803 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4804 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4805 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4806
4807 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4808
4809 The following format specification characters and extended format
4810 specification(s) are understood:
4811
4812 @table @samp
4813 @item N
4814 Article number.
4815 @item S
4816 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4817 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4818 @item s
4819 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4820 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4821 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4822 @item F
4823 Full @code{From} header.
4824 @item n
4825 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4826 @item f
4827 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4828 From Newsgroups}).
4829 @item a
4830 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4831 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4832 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4833 may be more thorough.
4834 @item A
4835 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4836 the @code{a} spec.
4837 @item L
4838 Number of lines in the article.
4839 @item c
4840 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4841 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4842 @item k
4843 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4844 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4845 @item I
4846 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4847 @item B
4848 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4849 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4850
4851 @example
4852 >
4853 +->
4854 | +->
4855 | | \->
4856 | | \->
4857 | \->
4858 +->
4859 \->
4860 @end example
4861
4862 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4863 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4864 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4865 line-drawing glyphs.
4866 @table @code
4867 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4868 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4869 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4870 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4871
4872 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4873 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4874 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4875 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4876
4877 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4878 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4879 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4880 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4881
4882 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4883 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4884 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4885
4886 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4887 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4888 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4889
4890 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4891 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4892 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4893
4894 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4895 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4896 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4897
4898 @end table
4899
4900 @item T
4901 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4902 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4903 @item [
4904 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4905 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4906 @item ]
4907 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4908 for adopted articles.
4909 @item >
4910 One space for each thread level.
4911 @item <
4912 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4913 @item U
4914 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4915
4916 @item R
4917 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4918 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4919 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4920
4921 @item i
4922 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4923 @item z
4924 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4925 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4926 default level. If the difference between
4927 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4928 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4929 @item V
4930 Total thread score.
4931 @item x
4932 @code{Xref}.
4933 @item D
4934 @code{Date}.
4935 @item d
4936 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4937 @item o
4938 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4939 @item M
4940 @code{Message-ID}.
4941 @item r
4942 @code{References}.
4943 @item t
4944 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4945 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4946 @item e
4947 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4948 article has any children.
4949 @item P
4950 The line number.
4951 @item O
4952 Download mark.
4953 @item *
4954 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4955 @item &user-date;
4956 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4957 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4958 @item u
4959 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4960 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4961 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4962 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4963 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4964 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4965 @end table
4966
4967 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4968 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4969 There can only be one such area.
4970
4971 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4972 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4973 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4974 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4975 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4976 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4977
4978 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4979 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4980
4981 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4982
4983
4984 @node To From Newsgroups
4985 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4986 @cindex To
4987 @cindex Newsgroups
4988
4989 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4990 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4991 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4992 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4993 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4994
4995 @enumerate
4996 @item
4997 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4998 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4999 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5000 instance:
5001
5002 @lisp
5003 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5004 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5005 @end lisp
5006
5007 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5008 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5009
5010 @item
5011 @findex gnus-extra-header
5012 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5013 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5014 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5015
5016 @example
5017 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5018 @end example
5019
5020 @item
5021 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5022 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5023 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5024 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5025 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5026 headers are used instead.
5027
5028 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5029 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5030 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5031 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5032 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5033 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5034
5035 @end enumerate
5036
5037 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5038 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5039 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5040 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5041 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5042 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5043 regeneration.
5044
5045 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5046 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5047 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5048 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5049
5050 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5051 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5052
5053 @lisp
5054 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5055 '(To Newsgroups))
5056 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5057 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5058 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5059 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5060 "Your Name Here")
5061 @end lisp
5062
5063 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5064 to fit your needs.)
5065
5066 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5067 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5068 support:
5069
5070 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5071 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5072 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5073
5074 @example
5075 Newsgroups:full
5076 @end example
5077
5078 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5079 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5080
5081
5082 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5083 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5084
5085 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5086 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5087 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5088 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5089
5090 Here are the elements you can play with:
5091
5092 @table @samp
5093 @item G
5094 Group name.
5095 @item p
5096 Unprefixed group name.
5097 @item A
5098 Current article number.
5099 @item z
5100 Current article score.
5101 @item V
5102 Gnus version.
5103 @item U
5104 Number of unread articles in this group.
5105 @item e
5106 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5107 summary buffer.
5108 @item Z
5109 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5110 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5111 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5112 and no unselected ones.
5113 @item g
5114 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5115 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5116 @item S
5117 Subject of the current article.
5118 @item u
5119 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5120 @item s
5121 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5122 @item d
5123 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5124 @item t
5125 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5126 @item r
5127 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5128 @item E
5129 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5130 @end table
5131
5132
5133 @node Summary Highlighting
5134 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5135
5136 @table @code
5137
5138 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5139 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5140 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5141 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5142 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5143
5144 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5145 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5146 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5147 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5148
5149 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5150 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5151 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5152 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5153
5154 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5155 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5156 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5157 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5158 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5159 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5160 to something like
5161 @lisp
5162 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5163 ((> score default) . bold))
5164 @end lisp
5165 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5166 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5167 @end table
5168
5169
5170 @node Summary Maneuvering
5171 @section Summary Maneuvering
5172 @cindex summary movement
5173
5174 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5175 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5176
5177 None of these commands select articles.
5178
5179 @table @kbd
5180 @item G M-n
5181 @itemx M-n
5182 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5183 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5184 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5185 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5186 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5187
5188 @item G M-p
5189 @itemx M-p
5190 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5191 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5192 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5193 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5194 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5195
5196 @item G g
5197 @kindex G g (Summary)
5198 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5199 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5200 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5201 @end table
5202
5203 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5204 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5205 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5206 to the group buffer.
5207
5208 Variables related to summary movement:
5209
5210 @table @code
5211
5212 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5213 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5214 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5215 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5216 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5217 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5218 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5219 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5220 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5221 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5222 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5223 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5224 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5225 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5226
5227 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5228 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5229 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5230 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5231 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5232 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5233 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5234
5235 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5236
5237 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5238 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5239 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5240 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5241 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5242
5243 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5244 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5245 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5246 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5247 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5248 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5249 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5250 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5251 threads.
5252
5253 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5254 the given number of lines from the top.
5255
5256 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5257 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5258 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5259 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5260
5261 @end table
5262
5263
5264 @node Choosing Articles
5265 @section Choosing Articles
5266 @cindex selecting articles
5267
5268 @menu
5269 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5270 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5271 @end menu
5272
5273
5274 @node Choosing Commands
5275 @subsection Choosing Commands
5276
5277 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5278 and they all select and display an article.
5279
5280 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5281 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5282
5283 @table @kbd
5284 @item SPACE
5285 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5286 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5287 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5288 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5289
5290 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5291 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5292 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5293
5294 @item G n
5295 @itemx n
5296 @kindex n (Summary)
5297 @kindex G n (Summary)
5298 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5299 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5300 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5301
5302 @item G p
5303 @itemx p
5304 @kindex p (Summary)
5305 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5306 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5307 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5308
5309 @item G N
5310 @itemx N
5311 @kindex N (Summary)
5312 @kindex G N (Summary)
5313 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5314 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5315
5316 @item G P
5317 @itemx P
5318 @kindex P (Summary)
5319 @kindex G P (Summary)
5320 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5321 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5322
5323 @item G C-n
5324 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5325 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5326 Go to the next article with the same subject
5327 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5328
5329 @item G C-p
5330 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5331 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5332 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5333 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5334
5335 @item G f
5336 @itemx .
5337 @kindex G f (Summary)
5338 @kindex . (Summary)
5339 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5340 Go to the first unread article
5341 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5342
5343 @item G b
5344 @itemx ,
5345 @kindex G b (Summary)
5346 @kindex , (Summary)
5347 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5348 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5349 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5350 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5351
5352 @item G l
5353 @itemx l
5354 @kindex l (Summary)
5355 @kindex G l (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5357 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5358
5359 @item G o
5360 @kindex G o (Summary)
5361 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5362 @cindex history
5363 @cindex article history
5364 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5365 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5366 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5367 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5368 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5369 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5370
5371 @item G j
5372 @itemx j
5373 @kindex j (Summary)
5374 @kindex G j (Summary)
5375 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5376 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5377 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5378
5379 @end table
5380
5381
5382 @node Choosing Variables
5383 @subsection Choosing Variables
5384
5385 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5386
5387 @table @code
5388 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5389 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5390 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5391 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5392 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5393 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5394
5395 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5396 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5397 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5398 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5399 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5400 hook will do so.
5401
5402 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5403 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5404 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5405 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5406 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5407 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5408 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5409 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5410 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5411 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5412 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5413 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5414 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5415 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5416
5417 @end table
5418
5419
5420 @node Paging the Article
5421 @section Scrolling the Article
5422 @cindex article scrolling
5423
5424 @table @kbd
5425
5426 @item SPACE
5427 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5428 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5429 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5430 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5431 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5432
5433 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5434 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5435 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5436 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5437 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5438 what is considered uninteresting with
5439 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5440 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5441
5442 @item DEL
5443 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5444 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5445 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5446
5447 @item RET
5448 @kindex RET (Summary)
5449 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5450 Scroll the current article one line forward
5451 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5452
5453 @item M-RET
5454 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5455 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5456 Scroll the current article one line backward
5457 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5458
5459 @item A g
5460 @itemx g
5461 @kindex A g (Summary)
5462 @kindex g (Summary)
5463 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5464 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5465 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5466 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5467 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5468 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5469 treatment functions.
5470
5471 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5472 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5473 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5474 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5475
5476 @lisp
5477 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5478 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5479 (2 . big5)))
5480 @end lisp
5481
5482 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5483
5484 @item A <
5485 @itemx <
5486 @kindex < (Summary)
5487 @kindex A < (Summary)
5488 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5489 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5490 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5491
5492 @item A >
5493 @itemx >
5494 @kindex > (Summary)
5495 @kindex A > (Summary)
5496 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5497 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5498
5499 @item A s
5500 @itemx s
5501 @kindex A s (Summary)
5502 @kindex s (Summary)
5503 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5504 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5505 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5506
5507 @item h
5508 @kindex h (Summary)
5509 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5510 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5511
5512 @end table
5513
5514
5515 @node Reply Followup and Post
5516 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5517
5518 @menu
5519 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5520 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5521 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5522 * Canceling and Superseding::
5523 @end menu
5524
5525
5526 @node Summary Mail Commands
5527 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5528 @cindex mail
5529 @cindex composing mail
5530
5531 Commands for composing a mail message:
5532
5533 @table @kbd
5534
5535 @item S r
5536 @itemx r
5537 @kindex S r (Summary)
5538 @kindex r (Summary)
5539 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5540 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5541 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5542 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5543 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5544
5545 @item S R
5546 @itemx R
5547 @kindex R (Summary)
5548 @kindex S R (Summary)
5549 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5550 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5551 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5552 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5553 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5554
5555 @item S w
5556 @kindex S w (Summary)
5557 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5558 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5559 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5560 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5561 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5562 present, that's used instead.
5563
5564 @item S W
5565 @kindex S W (Summary)
5566 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5567 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5568 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5569 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5570 first article to determine the recipients.
5571
5572 @item S L
5573 @kindex S L (Summary)
5574 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5575 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5576 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5577 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5578
5579 @item S v
5580 @kindex S v (Summary)
5581 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5582 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5583 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5584 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5585 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5586 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5587
5588 @item S V
5589 @kindex S V (Summary)
5590 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5591 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5592 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5593 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5594
5595 @item S B r
5596 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5597 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5598 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5599 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5600 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5601 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5602 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5603 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5604
5605 @item S B R
5606 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5607 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5608 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5609 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5610 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5611
5612 @item S o m
5613 @itemx C-c C-f
5614 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5615 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5616 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5617 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5618 Forward the current article to some other person
5619 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5620 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5621 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5622 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5623 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5624 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5625 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5626 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5627 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5628 section.
5629
5630 @item S m
5631 @itemx m
5632 @kindex m (Summary)
5633 @kindex S m (Summary)
5634 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5635 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5636 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5637 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5638 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5639
5640 @item S i
5641 @kindex S i (Summary)
5642 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5643 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5644 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5645 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5646
5647 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5648 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5649 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5650 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5651 for this to work though.
5652
5653 @item S D b
5654 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5655 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5656 @cindex bouncing mail
5657 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5658 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5659 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5660 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5661 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5662 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5663 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5664 very well fail, though.
5665
5666 @item S D r
5667 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5668 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5669 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5670 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5671 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5672 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5673 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5674 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5675 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5676 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5677
5678 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5679 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5680 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5681 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5682 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5683
5684 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5685 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5686
5687 @item S D e
5688 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5689 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5690
5691 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5692 if it were a new message before resending.
5693
5694 @item S O m
5695 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5696 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5697 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5698 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5699 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5700
5701 @item S M-c
5702 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5703 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5704 @cindex crossposting
5705 @cindex excessive crossposting
5706 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5707 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5708
5709 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5710 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5711 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5712 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5713 command understands the process/prefix convention
5714 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5715
5716 @end table
5717
5718 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5719 Manual}, for more information.
5720
5721
5722 @node Summary Post Commands
5723 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5724 @cindex post
5725 @cindex composing news
5726
5727 Commands for posting a news article:
5728
5729 @table @kbd
5730 @item S p
5731 @itemx a
5732 @kindex a (Summary)
5733 @kindex S p (Summary)
5734 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5735 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5736 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5737 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5738 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5739
5740 @item S f
5741 @itemx f
5742 @kindex f (Summary)
5743 @kindex S f (Summary)
5744 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5745 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5746 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5747
5748 @item S F
5749 @itemx F
5750 @kindex S F (Summary)
5751 @kindex F (Summary)
5752 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5753 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5754 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5755 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5756 process/prefix convention.
5757
5758 @item S n
5759 @kindex S n (Summary)
5760 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5761 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5762 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5763
5764 @item S N
5765 @kindex S N (Summary)
5766 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5767 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5768 message through mail and include the original message
5769 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5770 the process/prefix convention.
5771
5772 @item S o p
5773 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5774 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5775 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5776 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5777 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5778 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5779 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5780 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5781 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5782 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5783 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5784 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5785 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5786
5787 @item S O p
5788 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5789 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5790 @cindex digests
5791 @cindex making digests
5792 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5793 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5794 process/prefix convention.
5795
5796 @item S u
5797 @kindex S u (Summary)
5798 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5799 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5800 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5801 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5802 @end table
5803
5804 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5805 Manual}, for more information.
5806
5807
5808 @node Summary Message Commands
5809 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5810
5811 @table @kbd
5812 @item S y
5813 @kindex S y (Summary)
5814 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5815 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5816 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5817 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5818 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5819
5820 @end table
5821
5822
5823 @node Canceling and Superseding
5824 @subsection Canceling Articles
5825 @cindex canceling articles
5826 @cindex superseding articles
5827
5828 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5829 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5830
5831 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5832
5833 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5834 @kindex C (Summary)
5835 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5836 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5837 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5838 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5839 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5840 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5841
5842 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5843 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5844 question.
5845
5846 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5847 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5848 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5849
5850 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5851 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5852 message, Message Manual}).
5853
5854 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5855 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5856 your original article.
5857
5858 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5859 @kindex S (Summary)
5860 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5861 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5862 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5863 usual way.
5864
5865 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5866 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5867 have posted almost the same article twice.
5868
5869 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5870 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5871 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5872 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5873 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5874 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5875 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5876 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5877 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5878 canceled/superseded.
5879
5880 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5881
5882 @node Delayed Articles
5883 @section Delayed Articles
5884 @cindex delayed sending
5885 @cindex send delayed
5886
5887 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5888 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5889 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5890 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5891
5892 @lisp
5893 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5894 @end lisp
5895
5896 @findex gnus-delay-article
5897 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5898 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5899 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5900 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5901
5902 @itemize @bullet
5903 @item
5904 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5905 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5906 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5907 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5908
5909 @item
5910 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5911 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5912 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5913
5914 @item
5915 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5916 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5917 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5918 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5919 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5920 that means a time tomorrow.
5921 @end itemize
5922
5923 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5924 couple of variables:
5925
5926 @table @code
5927 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5928 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5929 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5930 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5931
5932 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5933 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5934 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5935 formats described above.
5936
5937 @item gnus-delay-group
5938 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5939 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5940 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5941 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5942
5943 @item gnus-delay-header
5944 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5945 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5946 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5947 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5948 @end table
5949
5950 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5951 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5952 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5953 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5954 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5955
5956 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5957 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5958 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5959 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5960 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5961 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5962 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5963
5964 @table @code
5965 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5966 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5967 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5968 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5969 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5970 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5971 argument is ignored.
5972
5973 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5974 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5975 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5976 @end table
5977
5978 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5979 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5980 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5981 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5982 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5983
5984
5985 @node Marking Articles
5986 @section Marking Articles
5987 @cindex article marking
5988 @cindex article ticking
5989 @cindex marks
5990
5991 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5992
5993 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5994 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5995 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5996
5997 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5998
5999 @ifinfo
6000 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6001 @end ifinfo
6002
6003 @menu
6004 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6005 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6006 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6007 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6008 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6009 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6010 @end menu
6011
6012
6013 @node Unread Articles
6014 @subsection Unread Articles
6015
6016 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6017 other.
6018
6019 @table @samp
6020 @item !
6021 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6022 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6023
6024 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6025 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6026 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6027 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6028 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6029 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6030 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6031
6032 @item ?
6033 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6034 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6035
6036 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6037 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6038 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6039 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6040 messages.
6041
6042 @item SPACE
6043 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6044 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6045
6046 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6047 @end table
6048
6049
6050 @node Read Articles
6051 @subsection Read Articles
6052 @cindex expirable mark
6053
6054 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6055
6056 @table @samp
6057
6058 @item r
6059 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6060 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6061 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6062
6063 @item R
6064 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6065 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6066
6067 @item O
6068 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6069 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6070 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6071
6072 @item K
6073 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6074 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6075
6076 @item X
6077 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6078 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6079
6080 @item Y
6081 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6082 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6083
6084 @item C
6085 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6086 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6087
6088 @item G
6089 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6090 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6091
6092 @item Q
6093 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6094 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6095 Threading}.
6096
6097 @item M
6098 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6099 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6100 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6101
6102 @end table
6103
6104 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6105 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6106
6107 One more special mark, though:
6108
6109 @table @samp
6110 @item E
6111 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6112 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6113
6114 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6115 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6116 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6117 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6118 any time.
6119 @end table
6120
6121
6122 @node Other Marks
6123 @subsection Other Marks
6124 @cindex process mark
6125 @cindex bookmarks
6126
6127 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6128 read or not.
6129
6130 @itemize @bullet
6131
6132 @item
6133 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6134 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6135 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6136 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6137 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6138
6139 @item
6140 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6141 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6142 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6143 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6144
6145 @item
6146 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6147 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6148 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6149
6150 @item
6151 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6152 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6153 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6154
6155 @item
6156 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6157 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6158 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6159 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6160
6161 @item
6162 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6163 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6164 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6165
6166 @item
6167 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6168 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6169 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6170 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6171 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6172 use.)
6173
6174 @item
6175 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6176 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6177 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6178 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6179 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6180 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6181
6182 @item
6183 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6184 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6185 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6186 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6187 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6188 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6189 use.)
6190
6191 @item
6192 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6193 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6194 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6195 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6196 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6197
6198 @item
6199 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6200 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6201 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6202 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6203 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6204 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6205
6206 @end itemize
6207
6208 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6209 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6210 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6211
6212 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6213 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6214 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6215
6216
6217 @node Setting Marks
6218 @subsection Setting Marks
6219 @cindex setting marks
6220
6221 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6222
6223 @table @kbd
6224 @item M c
6225 @itemx M-u
6226 @kindex M c (Summary)
6227 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6228 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6229 @cindex mark as unread
6230 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6231 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6232 article as unread.
6233
6234 @item M t
6235 @itemx !
6236 @kindex ! (Summary)
6237 @kindex M t (Summary)
6238 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6239 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6240 @xref{Article Caching}.
6241
6242 @item M ?
6243 @itemx ?
6244 @kindex ? (Summary)
6245 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6246 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6247 Mark the current article as dormant
6248 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6249
6250 @item M d
6251 @itemx d
6252 @kindex M d (Summary)
6253 @kindex d (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6255 Mark the current article as read
6256 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6257
6258 @item D
6259 @kindex D (Summary)
6260 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6261 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6262 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6263
6264 @item M k
6265 @itemx k
6266 @kindex k (Summary)
6267 @kindex M k (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6269 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6270 and then select the next unread article
6271 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6272
6273 @item M K
6274 @itemx C-k
6275 @kindex M K (Summary)
6276 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6278 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6279 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6280
6281 @item M C
6282 @kindex M C (Summary)
6283 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6284 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6285 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6286
6287 @item M C-c
6288 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6289 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6290 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6291 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6292
6293 @item M H
6294 @kindex M H (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6296 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6298
6299 @item M h
6300 @kindex M h (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6302 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6304
6305 @item C-w
6306 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6308 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6309 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6310
6311 @item M V k
6312 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6314 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6315 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6316
6317 @item M e
6318 @itemx E
6319 @kindex M e (Summary)
6320 @kindex E (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6322 Mark the current article as expirable
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6324
6325 @item M b
6326 @kindex M b (Summary)
6327 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6328 Set a bookmark in the current article
6329 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6330
6331 @item M B
6332 @kindex M B (Summary)
6333 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6334 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6335 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6336
6337 @item M V c
6338 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6339 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6340 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6341 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6342
6343 @item M V u
6344 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6346 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6347 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6348
6349 @item M V m
6350 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6351 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6352 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6353 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6354 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6355 @end table
6356
6357 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6358 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6359 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6360 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6361 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6362 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6363 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6364 The default is @code{t}.
6365
6366
6367 @node Generic Marking Commands
6368 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6369
6370 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6371 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6372 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6373 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6374 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6375 well.
6376
6377 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6378 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6379 command should do.
6380
6381 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6382 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6383 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6384 to list in this manual.
6385
6386 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6387 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6388 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6389 article, you could say something like:
6390
6391 @lisp
6392 @group
6393 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6394 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6395 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6396 @end group
6397 @end lisp
6398
6399 @noindent
6400 or
6401
6402 @lisp
6403 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6404 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6405 @end lisp
6406
6407
6408 @node Setting Process Marks
6409 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6410 @cindex setting process marks
6411
6412 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6413 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6414 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6415 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6416 articles into the cache. For more information,
6417 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6418
6419 @table @kbd
6420
6421 @item M P p
6422 @itemx #
6423 @kindex # (Summary)
6424 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6425 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6426 Mark the current article with the process mark
6427 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6428 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6429
6430 @item M P u
6431 @itemx M-#
6432 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6433 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6434 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6435 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6436
6437 @item M P U
6438 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6440 Remove the process mark from all articles
6441 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6442
6443 @item M P i
6444 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6445 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6446 Invert the list of process marked articles
6447 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6448
6449 @item M P R
6450 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6451 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6452 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6453 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6454
6455 @item M P G
6456 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6457 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6458 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6459 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6460
6461 @item M P r
6462 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6464 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6465
6466 @item M P g
6467 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6468 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6469 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6470
6471 @item M P t
6472 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6473 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6474 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6475 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6476
6477 @item M P T
6478 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6479 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6480 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6481 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6482
6483 @item M P v
6484 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6485 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6486 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6487 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6488
6489 @item M P s
6490 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6491 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6492 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6493
6494 @item M P S
6495 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6496 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6497 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6498 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6499
6500 @item M P a
6501 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6502 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6503 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6504
6505 @item M P b
6506 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6507 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6508 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6509 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6510
6511 @item M P k
6512 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6513 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6514 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6515 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6516
6517 @item M P y
6518 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6519 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6520 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6521 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6522
6523 @item M P w
6524 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6525 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6526 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6527 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6528
6529 @end table
6530
6531 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6532 set process marks based on article body contents.
6533
6534
6535 @node Limiting
6536 @section Limiting
6537 @cindex limiting
6538
6539 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6540 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6541 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6542 buffer.
6543
6544 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6545 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6546 articles.
6547
6548 @table @kbd
6549
6550 @item / /
6551 @itemx / s
6552 @kindex / / (Summary)
6553 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6554 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6555 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6556 matching articles.
6557
6558 @item / a
6559 @kindex / a (Summary)
6560 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6561 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6562 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6563 matching articles.
6564
6565 @item / R
6566 @kindex / R (Summary)
6567 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6568 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6569 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6570 matching articles.
6571
6572 @item / A
6573 @kindex / A (Summary)
6574 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6575 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6576 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6577 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6578
6579 @item / S
6580 @kindex / S (Summary)
6581 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6582 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6583 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6584 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6585
6586 @item / x
6587 @kindex / x (Summary)
6588 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6589 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6590 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6591 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6592 matching articles.
6593
6594 @item / u
6595 @itemx x
6596 @kindex / u (Summary)
6597 @kindex x (Summary)
6598 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6599 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6600 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6601 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6602 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6603
6604 @item / m
6605 @kindex / m (Summary)
6606 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6607 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6608 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6609
6610 @item / t
6611 @kindex / t (Summary)
6612 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6613 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6614 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6615 articles younger than that number of days.
6616
6617 @item / n
6618 @kindex / n (Summary)
6619 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6620 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6621 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6622 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6623
6624 @item / w
6625 @kindex / w (Summary)
6626 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6627 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6628 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6629 the stack.
6630
6631 @item / .
6632 @kindex / . (Summary)
6633 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6634 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6635 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6636
6637 @item / v
6638 @kindex / v (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6640 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6641 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6642
6643 @item / p
6644 @kindex / p (Summary)
6645 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6646 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6647 group parameter predicate
6648 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6649 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6650
6651 @item / r
6652 @kindex / r (Summary)
6653 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6654 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6655 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6656 replied articles.
6657
6658 @item / E
6659 @itemx M S
6660 @kindex M S (Summary)
6661 @kindex / E (Summary)
6662 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6663 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6664 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6665
6666 @item / D
6667 @kindex / D (Summary)
6668 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6669 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6670 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6671
6672 @item / *
6673 @kindex / * (Summary)
6674 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6675 Include all cached articles in the limit
6676 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6677
6678 @item / d
6679 @kindex / d (Summary)
6680 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6681 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6682 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6683
6684 @item / M
6685 @kindex / M (Summary)
6686 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6687 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6688
6689 @item / T
6690 @kindex / T (Summary)
6691 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6692 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6693
6694 @item / c
6695 @kindex / c (Summary)
6696 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6697 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6698 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6699
6700 @item / C
6701 @kindex / C (Summary)
6702 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6703 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6704 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6705 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6706
6707 @item / b
6708 @kindex / b (Summary)
6709 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6710 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6711 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6712 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6713 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6714
6715 @item / h
6716 @kindex / h (Summary)
6717 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6718 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6719 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6720
6721 @end table
6722
6723
6724 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6725 prefix as well.
6726
6727 @table @kbd
6728 @item / N
6729 @kindex / N (Summary)
6730 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6731 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6732 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6733
6734 @item / o
6735 @kindex / o (Summary)
6736 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6737 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6738 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6739
6740 @end table
6741
6742
6743 @node Threading
6744 @section Threading
6745 @cindex threading
6746 @cindex article threading
6747
6748 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6749 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6750 hierarchical fashion.
6751
6752 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6753 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6754 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6755 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6756 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6757 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6758 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6759
6760 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6761
6762 @table @dfn
6763 @item root
6764 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6765
6766 @item thread
6767 A tree-like article structure.
6768
6769 @item sub-thread
6770 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6771
6772 @item loose threads
6773 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6774 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6775 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6776 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6777 called loose threads.
6778
6779 @item thread gathering
6780 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6781
6782 @item sparse threads
6783 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6784 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6785
6786 @end table
6787
6788
6789 @menu
6790 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6791 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6792 @end menu
6793
6794
6795 @node Customizing Threading
6796 @subsection Customizing Threading
6797 @cindex customizing threading
6798
6799 @menu
6800 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6801 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6802 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6803 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6804 @end menu
6805
6806
6807 @node Loose Threads
6808 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6809 @cindex <
6810 @cindex >
6811 @cindex loose threads
6812
6813 @table @code
6814 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6815 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6816 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6817 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6818 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6819 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6820
6821 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6822 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6823 There are four possible values:
6824
6825 @iftex
6826 @iflatex
6827 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6828 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6829 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6830 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6831 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6832 }
6833 @end iflatex
6834 @end iftex
6835
6836 @cindex adopting articles
6837
6838 @table @code
6839
6840 @item adopt
6841 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6842 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6843 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6844 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6845
6846 @item dummy
6847 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6848 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6849 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6850 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6851 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6852 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6853 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6854 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6855 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6856 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6857
6858 @item empty
6859 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6860 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6861 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6862 Buffer Format}).)
6863
6864 @item none
6865 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6866 display them after one another.
6867
6868 @item nil
6869 Don't gather loose threads.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6873 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6874 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6875 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6876 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6877 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6878 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6879 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6880 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6881 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6882 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6883
6884 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6885 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6886 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6887 Matching}).
6888
6889 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6890 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6891 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6892 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6893 simplification is used.
6894
6895 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6896 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6897 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6898 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6899
6900 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6901 @lisp
6902 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6903 (concat
6904 "\\`\\[?\\("
6905 (mapconcat
6906 'identity
6907 '("looking"
6908 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6909 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6910 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6911 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6912 ;; ...
6913 )
6914 "\\|")
6915 "\\)\\s *\\("
6916 (mapconcat 'identity
6917 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6918 "\\|")
6919 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6920 @end lisp
6921
6922 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6923 subjects.
6924
6925 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6926 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6927 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6928 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6929 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6930 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6931
6932 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6933
6934 @table @code
6935 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6936 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6937 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6938
6939 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6940 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6941 Simplify fuzzily.
6942
6943 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6944 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6945 Remove excessive whitespace.
6946
6947 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6948 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6949 Remove all whitespace.
6950 @end table
6951
6952 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6953
6954
6955 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6956 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6957 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6958 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6959 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6960 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6961 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6962 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6963
6964 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6965 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6966 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6967 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6968 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6969 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6970 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6971 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6972 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6973 cholera:
6974
6975 @table @code
6976 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6977 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6978 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6979 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6980
6981 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6982 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6983 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6984 @end table
6985
6986 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6987 something like:
6988
6989 @lisp
6990 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6991 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6992 @end lisp
6993
6994 @end table
6995
6996
6997 @node Filling In Threads
6998 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6999
7000 @table @code
7001 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7002 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7003 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7004 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7005 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7006 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7007 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7008 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7009 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7010 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7011 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7012 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7013 do about that.
7014
7015 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7016 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7017 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7018
7019 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7020
7021 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7022 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7023 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7024 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7025 slow summary generation.
7026
7027 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7028 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7029 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7030 newsgroups.
7031
7032 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7033 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7034 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7035 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7036 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7037 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7038 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7039 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7040 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7041 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7042 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7043 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7044 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7045 @code{nil} by default.
7046
7047 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7048 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7049 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7050 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7051 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7052 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7053 web-based groups.
7054
7055 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7056 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7057 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7058
7059 @end table
7060
7061
7062 @node More Threading
7063 @subsubsection More Threading
7064
7065 @table @code
7066 @item gnus-show-threads
7067 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7068 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7069 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7070 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7071 slower and more awkward.
7072
7073 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7074 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7075 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7076 generated.
7077
7078 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7079 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7080 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7081
7082 Here's an example:
7083
7084 @lisp
7085 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7086 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7087 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7088 @end lisp
7089
7090 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7091 unread, but you get my drift.)
7092
7093
7094 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7095 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7096 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7097 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7098 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7099 threads are expunged.
7100
7101 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7102 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7103 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7104 will be hidden.
7105
7106 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7107 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7108 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7109 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7110 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7111 result in a new thread.
7112
7113 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7114 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7115 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7116 The default is 4.
7117
7118 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7119 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7120 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7121 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7122 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7123 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7124 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7125 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7126 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7127 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7128 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7129
7130 @end table
7131
7132
7133 @node Low-Level Threading
7134 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7135
7136 @table @code
7137
7138 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7139 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7140 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7141
7142 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7143 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7144 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7145 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7146 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7147 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7148 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7149 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7150 meaningful. Here's one example:
7151
7152 @lisp
7153 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7154
7155 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7156 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7157 (when (string-match
7158 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7159 (mail-header-set-id
7160 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7161 header))))
7162 @end lisp
7163
7164 @end table
7165
7166
7167 @node Thread Commands
7168 @subsection Thread Commands
7169 @cindex thread commands
7170
7171 @table @kbd
7172
7173 @item T k
7174 @itemx C-M-k
7175 @kindex T k (Summary)
7176 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7177 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7178 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7179 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7180 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7181 articles instead.
7182
7183 @item T l
7184 @itemx C-M-l
7185 @kindex T l (Summary)
7186 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7187 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7188 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7189 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7190
7191 @item T i
7192 @kindex T i (Summary)
7193 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7194 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7195 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7196
7197 @item T #
7198 @kindex T # (Summary)
7199 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7200 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7201 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7202
7203 @item T M-#
7204 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7205 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7206 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7207 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7208
7209 @item T T
7210 @kindex T T (Summary)
7211 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7212 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7213
7214 @item T s
7215 @kindex T s (Summary)
7216 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7217 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7218 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7219
7220 @item T h
7221 @kindex T h (Summary)
7222 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7223 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7224
7225 @item T S
7226 @kindex T S (Summary)
7227 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7228 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7229
7230 @item T H
7231 @kindex T H (Summary)
7232 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7233 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7234
7235 @item T t
7236 @kindex T t (Summary)
7237 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7238 Re-thread the current article's thread
7239 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7240 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7241
7242 @item T ^
7243 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7244 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7245 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7246 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7247
7248 @item T M-^
7249 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7250 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7251 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7252 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7253
7254 @end table
7255
7256 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7257 understand the numeric prefix.
7258
7259 @table @kbd
7260
7261 @item T n
7262 @kindex T n (Summary)
7263 @itemx C-M-f
7264 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7265 @itemx M-down
7266 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7267 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7268 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7269
7270 @item T p
7271 @kindex T p (Summary)
7272 @itemx C-M-b
7273 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7274 @itemx M-up
7275 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7276 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7277 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7278
7279 @item T d
7280 @kindex T d (Summary)
7281 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7282 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7283
7284 @item T u
7285 @kindex T u (Summary)
7286 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7287 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7288
7289 @item T o
7290 @kindex T o (Summary)
7291 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7292 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7293 @end table
7294
7295 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7296 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7297 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7298 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7299 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7300 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7301 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7302 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7303 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7304 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7305 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7306 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7307 Matching}).
7308
7309
7310 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7311 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7312
7313 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7315 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7317 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7318 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7319 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7320 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7321 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7322 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7323 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7324 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7325 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7326 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7327 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7328
7329 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7330 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7331 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7333 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7334 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7335 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7336 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7337 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7338 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7339
7340 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7341 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7342 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7343 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7344 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7345
7346 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7347 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7348 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7349 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7350 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7351 ascending article order.
7352
7353 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7354 by number, you could do something like:
7355
7356 @lisp
7357 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7358 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7359 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7360 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7361 @end lisp
7362
7363 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7364 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7365 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7366 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7367 which the articles arrived.
7368
7369 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7370 say something like:
7371
7372 @lisp
7373 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7374 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7375 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7376 @end lisp
7377
7378 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7379 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7380 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7381 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7382 tickles your fancy.
7383
7384 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7387 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7388 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7389 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7390 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7391 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7392 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7393 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7394 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7395 variable. It is very similar to the
7396 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7397 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7398 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7399 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7400 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7401 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7402 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7403
7404 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7405 say something like:
7406
7407 @lisp
7408 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7409 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7410 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7411 @end lisp
7412
7413 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7414 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7415
7416
7417 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7418 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7419 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7420 @cindex article pre-fetch
7421 @cindex pre-fetch
7422
7423 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7424 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7425 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7426 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7427 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7428
7429 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7430 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7431
7432 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7433 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7434 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7435 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7436 connection is blocked.
7437
7438 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7439 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7440 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7441 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7442
7443 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7444 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7445 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7446 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7447 extra connection.
7448
7449 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7450 you really want to.
7451
7452 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7453 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7454 happen automatically.
7455
7456 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7457 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7458 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7459 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7460 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7461 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7462 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7463
7464 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7465 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7466 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7467 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7468 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7469 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7470 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7471 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7472 article data structure as the only parameter.
7473
7474 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7475 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7476
7477 @lisp
7478 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7479 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7480 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7481 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7482 100)))
7483
7484 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7485 @end lisp
7486
7487 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7488 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7489 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7490
7491 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7492 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7493 After an article has been prefetched, this
7494 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7495 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7496 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7497 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7498 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7499 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7500
7501 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7502 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7503 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7504 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @item read
7508 Remove articles when they are read.
7509
7510 @item exit
7511 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7512 @end table
7513
7514 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7515
7516 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7517 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7518 @c from the next group.
7519
7520
7521 @node Article Caching
7522 @section Article Caching
7523 @cindex article caching
7524 @cindex caching
7525
7526 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7527 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7528 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7529 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7530 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7531
7532 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7533
7534 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7535 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7536 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7537 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7538 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7539 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7540 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7541 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7542
7543 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7544 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7545 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7546 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7547 as dormant, and don't worry.
7548
7549 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7550
7551 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7552 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7553 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7554 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7555 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7556 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7557 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7558 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7559 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7560 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7561
7562 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7563 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7564 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7565 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7566 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7567 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7568 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7569 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7570 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7571 not then be downloaded by this command.
7572
7573 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7574 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7575 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7576 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7577 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7578 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7579
7580 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7581 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7582 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7583 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7584 variables, the group is not cached.
7585
7586 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7587 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7588 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7589 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7590 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7591 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7592 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7593 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7594 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7595 file.
7596
7597 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7598 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7599 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7600 where, isn't that cool?
7601
7602 @node Persistent Articles
7603 @section Persistent Articles
7604 @cindex persistent articles
7605
7606 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7607 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7608 useful in my opinion.
7609
7610 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7611 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7612 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7613 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7614 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7615 the expiry going on at the news server.
7616
7617 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7618 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7619 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7620
7621 @table @kbd
7622
7623 @item *
7624 @kindex * (Summary)
7625 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7626 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7627
7628 @item M-*
7629 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7630 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7631 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7632 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7633 article.
7634 @end table
7635
7636 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7637
7638 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7639 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7640 interested in persistent articles:
7641
7642 @lisp
7643 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7644 @end lisp
7645
7646 @node Sticky Articles
7647 @section Sticky Articles
7648 @cindex sticky articles
7649
7650 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7651 according to the value of the variable
7652 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7653 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7654 has its own article buffer.
7655
7656 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7657 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7658 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7659 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7660
7661 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7662 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7663 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7664
7665 @table @kbd
7666 @item A S
7667 @kindex A S (Summary)
7668 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7669 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7670 name for this sticky article buffer.
7671 @end table
7672
7673 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7674
7675 @table @kbd
7676 @item q
7677 @kindex q (Article)
7678 @findex bury-buffer
7679 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7680
7681 @item k
7682 @kindex k (Article)
7683 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7684 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7685 @end table
7686
7687 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7688
7689 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7690 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7691 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7692 @end defun
7693
7694 @node Article Backlog
7695 @section Article Backlog
7696 @cindex backlog
7697 @cindex article backlog
7698
7699 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7700 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7701 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7702 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7703 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7704 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7705 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7706 increase memory usage some.
7707
7708 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7709 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7710 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7711 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7712 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7713 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7714 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7715
7716 The default value is 20.
7717
7718
7719 @node Saving Articles
7720 @section Saving Articles
7721 @cindex saving articles
7722
7723 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7724 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7725 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7726 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7727 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7728
7729 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7730 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7731 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7732
7733 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7734 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7735 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7736
7737 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7738 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7739 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7740 deleted before saving.
7741
7742 @table @kbd
7743
7744 @item O o
7745 @itemx o
7746 @kindex O o (Summary)
7747 @kindex o (Summary)
7748 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7749 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7750 Save the current article using the default article saver
7751 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7752
7753 @item O m
7754 @kindex O m (Summary)
7755 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7756 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7757 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7758
7759 @item O r
7760 @kindex O r (Summary)
7761 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7762 Save the current article in Rmail format
7763 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7764 Babyl in older versions.
7765
7766 @item O f
7767 @kindex O f (Summary)
7768 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7769 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7770 Save the current article in plain file format
7771 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7772
7773 @item O F
7774 @kindex O F (Summary)
7775 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7776 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7777 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7778
7779 @item O b
7780 @kindex O b (Summary)
7781 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7782 Save the current article body in plain file format
7783 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7784
7785 @item O h
7786 @kindex O h (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7788 Save the current article in mh folder format
7789 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7790
7791 @item O v
7792 @kindex O v (Summary)
7793 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7794 Save the current article in a VM folder
7795 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7796
7797 @item O p
7798 @itemx |
7799 @kindex O p (Summary)
7800 @kindex | (Summary)
7801 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7802 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7803 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7804 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7805 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7806 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7807 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7808 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7809 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7810 @code{nil}).
7811
7812 @item O P
7813 @kindex O P (Summary)
7814 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7815 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7816 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7817 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7818 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7819 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7820 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7821
7822 @end table
7823
7824 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7825 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7826 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7827 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7828 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7829 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7830 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7831 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7832 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7833 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7834 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7835 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7836 files.
7837
7838
7839 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7840 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7841 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7842 functions below, or you can create your own.
7843
7844 @table @code
7845
7846 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7847 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7848 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7849 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7850 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7851 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7852 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7853 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7854 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7855 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7856 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7857
7858 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7859 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7860 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7861 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7862 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7863 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7864
7865 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7866 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7867 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7868 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7869 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7870 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7871 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7872
7873 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7874 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7875 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7876 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7877 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7878 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7879
7880 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7881 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7882 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7883 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7884 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7885
7886 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7887 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7888 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7889 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7890 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7891 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7892
7893 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7894 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7895 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7896 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7897 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7898 @cindex rcvstore
7899 @cindex MH folders
7900 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7901 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7902 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7903 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7904 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7905
7906 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7907 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7908 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7909 reader to use this setting.
7910
7911 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7912 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7913 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7914 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7915
7916 @itemize @bullet
7917 @item a string@*
7918 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7919 @item @code{nil}@*
7920 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7921 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7922 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7923 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7924 last used for saving.
7925 @end itemize
7926
7927 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7928 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7929 headers will be piped.
7930 @end table
7931
7932 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7933
7934 @table @code
7935 @item :decode
7936 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7937 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7938 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7939 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7940 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7941 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7942
7943 @item :function
7944 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7945 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7946 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7947 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7948 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7949 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7950
7951 @item :headers
7952 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7953 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7954 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7955 headers should be saved.
7956 @end table
7957
7958 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7959 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7960 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7961 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7962 default.
7963
7964 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7965 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7966 available functions that generate names:
7967
7968 @table @code
7969
7970 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7971 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7972 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7973
7974 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7975 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7976 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7977
7978 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7979 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7980 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7981
7982 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7983 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7984 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7985
7986 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7987 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7988 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7989 @end table
7990
7991 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7992 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7993 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7994 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7995 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7996 like:
7997
7998 @lisp
7999 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8000 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8001 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8002 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8003 @end lisp
8004
8005 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8006 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8007 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8008 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8009 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8010 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8011 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8012 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8013 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8014
8015 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8016 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8017 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8018 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8019
8020 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8021 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8022 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8023 name.
8024
8025 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8026 lots of mail groups called things like
8027 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8028 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8029 following will do just that:
8030
8031 @lisp
8032 (defun my-save-name (group)
8033 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8034 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8035
8036 (setq gnus-split-methods
8037 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8038 (my-save-name)))
8039 @end lisp
8040
8041
8042 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8043 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8044 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8045 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8046 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8047 all the files in the top level directory
8048 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8049 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8050 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8051 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8052
8053 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8054 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8055 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8056 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8057 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8058 for kill files.
8059
8060 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8061 a spool, you could
8062
8063 @lisp
8064 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8065 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8066 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8067 @end lisp
8068
8069 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8070 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8071 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8072 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8073
8074
8075 @node Decoding Articles
8076 @section Decoding Articles
8077 @cindex decoding articles
8078
8079 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8080 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8081
8082 @menu
8083 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8084 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8085 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8086 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8087 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8088 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8089 @end menu
8090
8091 @cindex series
8092 @cindex article series
8093 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8094 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8095 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8096 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8097 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8098
8099 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8100 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8101 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8102
8103 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8104 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8105 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8106
8107 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8108 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8109 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8110
8111
8112 @node Uuencoded Articles
8113 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8114 @cindex uudecode
8115 @cindex uuencoded articles
8116
8117 @table @kbd
8118
8119 @item X u
8120 @kindex X u (Summary)
8121 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8122 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8123 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8124
8125 @item X U
8126 @kindex X U (Summary)
8127 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8128 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8129 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8130
8131 @item X v u
8132 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8133 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8134 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8135
8136 @item X v U
8137 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8138 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8139 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8140 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8141
8142 @end table
8143
8144 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8145 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8146 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8147 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8148 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8149
8150 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8151 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8152 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8153 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8154 @kbd{X u}.
8155
8156 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8157 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8158 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8159 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8160 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8161 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8162 off.
8163
8164
8165 @node Shell Archives
8166 @subsection Shell Archives
8167 @cindex unshar
8168 @cindex shell archives
8169 @cindex shared articles
8170
8171 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8172 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8173 some commands to deal with these:
8174
8175 @table @kbd
8176
8177 @item X s
8178 @kindex X s (Summary)
8179 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8180 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8181
8182 @item X S
8183 @kindex X S (Summary)
8184 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8185 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8186
8187 @item X v s
8188 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8189 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8190 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8191
8192 @item X v S
8193 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8194 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8195 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8196 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8197 @end table
8198
8199
8200 @node PostScript Files
8201 @subsection PostScript Files
8202 @cindex PostScript
8203
8204 @table @kbd
8205
8206 @item X p
8207 @kindex X p (Summary)
8208 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8209 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8210
8211 @item X P
8212 @kindex X P (Summary)
8213 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8214 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8215 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8216
8217 @item X v p
8218 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8219 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8220 View the current PostScript series
8221 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8222
8223 @item X v P
8224 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8225 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8226 View and save the current PostScript series
8227 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8228 @end table
8229
8230
8231 @node Other Files
8232 @subsection Other Files
8233
8234 @table @kbd
8235 @item X o
8236 @kindex X o (Summary)
8237 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8238 Save the current series
8239 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8240
8241 @item X b
8242 @kindex X b (Summary)
8243 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8244 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8245 doesn't really work yet.
8246
8247 @item X Y
8248 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8249 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8250 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8251 @end table
8252
8253
8254 @node Decoding Variables
8255 @subsection Decoding Variables
8256
8257 Adjective, not verb.
8258
8259 @menu
8260 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8261 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8262 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8263 @end menu
8264
8265
8266 @node Rule Variables
8267 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8268 @cindex rule variables
8269
8270 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8271 variables are of the form
8272
8273 @lisp
8274 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8275 '(regexp2 command2)
8276 ...)
8277 @end lisp
8278
8279 @table @code
8280
8281 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8282 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8283 @cindex sox
8284 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8285 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8286 say something like:
8287 @lisp
8288 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8289 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8290 @end lisp
8291
8292 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8293 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8294 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8295 user and default view rules.
8296
8297 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8298 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8299 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8300 archives.
8301 @end table
8302
8303
8304 @node Other Decode Variables
8305 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8306
8307 @table @code
8308 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8309
8310 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8311 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8312 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8313 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8314 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8315
8316 @table @code
8317
8318 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8319 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8320 View the file.
8321
8322 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8323 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8324 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8328 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8329 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8330 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8331 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8332 time.
8333
8334 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8335 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8336 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8337
8338 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8339 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8340 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8341 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8342 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8343 kludgy.
8344
8345 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8346 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8347 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8348
8349 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8350 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8351 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8352 looking for files to display.
8353
8354 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8355 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8356 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8357 after viewing it.
8358
8359 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8360 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8361 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8362 rules.
8363
8364 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8365 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8366 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8367 unpacking commands.
8368
8369 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8370 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8371 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8372 from articles.
8373
8374 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8375 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8376 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8377 decoded articles as unread.
8378
8379 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8380 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8381 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8382 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8383
8384 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8385 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8386 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8387
8388 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8389 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8390 @cindex metamail
8391 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8392 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8393 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8394 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8395
8396 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8397 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8398 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8399 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8400 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8401 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8402 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8403 simply dropped them.
8404
8405 @end table
8406
8407
8408 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8409 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8410
8411 @table @code
8412
8413 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8414 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8415 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8416 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8417 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8418 for you when you post the article.
8419
8420 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8421 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8422 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8423 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8424
8425 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8426 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8427 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8428 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8429 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8430 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8431 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8432
8433 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8434 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8435 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8436 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8437 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8438 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8439 Default is @code{t}.
8440
8441 @end table
8442
8443
8444 @node Viewing Files
8445 @subsection Viewing Files
8446 @cindex viewing files
8447 @cindex pseudo-articles
8448
8449 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8450 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8451 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8452 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8453 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8454 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8455 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8456
8457 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8458 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8459 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8460 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8461
8462 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8463 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8464 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8465
8466 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8467 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8468 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8469 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8470 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8471
8472 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8473 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8474 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8475 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8476 a list of parameters to that command.
8477
8478 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8479 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8480 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8481
8482 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8483 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8484 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8485
8486
8487 @node Article Treatment
8488 @section Article Treatment
8489
8490 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8491 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8492 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8493 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8494 these articles easier.
8495
8496 @menu
8497 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8498 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8499 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8500 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8501 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8502 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8503 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8504 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8505 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8506 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8507 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8508 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8509 @end menu
8510
8511
8512 @node Article Highlighting
8513 @subsection Article Highlighting
8514 @cindex highlighting
8515
8516 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8517 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8518
8519 @table @kbd
8520
8521 @item W H a
8522 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8523 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8524 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8525 Do much highlighting of the current article
8526 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8527 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8528
8529 @item W H h
8530 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8532 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8533 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8534 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8535 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8536 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8537 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8538 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8539 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8540 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8541 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8542
8543 @item W H c
8544 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8545 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8546 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8547
8548 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8549
8550 @table @code
8551 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8552
8553 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8554 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8555 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8556
8557 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8558 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8559 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8560
8561 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8562 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8563 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8564 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8565 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8566 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8567
8568 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8569 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8570 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8571
8572 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8573 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8574 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8575
8576 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8577 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8578 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8579 that it's a citation.
8580
8581 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8582 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8583 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8586 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8587 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8588
8589 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8590 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8591 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8592 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8593
8594 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8595 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8596 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8597 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8598 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8599 is @code{t}.
8600
8601 @end table
8602
8603
8604 @item W H s
8605 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8606 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8607 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8608 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8609 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8610 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8611 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8612 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8613 default.
8614
8615 @end table
8616
8617 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8618
8619
8620 @node Article Fontisizing
8621 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8622 @cindex emphasis
8623 @cindex article emphasis
8624
8625 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8626 @kindex W e (Summary)
8627 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8628 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8629 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8630 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8631
8632 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8633 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8634 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8635 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8636 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8637 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8638 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8639 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8640 highlighting.
8641
8642 @lisp
8643 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8644 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8645 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8646 @end lisp
8647
8648 @cindex slash
8649 @cindex asterisk
8650 @cindex underline
8651 @cindex /
8652 @cindex *
8653
8654 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8655 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8656 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8657 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8658 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8659 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8660 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8661 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8662 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8663 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8664 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8665 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8666 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8667
8668 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8669 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8670 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8671 say something like:
8672
8673 @lisp
8674 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8675 @end lisp
8676
8677 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8678
8679 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8680 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8681 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8682 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8683
8684 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8685
8686
8687 @node Article Hiding
8688 @subsection Article Hiding
8689 @cindex article hiding
8690
8691 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8692 too much cruft in most articles.
8693
8694 @table @kbd
8695
8696 @item W W a
8697 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8698 @findex gnus-article-hide
8699 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8700 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8701 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8702
8703 @item W W h
8704 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8705 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8706 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8707 Headers}.
8708
8709 @item W W b
8710 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8711 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8712 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8713 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8714
8715 @item W W s
8716 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8717 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8718 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8719 Signature}.
8720
8721 @item W W l
8722 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8723 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8724 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8725 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8726 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8727 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8728 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8729 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8730
8731 @table @code
8732
8733 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8734 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8735 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8736 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8737
8738 @end table
8739
8740 @item W W P
8741 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8742 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8743 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8744 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8745
8746 @item W W B
8747 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8748 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8749 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8750 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8751 @cindex banner
8752 @cindex OneList
8753 @cindex stripping advertisements
8754 @cindex advertisements
8755 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8756 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8757 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8758 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8759 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8760 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8761 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8762 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8763 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8764 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8765 used.
8766
8767 For instance:
8768
8769 @lisp
8770 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8771 ((googleGroups .
8772 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8773 @end lisp
8774
8775 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8776 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8777 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8778
8779 @table @code
8780
8781 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8782 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8783 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8784 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8785 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8786 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8787 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8788 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8789 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8790 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8791 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8792
8793 @lisp
8794 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8795 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8796 @end lisp
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 @item W W c
8801 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8802 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8803 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8804 customizing the hiding:
8805
8806 @table @code
8807
8808 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8809 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8810 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8811 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8812 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8813 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8814 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8815 specs are valid:
8816
8817 @table @samp
8818 @item b
8819 Starting point of the hidden text.
8820 @item e
8821 Ending point of the hidden text.
8822 @item l
8823 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8824 @item n
8825 Number of lines of hidden text.
8826 @end table
8827
8828 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8829 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8830 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8831 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8832 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8833
8834 @end table
8835
8836 @item W W C-c
8837 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8838 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8839
8840 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8841 following two variables:
8842
8843 @table @code
8844 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8845 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8846 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8847 50), hide the cited text.
8848
8849 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8850 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8851 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8852 is hidden.
8853 @end table
8854
8855 @item W W C
8856 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8857 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8858 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8859 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8860 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8861 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8862
8863 @end table
8864
8865 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8866 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8867 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8868
8869 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8870 citation customization.
8871
8872 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8873 automatically.
8874
8875
8876 @node Article Washing
8877 @subsection Article Washing
8878 @cindex washing
8879 @cindex article washing
8880
8881 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8882 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8883
8884 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8885 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8886 Cleaner, perhaps.
8887
8888 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8889 articles by default.
8890
8891 @table @kbd
8892
8893 @item C-u g
8894 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8895 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8896 the server.
8897
8898 @item g
8899 Force redisplaying of the current article
8900 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8901 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8902 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8903 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8904
8905 @item W l
8906 @kindex W l (Summary)
8907 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8908 Remove page breaks from the current article
8909 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8910 delimiters.
8911
8912 @item W r
8913 @kindex W r (Summary)
8914 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8915 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8916 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8917 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8918 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8919 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8920
8921 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8922 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8923 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8924 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8925
8926 @item W m
8927 @kindex W m (Summary)
8928 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8929 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8930
8931 @item W i
8932 @kindex W i (Summary)
8933 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8934 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8935 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8936 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8937 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8938 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8939 to work.
8940
8941 @item W t
8942 @item t
8943 @kindex W t (Summary)
8944 @kindex t (Summary)
8945 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8946 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8947 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8948
8949 @item W v
8950 @kindex W v (Summary)
8951 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8952 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8953 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8954
8955 @item W o
8956 @kindex W o (Summary)
8957 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8958 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8959
8960 @item W d
8961 @kindex W d (Summary)
8962 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8963 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8964 @cindex Smartquotes
8965 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8966 @cindex Latin 1
8967 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8968 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8969 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8970 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8971 interactively.
8972
8973 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8974 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8975 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8976 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8977
8978 @item W U
8979 @kindex W U (Summary)
8980 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8981 @cindex Unicode
8982 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8983 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8984 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8985 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8986 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8987 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8988
8989 @item W Y f
8990 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8991 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8992 @cindex Outlook Express
8993 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8994 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8995 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8996
8997 @item W Y u
8998 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8999 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9000 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9001 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9002 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9003 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9004 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9005 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9006 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9007 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9008
9009 @item W Y a
9010 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9011 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9012 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9013 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9014
9015 @item W Y c
9016 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9017 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9018 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9019 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9020
9021 @item W w
9022 @kindex W w (Summary)
9023 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9024 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9025
9026 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9027 when filling.
9028
9029 @item W Q
9030 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9031 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9032 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9033
9034 @item W C
9035 @kindex W C (Summary)
9036 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9037 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9038 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9039
9040 @item W c
9041 @kindex W c (Summary)
9042 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9043 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9044 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9045 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9046 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9047
9048 @item W q
9049 @kindex W q (Summary)
9050 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9051 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9052 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9053 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9054 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9055 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9056 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9057 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9058 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9059
9060 @item W 6
9061 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9062 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9063 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9064 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9065 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9066 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9067 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9068 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9069
9070 @item W Z
9071 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9072 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9073 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9074 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9075 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9076
9077 @item W A
9078 @kindex W A (Summary)
9079 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9080 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9081 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9082 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9083 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9084
9085 @item W u
9086 @kindex W u (Summary)
9087 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9088 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9089 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9090 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9091 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9092
9093 @item W h
9094 @kindex W h (Summary)
9095 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9096 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9097 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9098 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9099
9100 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9101 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9102 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9103
9104 The default is to use the function specified by
9105 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9106 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9107 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9108
9109 @table @code
9110 @item shr
9111 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9112
9113 @item gnus-w3m
9114 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9115
9116 @item w3
9117 Use Emacs/W3.
9118
9119 @item w3m
9120 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9121
9122 @item w3m-standalone
9123 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9124
9125 @item links
9126 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9127
9128 @item lynx
9129 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9130
9131 @item html2text
9132 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9133
9134 @end table
9135
9136 @item W b
9137 @kindex W b (Summary)
9138 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9139 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9140 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9141
9142 @item W B
9143 @kindex W B (Summary)
9144 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9145 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9146 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9147
9148 @item W p
9149 @kindex W p (Summary)
9150 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9151 Verify a signed control message
9152 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9153 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9154 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9155 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9156 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9157 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9158
9159 @item W s
9160 @kindex W s (Summary)
9161 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9162 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9163 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9164 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9165
9166 @item W a
9167 @kindex W a (Summary)
9168 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9169 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9170 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9171
9172 @item W E l
9173 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9174 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9175 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9176 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9177
9178 @item W E m
9179 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9180 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9181 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9182 lines with a single empty line.
9183 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9184
9185 @item W E t
9186 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9187 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9188 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9189 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9190
9191 @item W E a
9192 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9193 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9194 Do all the three commands above
9195 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9196
9197 @item W E A
9198 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9199 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9200 Remove all blank lines
9201 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9202
9203 @item W E s
9204 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9205 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9206 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9207 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9208
9209 @item W E e
9210 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9211 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9212 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9213 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9214
9215 @end table
9216
9217 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9218
9219
9220 @node Article Header
9221 @subsection Article Header
9222
9223 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9224
9225 @table @kbd
9226
9227 @item W G u
9228 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9229 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9230 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9231
9232 @item W G n
9233 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9234 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9235 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9236 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9237
9238 @item W G f
9239 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9240 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9241 Fold all the message headers
9242 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9243
9244 @item W E w
9245 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9246 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9247 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9248 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9249
9250 @end table
9251
9252
9253 @node Article Buttons
9254 @subsection Article Buttons
9255 @cindex buttons
9256
9257 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9258 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9259 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9260 button on these references.
9261
9262 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9263 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9264 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9265 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9266 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9267
9268 @table @code
9269
9270 @item gnus-button-alist
9271 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9272 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9273
9274 @lisp
9275 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9276 @end lisp
9277
9278 @table @var
9279
9280 @item regexp
9281 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9282 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9283 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9284 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9285 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9286
9287 @item button-par
9288 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9289 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9290 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9291
9292 @item use-p
9293 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9294 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9295 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9296 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9297 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9298
9299 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9300
9301 @item function
9302 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9303
9304 @item data-par
9305 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9306 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9307
9308 @end table
9309
9310 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9311
9312 @lisp
9313 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9314 @end lisp
9315
9316 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9317 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9318 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9319 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9320 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9321
9322 @lisp
9323 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9324 @end lisp
9325
9326 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9327 @end table
9328
9329 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9330
9331 @table @code
9332 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9333 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9334
9335 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9336
9337 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9338 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9339 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9340 default values of the variables above.
9341
9342 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9343
9344 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9345 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9346 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9347 argument with a string naming the man page.
9348
9349 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9350
9351 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9352 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9353 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9354
9355 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9356 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9357 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9358 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9359 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9360 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9361 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9362 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9363 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9364 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9365 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9366 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9367
9368 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9369 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9370 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9371 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9372 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9373 string is invalid.
9374
9375 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9376 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9377 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9378 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9379
9380 @c Misc stuff
9381
9382 @item gnus-article-button-face
9383 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9384 Face used on buttons.
9385
9386 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9387 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9388 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9389
9390 @end table
9391
9392 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9393
9394
9395 @node Article Button Levels
9396 @subsection Article button levels
9397 @cindex button levels
9398 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9399 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9400 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9401 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9402 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9403 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9404 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9405 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9406
9407 @lisp
9408 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9409 (setq gnus-parameters
9410 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9411 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9412 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9413 @end lisp
9414
9415 @table @code
9416
9417 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9418 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9419 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9420 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9421 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9422 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9423
9424 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9425 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9426 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9427 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9431 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9432 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9433 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9434 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9435 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9436 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9437
9438 @item gnus-button-man-level
9439 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9440 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9441 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9442
9443 @item gnus-button-message-level
9444 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9445 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9446 Related variables and functions include
9447 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9448 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9449 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9450 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9451
9452 @end table
9453
9454
9455 @node Article Date
9456 @subsection Article Date
9457
9458 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9459 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9460 when the article was sent.
9461
9462 @table @kbd
9463
9464 @item W T u
9465 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9466 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9467 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9468 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9469
9470 @item W T i
9471 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9472 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9473 @cindex ISO 8601
9474 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9475 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9476
9477 @item W T l
9478 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9479 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9480 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9481
9482 @item W T p
9483 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9484 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9485 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9486 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9487
9488 @item W T s
9489 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9490 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9491 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9492 @findex format-time-string
9493 Display the date using a user-defined format
9494 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9495 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9496 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9497 for a list of possible format specs.
9498
9499 @item W T e
9500 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9501 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9502 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9503 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9504 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9505 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9506
9507 @example
9508 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9509 @end example
9510
9511 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9512 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9513 variable.
9514
9515 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9516
9517 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9518 @lisp
9519 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9520 @end lisp
9521
9522 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9523
9524 @item W T o
9525 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9526 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9527 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9528 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9529 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9530 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9531 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9532
9533 @end table
9534
9535 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9536 preferred format automatically.
9537
9538
9539 @node Article Display
9540 @subsection Article Display
9541 @cindex picons
9542 @cindex x-face
9543 @cindex smileys
9544 @cindex gravatars
9545
9546 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9547 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9548
9549 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9550 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9551
9552 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9553 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9554
9555 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9556 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9557
9558 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9559 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9560
9561 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9562 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9563
9564 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9565 they'll be removed.
9566
9567 @table @kbd
9568 @item W D x
9569 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9570 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9571 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9572 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9573
9574 @item W D d
9575 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9576 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9577 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9578 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9579
9580 @item W D s
9581 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9582 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9583 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9584
9585 @item W D f
9586 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9587 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9588 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9589
9590 @item W D m
9591 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9592 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9593 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9594 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9595
9596 @item W D n
9597 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9598 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9599 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9600 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9601
9602 @item W D g
9603 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9604 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9605 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9606
9607 @item W D h
9608 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9609 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9610 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9611 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9612
9613 @item W D D
9614 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9615 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9616 Remove all images from the article buffer
9617 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9618
9619 @item W D W
9620 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9621 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9622 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9623 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9624 the buffer with this command.
9625 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9626
9627 @end table
9628
9629
9630
9631 @node Article Signature
9632 @subsection Article Signature
9633 @cindex signatures
9634 @cindex article signature
9635
9636 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9637 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9638 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9639 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9640 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9641 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9642 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9643 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9644 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9645
9646 @lisp
9647 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9648 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9649 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9650 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9651 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9652 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9653 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9654 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9655 @end lisp
9656
9657 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9658 positives.
9659
9660 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9661 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9662 signature when displaying articles.
9663
9664 @enumerate
9665 @item
9666 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9667 that integer.
9668 @item
9669 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9670 than that number.
9671 @item
9672 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9673 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9674 @item
9675 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9676 in question is not a signature.
9677 @end enumerate
9678
9679 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9680 listed above. Here's an example:
9681
9682 @lisp
9683 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9684 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9685 @end lisp
9686
9687 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9688 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9689 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9690 signature after all.
9691
9692
9693 @node Article Miscellanea
9694 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9695
9696 @table @kbd
9697 @item A t
9698 @kindex A t (Summary)
9699 @findex gnus-article-babel
9700 Translate the article from one language to another
9701 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9702
9703 @end table
9704
9705
9706 @node MIME Commands
9707 @section MIME Commands
9708 @cindex MIME decoding
9709 @cindex attachments
9710 @cindex viewing attachments
9711
9712 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9713 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9714
9715 @table @kbd
9716 @item b
9717 @itemx K v
9718 @kindex b (Summary)
9719 @kindex K v (Summary)
9720 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9721
9722 @item K o
9723 @kindex K o (Summary)
9724 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9725
9726 @item K O
9727 @kindex K O (Summary)
9728 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9729 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9730 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9731
9732 @item K r
9733 @kindex K r (Summary)
9734 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9735
9736 @item K d
9737 @kindex K d (Summary)
9738 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9739 removed part.
9740
9741 @item K c
9742 @kindex K c (Summary)
9743 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9744
9745 @item K e
9746 @kindex K e (Summary)
9747 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9748
9749 @item K i
9750 @kindex K i (Summary)
9751 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9752
9753 @item K |
9754 @kindex K | (Summary)
9755 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9756 @end table
9757
9758 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9759 the same manner:
9760
9761 @table @kbd
9762 @item K H
9763 @kindex K H (Summary)
9764 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9765 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9766 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9767 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9768 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9769 unless the prefix argument is given.
9770
9771 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9772 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9773 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9774 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9775 trusted senders.
9776
9777 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9778 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9779
9780 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9781 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9782 the group (if you want).
9783
9784 @item K b
9785 @kindex K b (Summary)
9786 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9787 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9788 parts.
9789
9790 @item K m
9791 @kindex K m (Summary)
9792 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9793 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9794 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9795 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9796 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9797
9798 @item X m
9799 @kindex X m (Summary)
9800 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9801 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9802 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9803 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9804
9805 @item M-t
9806 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9807 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9808 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9809 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9810
9811 @item W M w
9812 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9813 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9814 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9815 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9816
9817 @item W M c
9818 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9819 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9820 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9821 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9822
9823 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9824 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9825 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9826 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9827 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9828 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9829
9830 @item W M v
9831 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9832 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9833 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9834 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9835
9836 @end table
9837
9838 Relevant variables:
9839
9840 @table @code
9841 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9842 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9843 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9844 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9845 @code{nil}.
9846
9847 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9848
9849 @lisp
9850 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9851 '("text/x-vcard"))
9852 @end lisp
9853
9854 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9855 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9856 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9857 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9858 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9859 default is @code{t}.
9860
9861 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9862 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9863 @cindex uuencode
9864 @cindex yEnc
9865 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9866 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9867 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9868 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9869 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9870 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9871 for encoding in Gnus.
9872
9873 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9874 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9875 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9876 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9877 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9878 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9879 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9880 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9881
9882 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9883 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9884 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9885 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9886 displayed. This variable overrides
9887 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9888 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9889 is @code{nil}.
9890
9891 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9892 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9893 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9894
9895 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9896 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9897 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9898 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9899 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9900
9901 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9902 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9903 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9904 default value is @code{nil}.
9905
9906 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9907 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9908 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9909 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9910 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9911 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9912 save all jpegs into some directory).
9913
9914 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9915
9916 @lisp
9917 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9918 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9919 (with-temp-buffer
9920 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9921 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9922 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9923 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9924 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9925 @end lisp
9926
9927 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9928 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9929 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9930
9931 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9932 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9933 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9934
9935 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9936 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9937 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9938
9939 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9940 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9941 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9942 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9943 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9944
9945 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9946 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9947 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9948 overrides @code{nil} values of
9949 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9950 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9951
9952 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9953 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9954 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9955 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9956
9957 Ready-made functions include@*
9958 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9959 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9960 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9961 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9962 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9963 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9964 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9965 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9966 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9967 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9968 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9969 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9970
9971 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9972 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9973
9974 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9975 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9976 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9977
9978 @lisp
9979 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9980 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9981 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9982 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9983 @end lisp
9984
9985 @noindent
9986 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9987
9988 @end table
9989
9990
9991 @node Charsets
9992 @section Charsets
9993 @cindex charsets
9994
9995 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9996 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9997 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9998 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9999 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10000 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10001 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10002
10003 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10004 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10005 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10006 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10007
10008 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10009 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10010 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10011 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10012 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10013 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10014 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10015 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10016 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10017
10018 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10019 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10020 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10021 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10022 quoted-printable header encoding.
10023
10024 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10025 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10026 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10027
10028 @table @var
10029 @item test
10030 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10031 variable to query,
10032 @item header
10033 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10034 means encode all charsets),
10035 @item body-list
10036 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10037 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10038 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10039 @end table
10040
10041 @cindex Russian
10042 @cindex koi8-r
10043 @cindex koi8-u
10044 @cindex iso-8859-5
10045 @cindex coding system aliases
10046 @cindex preferred charset
10047
10048 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10049 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10050 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10051
10052 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10053
10054 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10055 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10056
10057 @lisp
10058 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10059 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10060 @end lisp
10061
10062 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10063 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10064
10065 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10066
10067 @lisp
10068 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10069 @end lisp
10070
10071 This will almost do the right thing.
10072
10073 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10074 something like
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (codepage-setup 1251)
10078 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10079 @end lisp
10080
10081
10082 @node Article Commands
10083 @section Article Commands
10084
10085 @table @kbd
10086
10087 @item A P
10088 @cindex PostScript
10089 @cindex printing
10090 @kindex A P (Summary)
10091 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10092 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10093 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10094 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10095 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10096 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10097
10098 @item A C
10099 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10100 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10101 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10102 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10103 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10104 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10105 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10106 do so.
10107
10108 @end table
10109
10110
10111 @node Summary Sorting
10112 @section Summary Sorting
10113 @cindex summary sorting
10114
10115 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10116 can't really see why you'd want that.
10117
10118 @table @kbd
10119
10120 @item C-c C-s C-n
10121 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10122 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10123 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10124
10125 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10126 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10127 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10128 Sort by most recent article number
10129 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10130
10131 @item C-c C-s C-a
10132 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10133 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10134 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10135
10136 @item C-c C-s C-t
10137 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10138 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10139 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10140
10141 @item C-c C-s C-s
10142 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10143 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10144 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10145
10146 @item C-c C-s C-d
10147 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10148 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10149 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10150
10151 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10152 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10153 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10154 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10155
10156 @item C-c C-s C-l
10157 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10158 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10159 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10160
10161 @item C-c C-s C-c
10162 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10163 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10164 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10165
10166 @item C-c C-s C-i
10167 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10168 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10169 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10170
10171 @item C-c C-s C-r
10172 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10173 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10174 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10175
10176 @item C-c C-s C-o
10177 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10178 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10179 Sort using the default sorting method
10180 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10181 @end table
10182
10183 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10184 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10185 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10186 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10187 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10188 Commands}).
10189
10190 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10191
10192
10193 @node Finding the Parent
10194 @section Finding the Parent
10195 @cindex parent articles
10196 @cindex referring articles
10197
10198 @table @kbd
10199 @item ^
10200 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10201 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10202 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10203 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10204 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10205 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10206 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10207 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10208 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10209 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10210
10211 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10212 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10213 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10214 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10215 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10216 article.
10217
10218 @item A R (Summary)
10219 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10220 @kindex A R (Summary)
10221 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10222 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10223
10224 @item A T (Summary)
10225 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10226 @kindex A T (Summary)
10227 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10228 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10229 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10230 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10231 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10232 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10233 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10234
10235 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10236 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10237 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10238 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10239 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10240 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10241
10242 @item M-^ (Summary)
10243 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10244 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10245 @cindex Message-ID
10246 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10247 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10248 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10249 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10250 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10251 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10252
10253 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10254 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10255 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10256 @end table
10257
10258 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10259 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10260 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10261 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10262 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10263 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10264 necessary.
10265
10266 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10267 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10268 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10269 match.
10270
10271 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10272 then ask Google if that fails:
10273
10274 @lisp
10275 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10276 '(current
10277 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10278 @end lisp
10279
10280 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10281 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10282 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10283 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10284 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10285 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10286
10287 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10288 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10289 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10290 registry}).
10291
10292 @node Alternative Approaches
10293 @section Alternative Approaches
10294
10295 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10296 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10297
10298 @menu
10299 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10300 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10301 @end menu
10302
10303
10304 @node Pick and Read
10305 @subsection Pick and Read
10306 @cindex pick and read
10307
10308 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10309 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10310 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10311 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10312
10313 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10314 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10315 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10316 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10317 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10318 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10319
10320 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10321
10322 @table @kbd
10323 @item .
10324 @kindex . (Pick)
10325 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10326 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10327 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10328 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10329 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10330 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10331 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10332 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10333
10334 @item SPACE
10335 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10336 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10337 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10338 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10339
10340 @item u
10341 @kindex u (Pick)
10342 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10343 Unpick the thread or article
10344 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10345 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10346 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10347 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10348 the thread or article at that line.
10349
10350 @item RET
10351 @kindex RET (Pick)
10352 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10353 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10354 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10355 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10356 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10357 will still be visible when you are reading.
10358
10359 @end table
10360
10361 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10362 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10363 which is mapped to the same function
10364 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10365
10366 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10367
10368 @lisp
10369 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10370 @end lisp
10371
10372 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10373 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10374
10375 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10376 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10377 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10378
10379 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10380 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10381 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10382 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10383 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10384 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10385 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10386
10387
10388 @node Binary Groups
10389 @subsection Binary Groups
10390 @cindex binary groups
10391
10392 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10393 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10394 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10395 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10396 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10397 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10398 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10399
10400 @kindex g (Binary)
10401 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10402 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10403 command, when you have turned on this mode
10404 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10405
10406 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10407 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10408
10409
10410 @node Tree Display
10411 @section Tree Display
10412 @cindex trees
10413
10414 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10415 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10416 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10417 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10418 in the tree buffer.
10419
10420 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10421
10422 @table @code
10423 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10424 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10425 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10426
10427 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10428 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10429 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10430 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10431 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10432
10433 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10434 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10435 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10436 default is @code{modeline}.
10437
10438 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10439 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10440 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10441 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10442 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10443 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10444 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10445
10446 Valid specs are:
10447
10448 @table @samp
10449 @item n
10450 The name of the poster.
10451 @item f
10452 The @code{From} header.
10453 @item N
10454 The number of the article.
10455 @item [
10456 The opening bracket.
10457 @item ]
10458 The closing bracket.
10459 @item s
10460 The subject.
10461 @end table
10462
10463 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10464
10465 Variables related to the display are:
10466
10467 @table @code
10468 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10469 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10470 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10471 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10472 @example
10473 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10474 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10475 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10476 @end example
10477 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10478
10479 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10480 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10481 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10482 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10483
10484 @end table
10485
10486 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10487 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10488 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10489 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10490 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10491 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10492 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10493 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10494 other windows displayed next to it.
10495
10496 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10497 at all times:
10498
10499 @lisp
10500 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10501 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10502 @end lisp
10503
10504 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10505 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10506 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10507 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10508 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10509 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10510 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10511
10512 @end table
10513
10514 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10515
10516 @example
10517 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10518 | \[Jan]
10519 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10520 | \(***)-[Eri]
10521 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10522 \[Bjo]
10523 \[Gun]
10524 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10525 @end example
10526
10527 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10528
10529 @example
10530 @group
10531 @{***@}
10532 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10533 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10534 |--\-----\-----\ |
10535 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10536 | | |--\
10537 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10538 |
10539 [Paa]
10540 @end group
10541 @end example
10542
10543 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10544 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10545 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10546
10547 @lisp
10548 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10549 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10550 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10551 (gnus-add-configuration
10552 '(article
10553 (vertical 1.0
10554 (horizontal 0.25
10555 (summary 0.75 point)
10556 (tree 1.0))
10557 (article 1.0))))
10558 @end lisp
10559
10560 @xref{Window Layout}.
10561
10562
10563 @node Mail Group Commands
10564 @section Mail Group Commands
10565 @cindex mail group commands
10566
10567 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10568 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10569
10570 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10571 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10572
10573 @table @kbd
10574
10575 @item B e
10576 @kindex B e (Summary)
10577 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10578 @cindex expiring mail
10579 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10580 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10581 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10582 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10583
10584 @item B C-M-e
10585 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10586 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10587 @cindex expiring mail
10588 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10589 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10590 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10591 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10592
10593 @item B DEL
10594 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10595 @cindex deleting mail
10596 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10597 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10598 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10599 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10600 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10601
10602 @item B m
10603 @kindex B m (Summary)
10604 @cindex move mail
10605 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10606 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10607 Move the article from one mail group to another
10608 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10609 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10610
10611 @item B c
10612 @kindex B c (Summary)
10613 @cindex copy mail
10614 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10615 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10616 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10617 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10618 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10619
10620 @item B B
10621 @kindex B B (Summary)
10622 @cindex crosspost mail
10623 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10624 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10625 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10626 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10627 be properly updated.
10628
10629 @item B i
10630 @kindex B i (Summary)
10631 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10632 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10633 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10634 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10635
10636 @item B I
10637 @kindex B I (Summary)
10638 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10639 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10640 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10641 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10642
10643 @item B r
10644 @kindex B r (Summary)
10645 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10646 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10647 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10648 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10649 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10650 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10651 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10652 (which is the default).
10653
10654 @item B w
10655 @itemx e
10656 @kindex B w (Summary)
10657 @kindex e (Summary)
10658 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10659 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10660 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10661 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10662 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10663 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10664 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10665
10666 @item B q
10667 @kindex B q (Summary)
10668 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10669 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10670 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10671 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10672
10673 @item B t
10674 @kindex B t (Summary)
10675 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10676 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10677 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10678
10679 @item B p
10680 @kindex B p (Summary)
10681 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10682 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10683 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10684 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10685 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10686 article from your news server (or rather, from
10687 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10688 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10689 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10690 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10691 just not have arrived yet.
10692
10693 @item K E
10694 @kindex K E (Summary)
10695 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10696 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10697 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10698 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10699 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10700
10701 @end table
10702
10703 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10704 @cindex moving articles
10705 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10706 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10707 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10708 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10709 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10710 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10711 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10712
10713 @lisp
10714 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10715 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10716 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10717 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10718 @end lisp
10719
10720
10721 @node Various Summary Stuff
10722 @section Various Summary Stuff
10723
10724 @menu
10725 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10726 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10727 * Summary Generation Commands::
10728 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10729 @end menu
10730
10731 @table @code
10732 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10733 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10734 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10735 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10736 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10737 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10738
10739 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10740 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10741 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10742 current article.
10743
10744 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10745 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10746 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10747
10748 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10749 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10750 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10751 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10752 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10753 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10754 have been set.
10755
10756 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10757 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10758 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10759 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10760 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10761
10762 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10763 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10764 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10765 generated.
10766
10767 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10768 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10769 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10770 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10771 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10772 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10773 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10774 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10775 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10776 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10777
10778 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10779 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10780 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10781 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10782 list of articles to be selected.
10783
10784 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10785 the list in one particular group:
10786
10787 @lisp
10788 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10789 (if (string= group "some.group")
10790 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10791 articles))
10792 @end lisp
10793
10794 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10795 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10796 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10797 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10798 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10799 buffer is active.
10800
10801 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10802 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10803 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10804 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10805 variable will be used instead.
10806
10807 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10808 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10809 buffers. For example:
10810
10811 @lisp
10812 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10813 '(message-use-followup-to
10814 (gnus-visible-headers .
10815 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10816 @end lisp
10817
10818 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10819
10820 @end table
10821
10822
10823 @node Summary Group Information
10824 @subsection Summary Group Information
10825
10826 @table @kbd
10827
10828 @item H d
10829 @kindex H d (Summary)
10830 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10831 Give a brief description of the current group
10832 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10833 rereading the description from the server.
10834
10835 @item H h
10836 @kindex H h (Summary)
10837 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10838 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10839 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10840
10841 @item H i
10842 @kindex H i (Summary)
10843 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10844 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10845 @end table
10846
10847
10848 @node Searching for Articles
10849 @subsection Searching for Articles
10850
10851 @table @kbd
10852
10853 @item M-s
10854 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10855 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10856 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10857 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10858
10859 @item M-r
10860 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10861 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10862 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10863 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10864
10865 @item M-S
10866 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10867 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10868 Repeat the previous search forwards
10869 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10870
10871 @item M-R
10872 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10873 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10874 Repeat the previous search backwards
10875 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10876
10877 @item &
10878 @kindex & (Summary)
10879 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10880 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10881 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10882 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10883 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10884 search backward instead.
10885
10886 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10887 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10888
10889 @item M-&
10890 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10891 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10892 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10893 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10894 @end table
10895
10896 @node Summary Generation Commands
10897 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10898
10899 @table @kbd
10900
10901 @item Y g
10902 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10903 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10904 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10905
10906 @item Y c
10907 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10908 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10909 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10910 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10911
10912 @item Y d
10913 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10914 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10915 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10916 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10917
10918 @item Y t
10919 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10920 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10921 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10922 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10923
10924 @end table
10925
10926
10927 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10928 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10929
10930 @table @kbd
10931
10932 @item A D
10933 @itemx C-d
10934 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10935 @kindex A D (Summary)
10936 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10937 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10938 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10939 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10940 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10941 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10942 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10943 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10944 fashion.
10945
10946 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10947 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10948 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10949 include:
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @item next
10953 Select the next article.
10954
10955 @item next-unread
10956 Select the next unread article.
10957
10958 @item next-noselect
10959 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10960
10961 @item next-unread-noselect
10962 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10963 @end table
10964
10965 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10966 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10967
10968 @item C-M-d
10969 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10970 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10971 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10972 several documents into one biiig group
10973 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10974 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10975 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10976 command understands the process/prefix convention
10977 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10978
10979 @item C-t
10980 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10981 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10982 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10983 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10984 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10985 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10986
10987 @item =
10988 @kindex = (Summary)
10989 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10990 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10991 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10992
10993 @item C-M-e
10994 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10995 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10996 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10997 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10998
10999 @item C-M-a
11000 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11001 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11002 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11003 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11004
11005 @end table
11006
11007
11008 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11009 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11010 @cindex summary exit
11011 @cindex exiting groups
11012
11013 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11014 group and return you to the group buffer.
11015
11016 @table @kbd
11017
11018 @item Z Z
11019 @itemx Z Q
11020 @itemx q
11021 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11022 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11023 @kindex q (Summary)
11024 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11025 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11026 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11027 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11028 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11029 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11030 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11031 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11032 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11033 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11034 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11035 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11036
11037 @item Z E
11038 @itemx Q
11039 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11040 @kindex Q (Summary)
11041 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11042 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11043 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11044
11045 @item Z c
11046 @itemx c
11047 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11048 @kindex c (Summary)
11049 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11050 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11051 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11052 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11053
11054 @item Z C
11055 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11056 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11057 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11058 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11059
11060 @item Z n
11061 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11063 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11064 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11065
11066 @item Z p
11067 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11069 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11070 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11071
11072 @item Z R
11073 @itemx C-x C-s
11074 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11075 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11076 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11077 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11078 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11079 all articles, both read and unread.
11080
11081 @item Z G
11082 @itemx M-g
11083 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11084 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11085 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11086 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11087 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11088 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11089 articles, both read and unread.
11090
11091 @item Z N
11092 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11093 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11094 Exit the group and go to the next group
11095 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11096
11097 @item Z P
11098 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11099 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11100 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11101 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11102
11103 @item Z s
11104 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11105 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11106 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11107 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11108 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11109 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11110 @end table
11111
11112 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11113 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11114 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11115 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11116
11117 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11118 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11119 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11120 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11121 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11122 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11123 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11124 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11125 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11126 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11127 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11128 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11129
11130 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11131
11132 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11133 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11134 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
11135 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11136 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11137 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11138 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11139 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11140 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11141
11142
11143 @node Crosspost Handling
11144 @section Crosspost Handling
11145
11146 @cindex velveeta
11147 @cindex spamming
11148 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11149 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11150 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11151 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11152 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11153 heinous crime.
11154
11155 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11156 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11157 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11158 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11159 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11160
11161 @cindex cross-posting
11162 @cindex Xref
11163 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11164 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11165 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11166 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11167 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11168 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11169 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11170 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11171 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11172 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11173 the cross reference mechanism.
11174
11175 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11176 @cindex overview.fmt
11177 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11178 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11179 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11180 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11181 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11182 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11183 overview files.
11184
11185 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11186 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11187 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11188
11189 C'est la vie.
11190
11191 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11192
11193
11194 @node Duplicate Suppression
11195 @section Duplicate Suppression
11196
11197 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11198 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11199 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11200 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11201 reasons.
11202
11203 @enumerate
11204 @item
11205 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11206 is evil and not very common.
11207
11208 @item
11209 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11210 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11211
11212 @item
11213 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11214 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11215
11216 @item
11217 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11218 @end enumerate
11219
11220 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11221 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11222
11223 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11224 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11225 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11226 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11227 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11228 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11229 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11230 once.
11231
11232 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11233 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11234 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11235 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11236 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11237 saw the article in.
11238
11239 @table @code
11240 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11241 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11242 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11243
11244 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11245 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11246 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11247 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11248 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11249 session are suppressed.
11250
11251 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11252 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11253 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11254 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11255
11256 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11257 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11258 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11259 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11260 @end table
11261
11262 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11263 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11264 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11265 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11266 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11267 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11268 to you to figure out, I think.
11269
11270 @node Security
11271 @section Security
11272
11273 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11274 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11275 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11276 things to work:
11277
11278 @enumerate
11279 @item
11280 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11281 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11282 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11283 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11284 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11285
11286 @item
11287 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11288 or newer is recommended.
11289
11290 @end enumerate
11291
11292 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11293 messages include:
11294
11295 @table @code
11296 @item mm-verify-option
11297 @vindex mm-verify-option
11298 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11299 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11300 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11301
11302 @item mm-decrypt-option
11303 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11304 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11305 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11306 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11307
11308 @item mm-sign-option
11309 @vindex mm-sign-option
11310 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11311 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11312
11313 @item mm-encrypt-option
11314 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11315 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11316 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11317 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11318
11319 @item mml1991-use
11320 @vindex mml1991-use
11321 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11322 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11323 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11324 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11325 this order.
11326
11327 @item mml2015-use
11328 @vindex mml2015-use
11329 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11330 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11331 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11332 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11333 interface in this order.
11334
11335 @end table
11336
11337 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11338 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11339 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11340 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11341 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11342 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11343 how to customize these variables to always display security
11344 information.
11345
11346 @cindex snarfing keys
11347 @cindex importing PGP keys
11348 @cindex PGP key ring import
11349 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11350 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11351 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11352 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11353 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11354 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11355 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11356 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11357 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11358
11359 @example
11360 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11361 @end example
11362 @noindent
11363 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11364 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11365
11366 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11367 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11368 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11369
11370 @node Mailing List
11371 @section Mailing List
11372 @cindex mailing list
11373 @cindex RFC 2396
11374
11375 @kindex A M (summary)
11376 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11377 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11378 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11379 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11380 summary buffer.
11381
11382 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11383
11384 @table @kbd
11385
11386 @item C-c C-n h
11387 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11388 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11389 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11390
11391 @item C-c C-n s
11392 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11393 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11394 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11395
11396 @item C-c C-n u
11397 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11398 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11399 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11400 field exists.
11401
11402 @item C-c C-n p
11403 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11404 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11405 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11406
11407 @item C-c C-n o
11408 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11409 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11410 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11411
11412 @item C-c C-n a
11413 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11414 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11415 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11416
11417 @end table
11418
11419
11420 @node Article Buffer
11421 @chapter Article Buffer
11422 @cindex article buffer
11423
11424 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11425 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11426 tell Gnus otherwise.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11430 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11431 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11432 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11433 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11434 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11435 @end menu
11436
11437
11438 @node Hiding Headers
11439 @section Hiding Headers
11440 @cindex hiding headers
11441 @cindex deleting headers
11442
11443 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11444 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11445
11446 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11447 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11448 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11449 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11450 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11451 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11452 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11453 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11454 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11455
11456 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11457
11458 @table @code
11459
11460 @item gnus-visible-headers
11461 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11462 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11463 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11464 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11465
11466 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11467 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11468
11469 @lisp
11470 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11471 @end lisp
11472
11473 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11474 remain visible.
11475
11476 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11477 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11478 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11479 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11480 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11481 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11482
11483 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11484 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11485
11486 @lisp
11487 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11488 @end lisp
11489
11490 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11491 be removed.
11492
11493 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11494 variable will have no effect.
11495
11496 @end table
11497
11498 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11499 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11500 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11501 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11502 the headers are to be displayed.
11503
11504 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11505 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11506
11507 @lisp
11508 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11509 @end lisp
11510
11511 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11512 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11513
11514 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11515 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11516 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11517 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11518 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11519 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11520 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11521 from sight.
11522
11523 These conditions are:
11524 @table @code
11525 @item empty
11526 Remove all empty headers.
11527 @item followup-to
11528 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11529 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11530 @item reply-to
11531 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11532 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11533 parameter is set.
11534 @item newsgroups
11535 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11536 name.
11537 @item to-address
11538 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11539 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11540 @item to-list
11541 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11542 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11543 @item cc-list
11544 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11545 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11546 @item date
11547 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11548 old.
11549 @item long-to
11550 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11551 @item many-to
11552 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11553 @end table
11554
11555 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11556
11557 @lisp
11558 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11559 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11560 @end lisp
11561
11562 This is also the default value for this variable.
11563
11564
11565 @node Using MIME
11566 @section Using MIME
11567 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11568
11569 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11570 while people stand around yawning.
11571
11572 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11573 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11574
11575 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11576 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11577 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11578
11579 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11580 @findex gnus-display-mime
11581 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11582 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11583 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11584 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11585
11586 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11587 @acronym{MIME} button:
11588
11589 @table @kbd
11590 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11591 @item RET (Article)
11592 @kindex RET (Article)
11593 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11594 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11595 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11596 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11597 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11598 object is displayed inline.
11599
11600 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11601 @item M-RET (Article)
11602 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11603 @itemx v (Article)
11604 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11605 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11606
11607 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11608 @item t (Article)
11609 @kindex t (Article)
11610 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11611 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11612
11613 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11614 @item C (Article)
11615 @kindex C (Article)
11616 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11617 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11618
11619 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11620 @item o (Article)
11621 @kindex o (Article)
11622 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11623 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11624
11625 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11626 @item C-o (Article)
11627 @kindex C-o (Article)
11628 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11629 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11630 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11631 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11632 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11633 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11634
11635 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11636 @item r (Article)
11637 @kindex r (Article)
11638 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11639 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11640 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11641
11642 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11643 @item d (Article)
11644 @kindex d (Article)
11645 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11646 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11647 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11648
11649 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11650
11651 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11652 @item c (Article)
11653 @kindex c (Article)
11654 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11655 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11656 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11657 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11658 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11659 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11660 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11661 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11662
11663 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11664 @item p (Article)
11665 @kindex p (Article)
11666 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11667 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11668 @file{.mailcap} file.
11669
11670 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11671 @item i (Article)
11672 @kindex i (Article)
11673 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11674 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11675 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11676 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11677 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11678 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11679 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11680 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11681 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11682
11683 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11684 @item E (Article)
11685 @kindex E (Article)
11686 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11687 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11688 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11689
11690 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11691 @item e (Article)
11692 @kindex e (Article)
11693 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11694 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11695
11696 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11697 @item | (Article)
11698 @kindex | (Article)
11699 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11700
11701 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11702 @item . (Article)
11703 @kindex . (Article)
11704 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11705 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11706
11707 @end table
11708
11709 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11710 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11711 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11712
11713 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11714 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11715 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11716 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11717 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11718 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11719 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11720 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11721 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11722
11723 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11724
11725 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11726
11727
11728 @node HTML
11729 @section @acronym{HTML}
11730 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11731
11732 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11733 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11734 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11735 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11736
11737 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11738 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11739 section only describes the default method.
11740
11741 @table @code
11742 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11743 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11744 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11745 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11746
11747 @item gnus-blocked-images
11748 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11749 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11750 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11751 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11752
11753 @lisp
11754 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11755 @end lisp
11756
11757 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11758 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11759 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11760 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11761 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11762 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11763
11764 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11765
11766 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11767 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11768 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11769 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11770 this directory.
11771
11772 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11773 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11774 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11775 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11776
11777 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11778 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11779 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11780
11781 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11782 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11783 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11784 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11785 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11786 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11787 fit these criteria.
11788
11789 @end table
11790
11791 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11792 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11793 automatically.
11794
11795
11796
11797 @node Customizing Articles
11798 @section Customizing Articles
11799 @cindex article customization
11800
11801 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11802 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11803 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11804 called automatically when you select the articles.
11805
11806 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11807 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11808 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11809 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11810
11811 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11812 for sensible values.
11813
11814 @enumerate
11815 @item
11816 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11817
11818 @item
11819 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11820
11821 @item
11822 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11823
11824 @item
11825 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11826
11827 @item
11828 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11829
11830 @item
11831 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11832 than this number.
11833
11834 @item
11835 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11836 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11837 regexps in the list.
11838
11839 @item
11840 A list where the first element is not a string:
11841
11842 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11843 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11844 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11845
11846 @lisp
11847 (or last
11848 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11849 @end lisp
11850
11851 @end enumerate
11852
11853 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11854 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11855 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11856 considered to contain just a single part.
11857
11858 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11859 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11860 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11861 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11862 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11863 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11864 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11865
11866 @ifinfo
11867 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11868 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11869 @c `i foo-bar'.
11870 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11911 @end ifinfo
11912
11913 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11914 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11915 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11916 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11917
11918 @table @code
11919 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11920 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11921
11922 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11923
11924 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11925 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11930 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11931 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11932 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11933 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11934
11935 @xref{Article Washing}.
11936
11937 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11938
11939 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11940 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11941 headers to display. The formats available are:
11942
11943 @table @code
11944 @item ut
11945 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11946
11947 @item local
11948 The user's local time zone.
11949
11950 @item english
11951 A semi-readable English sentence.
11952
11953 @item lapsed
11954 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11955
11956 @item combined-lapsed
11957 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11958
11959 @item original
11960 The original date header.
11961
11962 @item iso8601
11963 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11964
11965 @item user-defined
11966 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11967 variable.
11968
11969 @end table
11970
11971 @xref{Article Date}.
11972
11973 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11974 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11975 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11976
11977 @xref{Picons}.
11978
11979 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11980 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11981
11982 @xref{Gravatars}.
11983
11984 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11985
11986 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11987
11988 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11989 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11990 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11991
11992 @xref{Smileys}.
11993
11994 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11995 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11996
11997 @xref{X-Face}.
11998
11999 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12000 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12001
12002 @xref{Face}.
12003
12004 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12005 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12006 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12007 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12008 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12009 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12010 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12011 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12012 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12013 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12014 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12015 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12016 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12017 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12018 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12019 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12020 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12021 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12022 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12023 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12024
12025 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12026
12027 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12028 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12029 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12030 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12031 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12032 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12033
12034 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12035
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12037 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12038 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12039 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12040 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12041
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12043 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12044 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12045 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12046 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12047 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12048 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12049 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12050
12051 @xref{Article Header}.
12052
12053
12054 @end table
12055
12056 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12057 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12058 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12059 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12060 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12061 everything.
12062
12063
12064 @node Article Keymap
12065 @section Article Keymap
12066
12067 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12068 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12069 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12070 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12071 buffer.
12072
12073 @kindex v (Article)
12074 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12075 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12076 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12077
12078 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12079
12080 @table @kbd
12081
12082 @item SPACE
12083 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12084 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12085 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12086 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12087
12088 @item DEL
12089 @kindex DEL (Article)
12090 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12091 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12092 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12093
12094 @item C-c ^
12095 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12096 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12097 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12098 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12099 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12100
12101 @item C-c C-m
12102 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12103 @findex gnus-article-mail
12104 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12105 given a prefix, include the mail.
12106
12107 @item s
12108 @kindex s (Article)
12109 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12110 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12111 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12112
12113 @item ?
12114 @kindex ? (Article)
12115 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12116 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12117 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12118
12119 @item TAB
12120 @kindex TAB (Article)
12121 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12122 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12123 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12124
12125 @item M-TAB
12126 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12127 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12128 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12129
12130 @item R
12131 @kindex R (Article)
12132 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12133 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12134 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12135 only yank the text in the region.
12136
12137 @item S W
12138 @kindex S W (Article)
12139 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12140 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12141 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12142 active, only yank the text in the region.
12143
12144 @item F
12145 @kindex F (Article)
12146 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12147 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12148 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12149 only yank the text in the region.
12150
12151
12152 @end table
12153
12154
12155 @node Misc Article
12156 @section Misc Article
12157
12158 @table @code
12159
12160 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12161 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12162 @cindex article buffers, several
12163 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12164 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12165 article buffer.
12166
12167 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12168 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12169 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12170 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12171
12172 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12173 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12174 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12175 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12176 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12177
12178 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12179 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12180 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12181 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12182 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12183 the contents of the article buffer.
12184
12185 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12186 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12187 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12188
12189 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12190 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12191 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12192 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12193
12194 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12195 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12196 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12197 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12198
12199 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12200 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12201 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12202 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12203 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12204 with two extensions:
12205
12206 @table @samp
12207
12208 @item w
12209 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12210 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12211 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12212
12213 @table @samp
12214
12215 @item c
12216 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12217
12218 @item h
12219 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12220
12221 @item p
12222 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12223 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12224 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12225
12226 @item s
12227 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12228
12229 @item o
12230 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12231
12232 @item e
12233 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12234
12235 @end table
12236
12237 @item m
12238 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12239
12240 @end table
12241
12242 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12243
12244 @item gnus-break-pages
12245 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12246 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12247 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12248 paging will not be done.
12249
12250 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12251 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12252 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12253 (formfeed).
12254
12255 @cindex IDNA
12256 @cindex internationalized domain names
12257 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12258 @item gnus-use-idna
12259 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12260 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12261 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12262 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12263 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12264 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12265
12266 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12267 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12268 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12269 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12270 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12271 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12272 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12273 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12274
12275 @end table
12276
12277
12278 @node Composing Messages
12279 @chapter Composing Messages
12280 @cindex composing messages
12281 @cindex messages
12282 @cindex mail
12283 @cindex sending mail
12284 @cindex reply
12285 @cindex followup
12286 @cindex post
12287 @cindex using gpg
12288 @cindex using s/mime
12289 @cindex using smime
12290
12291 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12292 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12293 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12294 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12295 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12296 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12297
12298 @menu
12299 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12300 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12301 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12302 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12303 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12304 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12305 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12306 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12307 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12308 @end menu
12309
12310 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12311 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12312
12313
12314 @node Mail
12315 @section Mail
12316
12317 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12318
12319 @table @code
12320 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12321 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12322 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12323 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12324 @code{nil} include all headers.
12325
12326 @item gnus-add-to-list
12327 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12328 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12329 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12330
12331 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12332 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12333 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12334 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12335 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12336 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12337 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12338 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12339
12340 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12341 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12342
12343 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12344 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12345 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12346 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12347 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12348
12349 @end table
12350
12351
12352 @node Posting Server
12353 @section Posting Server
12354
12355 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12356 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12357
12358 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12359
12360 It can be quite complicated.
12361
12362 @vindex gnus-post-method
12363 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12364 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12365 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12366 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12367 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12368 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12369 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12370 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12371 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12372
12373 @lisp
12374 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12375 @end lisp
12376
12377 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12378 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12379 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12380 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12381
12382 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12383 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12384
12385 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12386 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12387 for posting.
12388
12389 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12390 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12391
12392 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12393 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12394 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12395 value suitable for your system.
12396 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12397 information.
12398
12399
12400 @node POP before SMTP
12401 @section POP before SMTP
12402 @cindex pop before smtp
12403 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12404
12405 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12406 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12407 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12408 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12409
12410 @lisp
12411 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12412 @end lisp
12413
12414 @noindent
12415 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12416 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12417 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12418
12419 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12420 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12421 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12422 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12423 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12424 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12425
12426 @lisp
12427 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12428 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12429 :password "secret"))
12430 @end lisp
12431
12432 @noindent
12433 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12434 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12435
12436 @lisp
12437 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12438 (lambda ()
12439 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12440 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12441 :password "secret")))
12442 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12443 @end lisp
12444
12445
12446 @node Mail and Post
12447 @section Mail and Post
12448
12449 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12450 posting:
12451
12452 @table @code
12453 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12454 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12455 @cindex mailing lists
12456
12457 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12458 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12459 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12460 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12461 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12462 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12463 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12464 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12465 still a pain, though.
12466
12467 @item gnus-user-agent
12468 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12469 @cindex User-Agent
12470
12471 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12472 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12473 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12474 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12475 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12476 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12477 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12478
12479 @end table
12480
12481 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12482 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12483 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12484
12485 @cindex ispell
12486 @findex ispell-message
12487 @lisp
12488 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12489 @end lisp
12490
12491 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12492 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12493
12494 @lisp
12495 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12496 (lambda ()
12497 (cond
12498 ((string-match
12499 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12500 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12501 (t
12502 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12503 @end lisp
12504
12505 Modify to suit your needs.
12506
12507 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12508 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12509 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12510 mode buffers.
12511
12512 @node Archived Messages
12513 @section Archived Messages
12514 @cindex archived messages
12515 @cindex sent messages
12516
12517 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12518 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12519 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12520 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12521 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12522
12523 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12524 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12525 Group Commands}).
12526
12527 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12528 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12529 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12530 actually being used it is expanded into:
12531
12532 @lisp
12533 (nnfolder "archive"
12534 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12535 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12536 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12537 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12538 @end lisp
12539
12540 @quotation
12541 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12542 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12543 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12544 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12545 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12546 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12547 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12548 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12549 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12550 saved method to reflect always the value of
12551 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12552 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12553 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12554 @end quotation
12555
12556 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12557 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12558 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12559 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12560
12561 @lisp
12562 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12563 '(nnfolder "archive"
12564 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12565 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12566 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12567 @end lisp
12568
12569 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12570 @cindex Gcc
12571 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12572 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12573 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12574
12575 This variable can be used to do the following:
12576
12577 @table @asis
12578 @item a string
12579 Messages will be saved in that group.
12580
12581 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12582 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12583 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12584 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12585 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12586 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12587 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12588 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12589 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12590
12591 @item a list of strings
12592 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12593
12594 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12595 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12596
12597 @item @code{nil}
12598 No message archiving will take place.
12599 @end table
12600
12601 Let's illustrate:
12602
12603 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12604 @lisp
12605 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12606 @end lisp
12607
12608 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12609 @lisp
12610 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12611 @end lisp
12612
12613 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12614 @lisp
12615 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12616 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12617 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12618 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12619 @end lisp
12620
12621 More complex stuff:
12622 @lisp
12623 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12624 '((if (message-news-p)
12625 "misc-news"
12626 "misc-mail")))
12627 @end lisp
12628
12629 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12630 messages in one file per month:
12631
12632 @lisp
12633 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12634 '((if (message-news-p)
12635 "misc-news"
12636 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12637 @end lisp
12638
12639 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12640 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12641 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12642 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12643 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12644 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12645 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12646 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12647 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12648 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12649
12650 @table @code
12651 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12652 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12653 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12654
12655 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12656 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12657 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12658 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12659 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12660 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12661 changed in the future.
12662
12663 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12664 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12665 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12666 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12667 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12668 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12669
12670 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12671 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12672 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12673 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12674 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12675 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12676 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12677 except for the current group.
12678
12679 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12680 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12681 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12682 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12683
12684 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12685 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12686 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12687 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12688 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12689 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12690 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12691
12692 @end table
12693
12694
12695 @node Posting Styles
12696 @section Posting Styles
12697 @cindex posting styles
12698 @cindex styles
12699
12700 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12701
12702 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12703 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12704 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12705 on?
12706
12707 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12708 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12709 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12710 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12711 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12712 variable:
12713
12714 @lisp
12715 ((".*"
12716 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12717 (organization "What me?"))
12718 ("^comp"
12719 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12720 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12721 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12722 @end lisp
12723
12724 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12725 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12726 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12727 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12728 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12729 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12730 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12731 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12732
12733 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12734 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12735 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12736 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12737 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12738 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12739 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12740 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12741 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12742 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12743 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12744 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12745 said to @dfn{match}.
12746
12747 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12748 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12749 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12750 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12751 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12752 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12753 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12754 name can be one of:
12755
12756 @itemize @bullet
12757 @item @code{signature}
12758 @item @code{signature-file}
12759 @item @code{x-face-file}
12760 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12761 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12762 @item @code{body}
12763 @end itemize
12764
12765 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12766 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12767
12768 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12769 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12770 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12771 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12772 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12773
12774 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12775 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12776 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12777 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12778 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12779 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12780 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12781 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12782
12783 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12784 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12785 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12786 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12787 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12788
12789 @vindex message-reply-headers
12790
12791 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12792 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12793 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12794
12795 @findex message-mail-p
12796 @findex message-news-p
12797
12798 So here's a new example:
12799
12800 @lisp
12801 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12802 '((".*"
12803 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12804 (name "User Name")
12805 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12806 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12807 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12808 ("^rec.humor"
12809 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12810 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12811 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12812 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12813 (signature my-news-signature))
12814 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12815 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12816 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12817 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12818 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12819 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12820 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12821 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12822 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12823 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12824 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12825 ("nnml:.*"
12826 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12827 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12828 ("^nn.+:"
12829 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12830 @end lisp
12831
12832 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12833 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12834 if you fill many roles.
12835 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12836 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12837
12838 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12839 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12840 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12841 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12842 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12843
12844
12845 @node Drafts
12846 @section Drafts
12847 @cindex drafts
12848
12849 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12850 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12851 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12852 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12853 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12854
12855 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12856 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12857 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12858 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12859 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12860 group.)
12861
12862 @cindex nndraft
12863 @vindex nndraft-directory
12864 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12865 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12866 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12867 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12868 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12869 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12870
12871 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12872 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12873 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12874 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12875 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12876 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12877 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12878 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12879 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12880
12881 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12882 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12883 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12884 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12885 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12886 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12887 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12888 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12889 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12890 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12891 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12892 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12893 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12894 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12895 @c
12896 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12897 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12898 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12899
12900 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12901 @kindex D e (Draft)
12902 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12903 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12904 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12905
12906 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12907 Articles}).
12908
12909 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12910 @kindex D s (Draft)
12911 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12912 @kindex D S (Draft)
12913 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12914 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12915 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12916 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12917 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12918 in the buffer.
12919
12920 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12921 @kindex D t (Draft)
12922 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12923 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12924 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12925
12926 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12927 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12928
12929
12930 @node Rejected Articles
12931 @section Rejected Articles
12932 @cindex rejected articles
12933
12934 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12935 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12936 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12937 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12938
12939 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12940 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12941 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12942 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12943 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12944
12945 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12946 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12947 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12948
12949 @node Signing and encrypting
12950 @section Signing and encrypting
12951 @cindex using gpg
12952 @cindex using s/mime
12953 @cindex using smime
12954
12955 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12956 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12957 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12958 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12959
12960 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12961 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12962 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12963 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12964 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12965 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12966 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12967 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12968 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12969 automatically encrypted messages.
12970
12971 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12972 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12973 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12974
12975 @table @kbd
12976
12977 @item C-c C-m s s
12978 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12979 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12980
12981 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12982
12983 @item C-c C-m s o
12984 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12985 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12986
12987 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12988
12989 @item C-c C-m s p
12990 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12991 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12992
12993 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12994
12995 @item C-c C-m c s
12996 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12997 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12998
12999 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13000
13001 @item C-c C-m c o
13002 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13003 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13004
13005 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13006
13007 @item C-c C-m c p
13008 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13009 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13010
13011 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13012
13013 @item C-c C-m C-n
13014 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13015 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13016 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13017
13018 @end table
13019
13020 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13021
13022 @node Select Methods
13023 @chapter Select Methods
13024 @cindex foreign groups
13025 @cindex select methods
13026
13027 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13028 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13029 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13030 personal mail group.
13031
13032 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13033 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13034 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13035 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13036 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13037 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13038
13039 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13040 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13041
13042 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13043 group as.
13044
13045 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13046 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13047 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13048 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13049 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13050
13051 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13052
13053 @menu
13054 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13055 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13056 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13057 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13058 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13059 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13060 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13061 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13062 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13063 @end menu
13064
13065
13066 @node Server Buffer
13067 @section Server Buffer
13068
13069 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13070 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13071 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13072 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13073 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13074 back end represents a virtual server.
13075
13076 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13077 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13078 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13079 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13080
13081 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13082 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13083 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13084 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13085 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13086 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13087 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13088
13089 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13090 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13091
13092 @menu
13093 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13094 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13095 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13096 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13097 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13098 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13099 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13100 @end menu
13101
13102 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13103 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13104
13105
13106 @node Server Buffer Format
13107 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13108 @cindex server buffer format
13109
13110 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13111 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13112 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13113 variable, with some simple extensions:
13114
13115 @table @samp
13116
13117 @item h
13118 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13119
13120 @item n
13121 The name of this server.
13122
13123 @item w
13124 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13125
13126 @item s
13127 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13128
13129 @item a
13130 Whether this server is agentized.
13131 @end table
13132
13133 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13134 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13135 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13136 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13137
13138 @table @samp
13139 @item S
13140 Server name.
13141
13142 @item M
13143 Server method.
13144 @end table
13145
13146 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13147
13148
13149 @node Server Commands
13150 @subsection Server Commands
13151 @cindex server commands
13152
13153 @table @kbd
13154
13155 @item v
13156 @kindex v (Server)
13157 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13158 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13159 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13160
13161 @item a
13162 @kindex a (Server)
13163 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13164 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13165
13166 @item e
13167 @kindex e (Server)
13168 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13169 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13170
13171 @item S
13172 @kindex S (Server)
13173 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13174 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13175
13176 @item SPACE
13177 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13178 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13179 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13180
13181 @item q
13182 @kindex q (Server)
13183 @findex gnus-server-exit
13184 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13185
13186 @item k
13187 @kindex k (Server)
13188 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13189 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13190
13191 @item y
13192 @kindex y (Server)
13193 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13194 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13195
13196 @item c
13197 @kindex c (Server)
13198 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13199 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13200
13201 @item l
13202 @kindex l (Server)
13203 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13204 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13205
13206 @item s
13207 @kindex s (Server)
13208 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13209 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13210 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13211 servers.
13212
13213 @item g
13214 @kindex g (Server)
13215 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13216 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13217 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13218 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13219
13220 @item z
13221 @kindex z (Server)
13222 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13223
13224 Compact all groups in the server under point
13225 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13226 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13227 hence getting a correct total article count.
13228
13229 @end table
13230
13231 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13232 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13233
13234
13235 @node Example Methods
13236 @subsection Example Methods
13237
13238 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13239
13240 @lisp
13241 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13242 @end lisp
13243
13244 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13245
13246 @lisp
13247 (nnspool "")
13248 @end lisp
13249
13250 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13251 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13252 will.
13253
13254 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13255 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13256
13257 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13258 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13259 look like then:
13260
13261 @lisp
13262 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13263 @end lisp
13264
13265 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13266 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13267
13268 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13269 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13270 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13271 your private mail:
13272
13273 @lisp
13274 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13275 @end lisp
13276
13277 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13278 that.)
13279
13280 Here's the method for a public spool:
13281
13282 @lisp
13283 (nnmh "public"
13284 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13285 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13286 @end lisp
13287
13288 @cindex proxy
13289 @cindex firewall
13290
13291 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13292 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13293 on the firewall machine and connect with
13294 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13295 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13296 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13297 should probably look something like this:
13298
13299 @lisp
13300 (nntp "firewall"
13301 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13302 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13303 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13304 @end lisp
13305
13306 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13307 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13308 configuration to the example above:
13309
13310 @lisp
13311 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13312 @end lisp
13313
13314 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13315 an indirect connection:
13316
13317 @lisp
13318 (setq gnus-select-method
13319 '(nntp "indirect"
13320 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13321 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13322 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13323 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13324 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13325 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13326 @end lisp
13327
13328 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13329 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13330
13331 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13332 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13333 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13334
13335 @lisp
13336 (nntp "outside"
13337 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13338 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13339 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13340 @end lisp
13341
13342
13343 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13344 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13345
13346 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13347 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13348
13349 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13350 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13351 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13352
13353 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13354
13355 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13356 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13357 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13358 will contain the following:
13359
13360 @lisp
13361 (nnml "cache")
13362 @end lisp
13363
13364 Change that to:
13365
13366 @lisp
13367 (nnml "cache"
13368 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13369 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13370 @end lisp
13371
13372 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13373 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13374 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13375
13376
13377 @node Server Variables
13378 @subsection Server Variables
13379 @cindex server variables
13380 @cindex server parameters
13381
13382 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13383 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13384 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13385 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13386 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13387
13388 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13389 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13390 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13391 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13392 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13393 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13394 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13395 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13396 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13397
13398 @lisp
13399 (nnml "public"
13400 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13401 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13402 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13403 @end lisp
13404
13405 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13406
13407 @node Servers and Methods
13408 @subsection Servers and Methods
13409
13410 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13411 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13412 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13413 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13414 over.
13415
13416
13417 @node Unavailable Servers
13418 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13419
13420 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13421 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13422 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13423 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13424 actually the case or not.
13425
13426 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13427 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13428 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13429 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13430 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13431 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13432 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13433 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13434
13435 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13436 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13437
13438 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13439 with the following commands:
13440
13441 @table @kbd
13442
13443 @item O
13444 @kindex O (Server)
13445 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13446 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13447 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13448
13449 @item C
13450 @kindex C (Server)
13451 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13452 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13453 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13454
13455 @item D
13456 @kindex D (Server)
13457 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13458 Mark the current server as unreachable
13459 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13460
13461 @item M-o
13462 @kindex M-o (Server)
13463 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13464 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13465 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13466
13467 @item M-c
13468 @kindex M-c (Server)
13469 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13470 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13471 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13472
13473 @item R
13474 @kindex R (Server)
13475 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13476 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13477 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13478
13479 @item c
13480 @kindex c (Server)
13481 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13482 Copy a server and give it a new name
13483 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13484 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13485 a different (physical) server.
13486
13487 @item L
13488 @kindex L (Server)
13489 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13490 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13491
13492 @end table
13493
13494
13495 @node Getting News
13496 @section Getting News
13497 @cindex reading news
13498 @cindex news back ends
13499
13500 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13501 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13502 or it can read from a local spool.
13503
13504 @menu
13505 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13506 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13507 @end menu
13508
13509
13510 @node NNTP
13511 @subsection NNTP
13512 @cindex nntp
13513
13514 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13515 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13516 server as the, uhm, address.
13517
13518 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13519 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13520 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13521 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13522
13523 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13524 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13525 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13526
13527 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13528 server:
13529
13530 @table @code
13531
13532 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13533 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13534 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13535 @cindex authinfo
13536 @cindex authentication
13537 @cindex nntp authentication
13538 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13539 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13540 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13541 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13542 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13543 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13544 present in this hook.
13545
13546 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13547 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13548 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13549 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13550 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13551 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13552 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13553 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13554 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13555 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13556 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13557 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13558
13559 @enumerate
13560 @item
13561 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13562
13563 @item
13564 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13565
13566 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13567 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13568 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13569 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13570 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13571 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13572 @samp{force} is explained below.
13573
13574 @end enumerate
13575
13576 Here's an example file:
13577
13578 @example
13579 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13580 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13581 @end example
13582
13583 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13584 have to be first, for instance.
13585
13586 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13587 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13588 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13589 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13590 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13591 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13592 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13593
13594 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13595 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13596
13597 @example
13598 default force yes
13599 @end example
13600
13601 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13602 previously mentioned.
13603
13604 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13605
13606 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13607 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13608 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13609 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13610 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13611
13612 @lisp
13613 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13614 '(("innd" (ding))))
13615 @end lisp
13616
13617 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13618
13619 The default value is
13620
13621 @lisp
13622 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13623 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13624 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13625 @end lisp
13626
13627 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13628 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13629
13630 @item nntp-maximum-request
13631 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13632 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13633 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13634 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13635 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13636 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13637 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13638
13639 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13640 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13641 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13642 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13643 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13644 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13645 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13646 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13647 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13648 no timeouts are done.
13649
13650 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13651 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13652 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13653 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13654 can be used.
13655
13656 @item nntp-xover-commands
13657 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13658 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13659 @cindex XOVER
13660 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13661 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13662 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13663
13664 @item nntp-nov-gap
13665 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13666 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13667 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13668 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13669 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13670 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13671 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13672 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13673 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13674 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13675 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13676
13677 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13678 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13679 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13680 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13681 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13682 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13683 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13684 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13685 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13686 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13687 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13688 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13689 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13690 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13691 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13692 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13693 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13694
13695 @lisp
13696 (setq gnus-select-method
13697 '(nntp "newszilla"
13698 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13699 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13700 @dots{}))
13701 @end lisp
13702
13703 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13704
13705 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13706 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13707 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13708
13709 @item nntp-record-commands
13710 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13711 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13712 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13713 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13714 that doesn't seem to work.
13715
13716 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13717 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13718 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13719 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13720 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13721 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13722 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13723 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13724
13725 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13726 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13727 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13728 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13729 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13730 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13731 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13732 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13733 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13734
13735 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13736 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13737 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13738 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13739 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13740 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13741 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13742
13743 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13744 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13745 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13746 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13747 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13748 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13749 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13750
13751 @lisp
13752 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13753 @end lisp
13754
13755 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13756 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13757
13758 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13759 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13760 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13761 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13762
13763
13764 @end table
13765
13766 @menu
13767 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13768 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13769 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13770 @end menu
13771
13772
13773 @node Direct Functions
13774 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13775 @cindex direct connection functions
13776
13777 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13778 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13779 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13780 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13781
13782 @table @code
13783 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13784 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13785 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13786 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13787 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13788 connection automatically.
13789
13790 @item network-only
13791 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13792
13793 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13794 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13795 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13796 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13797 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13798
13799 @lisp
13800 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13801 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13802 ;;
13803 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13804 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13805 (nntp-port-number 563)
13806 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13807 @end lisp
13808
13809 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13810 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13811 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13812 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13813 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13814 then define a server as follows:
13815
13816 @lisp
13817 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13818 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13819 ;;
13820 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13821 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13822 (nntp-port-number 563)
13823 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13824 @end lisp
13825
13826 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13827 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13828 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13829 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13830 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13831 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13832 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13833 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13834
13835 @lisp
13836 (nntp "socksified"
13837 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13838 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13839 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13840 @end lisp
13841
13842 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13843 session, which is not a good idea.
13844
13845 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13846 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13847 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13848 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13849 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13850 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13851
13852 @lisp
13853 (nntp "socksified"
13854 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13855 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13856 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13857 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13858 @end lisp
13859 @end table
13860
13861
13862 @node Indirect Functions
13863 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13864 @cindex indirect connection functions
13865
13866 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13867 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13868 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13869 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13870 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13871 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13872
13873 @table @code
13874 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13875 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13876 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13877 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13878 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13879
13880 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13881
13882 @table @code
13883 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13884 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13885 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13886 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13887
13888 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13889 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13890 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13891 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13892 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13893 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13894 @end table
13895
13896 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13897 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13898 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13899 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13900 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13901 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13902
13903 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13904
13905 @table @code
13906 @item nntp-telnet-command
13907 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13908 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13909 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13910
13911 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13912 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13913 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13914 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13915
13916 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13917 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13918 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13919 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13920
13921 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13922 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13923 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13924 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13925 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13926 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13927 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13928 @end table
13929
13930 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13931 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13932
13933 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13934 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13935 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13936 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13937
13938 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13939
13940 @table @code
13941 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13942 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13943 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13944 @samp{telnet}.
13945
13946 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13947 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13948 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13949 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13950
13951 @item nntp-via-user-password
13952 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13953 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13954
13955 @item nntp-via-envuser
13956 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13957 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13958 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13959 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13960
13961 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13962 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13963 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13964 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13965
13966 @end table
13967
13968 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13969 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13970 @end table
13971
13972
13973 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13974 functions:
13975
13976 @table @code
13977
13978 @item nntp-via-user-name
13979 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13980 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13981
13982 @item nntp-via-address
13983 @vindex nntp-via-address
13984 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13985
13986 @end table
13987
13988
13989 @node Common Variables
13990 @subsubsection Common Variables
13991
13992 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13993 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13994 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13995 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13996 variables individually).
13997
13998 @table @code
13999
14000 @item nntp-pre-command
14001 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14002 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14003 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14004 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14005 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14006
14007 @item nntp-address
14008 @vindex nntp-address
14009 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14010
14011 @item nntp-port-number
14012 @vindex nntp-port-number
14013 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14014 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14015 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14016 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14017 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14018 not work with named ports.
14019
14020 @item nntp-end-of-line
14021 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14022 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14023 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14024 using a non native telnet connection function.
14025
14026 @item nntp-netcat-command
14027 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14028 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14029 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14030 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14031 @samp{nc}.
14032
14033 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14034 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14035 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14036 is @samp{()}.
14037
14038 @end table
14039
14040 @node News Spool
14041 @subsection News Spool
14042 @cindex nnspool
14043 @cindex news spool
14044
14045 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14046 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14047 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14048 instance.
14049
14050 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14051 anything else) as the address.
14052
14053 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14054 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14055 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14056 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14057
14058 @table @code
14059
14060 @item nnspool-inews-program
14061 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14062 Program used to post an article.
14063
14064 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14065 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14066 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14067
14068 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14069 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14070 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14071 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14072
14073 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14074 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14075 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14076 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14077
14078 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14079 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14080 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14081
14082 @item nnspool-active-file
14083 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14084 The name of the active file.
14085
14086 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14087 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14088 The name of the group descriptions file.
14089
14090 @item nnspool-history-file
14091 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14092 The name of the news history file.
14093
14094 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14095 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14096 The name of the active date file.
14097
14098 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14099 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14100 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14101 that it finds.
14102
14103 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14104 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14105 @cindex sed
14106 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14107 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14108 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14109 there.
14110
14111 @end table
14112
14113
14114 @node Using IMAP
14115 @section Using IMAP
14116 @cindex imap
14117
14118 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14119 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14120 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14121 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14122 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14123
14124 @menu
14125 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14126 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14127 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14128 @end menu
14129
14130
14131 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14132 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14133
14134 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14135 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14136 something like:
14137
14138 @example
14139 (setq gnus-select-method
14140 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14141 @end example
14142
14143 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14144 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14145
14146 @example
14147 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14148 @end example
14149
14150 That should basically be it for most users.
14151
14152
14153 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14154 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14155
14156 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14157
14158 @example
14159 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14160 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14161 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14162 (nnimap-expunge t)
14163 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14164 @end example
14165
14166 @table @code
14167 @item nnimap-address
14168 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14169
14170 @item nnimap-server-port
14171 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14172 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14173
14174 @item nnimap-stream
14175 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14176
14177 @table @code
14178 @item undecided
14179 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14180 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14181
14182 @item ssl
14183 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14184
14185 @item network
14186 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14187 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14188 supports it.
14189
14190 @item starttls
14191 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14192
14193 @item shell
14194 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14195 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14196 what you need.
14197
14198 @end table
14199
14200 @item nnimap-authenticator
14201 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14202 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14203
14204 @item nnimap-expunge
14205 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14206 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14207 servers that doesn't support that command.
14208
14209 @item nnimap-streaming
14210 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14211 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14212 @code{nil}.
14213
14214 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14215 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14216 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14217 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14218 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14219
14220 @item nnimap-record-commands
14221 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14222 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14223
14224 @end table
14225
14226
14227 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14228 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14229
14230 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14231 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14232 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14233
14234 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14235 variables are relevant:
14236
14237 @table @code
14238 @item nnimap-inbox
14239 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14240
14241 @item nnimap-split-methods
14242 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14243 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14244 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14245
14246 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14247 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14248
14249 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14250 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14251 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14252 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14253
14254 @end table
14255
14256 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14257 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14258
14259 @example
14260 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14261 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14262 (nnimap-split-methods
14263 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14264 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14265 "undecided")))
14266 @end example
14267
14268
14269 @node Getting Mail
14270 @section Getting Mail
14271 @cindex reading mail
14272 @cindex mail
14273
14274 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14275 course.
14276
14277 @menu
14278 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14279 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14280 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14281 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14282 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14283 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14284 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14285 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14286 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14287 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14288 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14289 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14290 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14291 @end menu
14292
14293
14294 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14295 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14296
14297 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14298 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14299 of a culture shock.
14300
14301 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14302 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14303
14304 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14305 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14306 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14307 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14308
14309 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14310
14311 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14312 deleted? How awful!
14313
14314 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14315 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14316 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14317 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14318 Mail}.
14319
14320 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14321 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14322 they want to treat a message.
14323
14324 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14325 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14326 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14327 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14328 archived somewhere else.
14329
14330 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14331 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14332 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14333 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14334 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14335
14336 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14337 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14338 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14339
14340 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14341 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14342 differently.
14343
14344 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14345 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14346 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14347 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14348 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14349
14350 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14351 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14352 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14353 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14354 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14355 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14356 You Do.)
14357
14358
14359 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14360 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14361
14362 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14363 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14364 and things will happen automatically.
14365
14366 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14367 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14368
14369 @lisp
14370 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14371 @end lisp
14372
14373 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14374 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14375 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14376 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14377 like any other group.
14378
14379 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14380
14381 @lisp
14382 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14383 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14384 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14385 ("other" "")))
14386 @end lisp
14387
14388 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14389 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14390 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14391 last group.
14392
14393 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14394 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14395 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14396
14397
14398 @node Splitting Mail
14399 @subsection Splitting Mail
14400 @cindex splitting mail
14401 @cindex mail splitting
14402 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14403
14404 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14405 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14406 to be split into groups.
14407
14408 @lisp
14409 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14410 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14411 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14412 ("mail.other" "")))
14413 @end lisp
14414
14415 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14416 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14417 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14418 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14419 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14420 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14421 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14422
14423 @lisp
14424 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14425 @end lisp
14426
14427 @noindent
14428 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14429 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14430
14431 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14432 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14433 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14434 mail belongs in that group.
14435
14436 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14437 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14438 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14439 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14440 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14441 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14442 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14443 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14444 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14445 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14446
14447 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14448 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14449 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14450 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14451 thinks should carry this mail message.
14452
14453 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14454 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14455
14456 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14457 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14458 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14459 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14460
14461 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14462 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14463 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14464 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14465 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14466
14467 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14468 @cindex crosspost
14469 @cindex links
14470 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14471 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14472 links. If that's the case for you, set
14473 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14474 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14475
14476 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14477 @findex nnmail-split-history
14478 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14479 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14480 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14481 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14482 Group Commands}).
14483
14484 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14485 Header lines longer than the value of
14486 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14487 function.
14488
14489 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14490 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14491 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14492 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14493 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14494 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14495 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14496 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14497 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14498 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14499 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14500 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14501
14502 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14503 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14504 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14505 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14506 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14507 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14508 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14509 other kinds of entries.)
14510
14511 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14512 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14513 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14514 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14515 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14516 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14517 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14518 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14519 month's rent money.
14520
14521
14522 @node Mail Sources
14523 @subsection Mail Sources
14524
14525 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14526 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14527 maildir, for instance.
14528
14529 @menu
14530 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14531 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14532 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14533 @end menu
14534
14535
14536 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14537 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14538 @cindex POP
14539 @cindex mail server
14540 @cindex procmail
14541 @cindex mail spool
14542 @cindex mail source
14543
14544 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14545 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14546
14547 Here's an example:
14548
14549 @lisp
14550 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14551 @end lisp
14552
14553 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14554 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14555 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14556 default values.
14557
14558 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14559 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14560 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14561 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14562 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14563 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14564 group might look like this:
14565
14566 @lisp
14567 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14568 @end lisp
14569
14570 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14571 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14572
14573 The following mail source types are available:
14574
14575 @table @code
14576 @item file
14577 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14578
14579 Keywords:
14580
14581 @table @code
14582 @item :path
14583 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14584 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14585 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14586
14587 @item :prescript
14588 @itemx :postscript
14589 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14590 @end table
14591
14592 An example file mail source:
14593
14594 @lisp
14595 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14596 @end lisp
14597
14598 Or using the default file name:
14599
14600 @lisp
14601 (file)
14602 @end lisp
14603
14604 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14605 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14606 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14607 mail spool while moving the mail.
14608
14609 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14610
14611 @lisp
14612 (setq mail-sources
14613 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14614 @end lisp
14615
14616 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14617
14618 @example
14619 #!/bin/sh
14620 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14621 # flu@@iki.fi
14622
14623 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14624 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14625 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14626 @end example
14627
14628 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14629 file you want to use.
14630
14631
14632 @item directory
14633 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14634 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14635 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14636 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14637 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14638 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14639 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14640 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14641 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14642 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14643
14644 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14645 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14646 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14647 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14648
14649 Keywords:
14650
14651 @table @code
14652 @item :path
14653 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14654 value.
14655
14656 @item :suffix
14657 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14658 @samp{.spool}.
14659
14660 @item :predicate
14661 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14662 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14663 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14664 predicate are considered.
14665
14666 @item :prescript
14667 @itemx :postscript
14668 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14669
14670 @end table
14671
14672 An example directory mail source:
14673
14674 @lisp
14675 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14676 :suffix ".prcml")
14677 @end lisp
14678
14679 @item pop
14680 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14681
14682 Keywords:
14683
14684 @table @code
14685 @item :server
14686 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14687 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14688
14689 @item :port
14690 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14691 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14692 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14693 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14694 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14695
14696 @item :user
14697 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14698 name.
14699
14700 @item :password
14701 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14702 the user is prompted.
14703
14704 @item :program
14705 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14706 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14707
14708 @example
14709 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14710 @end example
14711
14712 The valid format specifier characters are:
14713
14714 @table @samp
14715 @item t
14716 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14717 included in this string.
14718
14719 @item s
14720 The name of the server.
14721
14722 @item P
14723 The port number of the server.
14724
14725 @item u
14726 The user name to use.
14727
14728 @item p
14729 The password to use.
14730 @end table
14731
14732 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14733 corresponding keywords.
14734
14735 @item :prescript
14736 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14737 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14738
14739 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14740 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14741
14742 @lisp
14743 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14744 :port 1234
14745 :user "foo"
14746 :password "secret"
14747 :prescript
14748 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14749 @end lisp
14750
14751 @item :postscript
14752 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14753 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14754
14755 @item :function
14756 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14757 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14758 mail should be moved to.
14759
14760 @item :authentication
14761 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14762 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14763 @code{password}.
14764
14765 @item :leave
14766 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14767 after fetching. Mails once fetched will never be fetched again by the
14768 @acronym{UIDL} control. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program
14769 (the default) supports this keyword.
14770
14771 If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails will be left on
14772 the server. If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this
14773 many days since you first checked new mails. If this is @code{nil}
14774 (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right after fetching.
14775
14776 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14777 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14778 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14779 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14780
14781 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14782 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14783 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14784 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14785 mailbox.
14786
14787 @end table
14788
14789 @findex pop3-movemail
14790 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14791 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14792 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14793
14794 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14795
14796 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14797 name, and default fetcher:
14798
14799 @lisp
14800 (pop)
14801 @end lisp
14802
14803 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14804
14805 @lisp
14806 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14807 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14808 @end lisp
14809
14810 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14811
14812 @lisp
14813 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14814 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14815 :leave 14)
14816 @end lisp
14817
14818 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14819
14820 @lisp
14821 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14822 @end lisp
14823
14824 @item maildir
14825 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14826 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14827 contains exactly one mail.
14828
14829 Keywords:
14830
14831 @table @code
14832 @item :path
14833 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14834 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14835 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14836 @item :subdirs
14837 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14838 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14839
14840 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14841 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14842 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14843 @c below.
14844
14845 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14846 from locking problems).
14847
14848 @end table
14849
14850 Two example maildir mail sources:
14851
14852 @lisp
14853 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14854 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14855 @end lisp
14856
14857 @lisp
14858 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14859 :subdirs ("new"))
14860 @end lisp
14861
14862 @item imap
14863 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14864 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14865 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14866 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14867 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14868
14869 Keywords:
14870
14871 @table @code
14872 @item :server
14873 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14874 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14875
14876 @item :port
14877 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14878 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14879
14880 @item :user
14881 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14882 name.
14883
14884 @item :password
14885 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14886 prompted.
14887
14888 @item :stream
14889 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14890 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14891 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14892 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14893
14894 @item :authentication
14895 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14896 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14897 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14898 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14899
14900 @item :program
14901 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14902 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14903 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14904
14905 @example
14906 ssh %s imapd
14907 @end example
14908
14909 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14910 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14911 specifier characters are:
14912
14913 @table @samp
14914 @item s
14915 The name of the server.
14916
14917 @item l
14918 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14919
14920 @item p
14921 The port number of the server.
14922 @end table
14923
14924 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14925 corresponding keywords.
14926
14927 @item :mailbox
14928 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14929 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14930
14931 @item :predicate
14932 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14933 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14934 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14935 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14936 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14937 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14938
14939 @item :fetchflag
14940 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14941 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14942 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14943 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14944
14945 @item :dontexpunge
14946 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14947 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14948
14949 @end table
14950
14951 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14952
14953 @lisp
14954 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14955 :stream kerberos4
14956 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14957 @end lisp
14958
14959 @item group
14960 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14961 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14962
14963 @end table
14964
14965 @table @dfn
14966 @item Common Keywords
14967 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14968
14969 Keywords:
14970
14971 @table @code
14972 @item :plugged
14973 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14974 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14975 example:
14976
14977 @lisp
14978 (setq mail-sources
14979 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14980 :suffix ""
14981 :plugged t)))
14982 @end lisp
14983
14984 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14985 useful when you use local mail and news.
14986
14987 @end table
14988 @end table
14989
14990 @subsubsection Function Interface
14991
14992 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14993 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14994 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14995 consider the following mail-source setting:
14996
14997 @lisp
14998 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14999 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15000 @end lisp
15001
15002 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15003 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15004 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15005 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15006 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15007
15008 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15009
15010
15011 @node Mail Source Customization
15012 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15013
15014 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15015 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15016 variables.
15017
15018 @table @code
15019 @item mail-source-crash-box
15020 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15021 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15022 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15023
15024 @cindex Incoming*
15025 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15026 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15027 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15028 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15029 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15030 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15031 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15032 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15033 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15034 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15035
15036 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15037 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15038 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15039 files. This variable only applies when
15040 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15041
15042 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15043 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15044 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15045
15046 @item mail-source-directory
15047 @vindex mail-source-directory
15048 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15049 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15050 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15051 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15052
15053 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15054 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15055 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15056 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15057 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15058 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15059 number.
15060
15061 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15062 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15063 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15064
15065 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15066 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15067 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15068 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15069
15070 @end table
15071
15072
15073 @node Fetching Mail
15074 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15075
15076 @vindex mail-sources
15077 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15078 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15079 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15080
15081 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15082 fetch mail by themselves.
15083
15084 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15085 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15086
15087 @lisp
15088 (setq mail-sources
15089 '((file)
15090 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15091 :password "secret")))
15092 @end lisp
15093
15094 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15095
15096 @lisp
15097 (setq mail-sources
15098 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15099 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15100 :user "user-name"
15101 :port "pop3"
15102 :password "secret")))
15103 @end lisp
15104
15105
15106 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15107 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15108 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15109 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15110 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15111 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15112
15113
15114
15115 @node Mail Back End Variables
15116 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15117
15118 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15119 mail back ends.
15120
15121 @table @code
15122 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15123 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15124 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15125 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15126
15127 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15128 @item nnmail-split-hook
15129 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15130 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15131 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15132 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15133 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15134 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15135 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15136 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15137 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15138 to this hook.
15139
15140 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15141 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15142 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15143 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15144 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15145 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15146 starting to handle the new mail) and
15147 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15148 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15149 default file modes the new mail files get:
15150
15151 @lisp
15152 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15153 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15154
15155 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15156 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15157 @end lisp
15158
15159 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15160 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15161 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15162 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15163 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15164 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15165 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15166
15167 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15168 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15169 @findex delete-file
15170 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15171
15172 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15173 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15174 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15175 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15176 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15177
15178 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15179 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15180 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15181 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15182 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15183
15184 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15185 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15186 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15187
15188 @end table
15189
15190
15191 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15192 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15193 @cindex mail splitting
15194 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15195
15196 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15197 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15198 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15199 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15200 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15201 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15202
15203 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15204
15205 @lisp
15206 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15207 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15208 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15209 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15210 "mail.misc"))
15211 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15212 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15213 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15214 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15215 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15216 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15217 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15218 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15219 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15220 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15221 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15222 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15223 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15224 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15225 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15226 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15227 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15228 "misc.misc")
15229 @end lisp
15230
15231 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15232 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15233 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15234
15235 @table @code
15236
15237 @item group
15238 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15239 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15240
15241 @c Don't fold this line.
15242 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15243 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15244 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15245 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15246 @var{split}.
15247
15248 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15249 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15250 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15251 @var{split} is processed.
15252
15253 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15254 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15255 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15256 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15257
15258 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15259 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15260 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15261 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15262 stored in one or more groups.
15263
15264 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15265 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15266 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15267
15268 @item junk
15269 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15270 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15271
15272 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15273 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15274 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15275 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15276
15277 @cindex body split
15278 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15279 body of the messages:
15280
15281 @lisp
15282 (defun split-on-body ()
15283 (save-excursion
15284 (save-restriction
15285 (widen)
15286 (goto-char (point-min))
15287 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15288 "string.group"))))
15289 @end lisp
15290
15291 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15292 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15293 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15294 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15295 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15296 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15297 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15298
15299 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15300 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15301 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15302 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15303 should return a split.
15304
15305 @item nil
15306 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15307
15308 @end table
15309
15310 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15311
15312 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15313 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15314 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15315 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15316 for example,
15317
15318 @example
15319 (any "joe" "joemail")
15320 @end example
15321
15322 @noindent
15323 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15324 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15325 of the following three ways:
15326
15327 @enumerate
15328 @item
15329 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15330 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15331 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15332 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15333 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15334 @code{nil}.
15335
15336 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15337
15338 @item
15339 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15340 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15341 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15342 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15343 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15344
15345 @item
15346 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15347 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15348 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15349 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15350 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15351 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15352 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15353 @end enumerate
15354
15355 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15356 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15357 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15358 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15359 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15360 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15361 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15362
15363 @table @code
15364 @item from
15365 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15366 @item to
15367 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15368 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15369 @item any
15370 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15371 @end table
15372
15373 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15374 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15375 when all this splitting is performed.
15376
15377 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15378 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15379 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15380
15381 @example
15382 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15383 @end example
15384
15385 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15386 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15387
15388 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15389 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15390 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15391 groupings 1 through 9.
15392
15393 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15394 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15395 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15396 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15397 groups when users send to an address using different case
15398 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15399 is @code{t}.
15400
15401 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15402 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15403 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15404 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15405 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15406 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15407 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15408 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15409 it once per thread.
15410
15411 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15412 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15413 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15414 using the colon feature, like so:
15415 @lisp
15416 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15417 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15418 nnmail-split-fancy
15419 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15420 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15421 ))
15422 @end lisp
15423
15424 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15425 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15426 in the file specified by the variable
15427 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15428 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15429 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15430 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15431 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15432 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15433 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15434 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15435 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15436 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15437 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15438 300 kBytes in size.)
15439 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15440 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15441 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15442 messages goes into the new group.
15443
15444 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15445 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15446 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15447 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15448 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15449 ``outgoing'' group.
15450
15451
15452 @node Group Mail Splitting
15453 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15454 @cindex mail splitting
15455 @cindex group mail splitting
15456
15457 @findex gnus-group-split
15458 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15459 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15460 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15461 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15462 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15463 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15464 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15465 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15466
15467 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15468 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15469 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15470 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15471
15472 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15473 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15474 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15475 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15476 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15477 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15478 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15479
15480 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15481 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15482 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15483 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15484 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15485 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15486 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15487
15488 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15489 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15490 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15491 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15492 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15493 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15494 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15495 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15496 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15497 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15498 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15499 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15500 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15501
15502 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15503 been defined:
15504
15505 @example
15506 nnml:mail.bar:
15507 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15508 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15509 nnml:mail.foo:
15510 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15511 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15512 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15513 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15514 nnml:mail.others:
15515 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15516 @end example
15517
15518 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15519 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15520 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15521
15522 @lisp
15523 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15524 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15525 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15526 "mail.others")
15527 @end lisp
15528
15529 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15530 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15531 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15532 splits like this:
15533
15534 @lisp
15535 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15536 @end lisp
15537
15538 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15539 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15540 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15541 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15542 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15543 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15544 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15545 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15546 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15547
15548 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15549 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15550 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15551 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15552 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15553 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15554 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15555 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15556 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15557
15558 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15559 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15560 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15561 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15562 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15563 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15564
15565 @lisp
15566 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15567 @end lisp
15568
15569 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15570 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15571 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15572 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15573 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15574 value.
15575
15576 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15577 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15578 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15579 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15580
15581 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15582 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15583 @cindex incorporating old mail
15584 @cindex import old mail
15585
15586 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15587 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15588 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15589 your mail groups.
15590
15591 Doing so can be quite easy.
15592
15593 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15594 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15595 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15596 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15597 your @code{nnml} groups.
15598
15599 Here's how:
15600
15601 @enumerate
15602 @item
15603 Go to the group buffer.
15604
15605 @item
15606 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15607 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15608
15609 @item
15610 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15611
15612 @item
15613 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15614 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15615
15616 @item
15617 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15618 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15619 @end enumerate
15620
15621 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15622 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15623 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15624 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15625 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15626
15627 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15628 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15629 using the new mail back end.
15630
15631
15632 @node Expiring Mail
15633 @subsection Expiring Mail
15634 @cindex article expiry
15635 @cindex expiring mail
15636
15637 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15638 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15639 different approach to mail reading.
15640
15641 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15642 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15643 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15644 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15645 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15646 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15647 course.
15648
15649 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15650 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15651 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15652 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15653 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15654 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15655 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15656 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15657 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15658
15659 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15660 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15661 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15662 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15663 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15664 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15665 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15666 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15667 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15668 these marks.
15669
15670 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15671 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15672 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15673 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15674 into its own group.)
15675
15676 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15677 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15678 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15679 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15680 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15681 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15682 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15683 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15684 scoring.
15685
15686 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15687 Groups that match the regular expression
15688 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15689 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15690 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15691
15692 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15693 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15694 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15695 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15696 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15697
15698 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15699 @lisp
15700 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15701 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15702 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15703 @end lisp
15704
15705 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15706 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15707 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15708 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15709 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15710
15711 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15712 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15713
15714 @lisp
15715 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15716 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15717 @end lisp
15718
15719 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15720 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15721
15722 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15723 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15724 don't really mix very well.
15725
15726 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15727 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15728 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15729 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15730 days.
15731
15732 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15733 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15734 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15735 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15736 everywhere else:
15737
15738 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15739 @lisp
15740 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15741 (lambda (group)
15742 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15743 31)
15744 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15745 1)
15746 ((string= group "important")
15747 'never)
15748 (t
15749 6))))
15750 @end lisp
15751
15752 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15753 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15754
15755 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15756 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15757 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15758 @code{never}.
15759
15760 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15761 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15762
15763 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15764 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15765 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15766 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15767 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15768 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15769 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15770 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15771 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15772 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15773 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15774 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15775 name or @code{delete}.
15776
15777 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15778 @lisp
15779 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15780 @end lisp
15781
15782 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15783 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15784 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15785 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15786 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15787
15788 @lisp
15789 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15790 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15791 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15792 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15793 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15794 @end lisp
15795
15796 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15797 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15798 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15799 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15800 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15801 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15802
15803 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15804 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15805 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15806 easier for procmail users.
15807
15808 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15809 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15810 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15811 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15812 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15813 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15814 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15815 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15816 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15817 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15818 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15819 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15820 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15821 with! So there!
15822
15823 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15824
15825 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15826 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15827 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15828 auto-expire turned on.
15829
15830 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15831 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15832 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15833 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15834 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15835 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15836 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15837 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15838 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15839 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15840 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15841 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15842 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15843 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15844 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15845 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15846
15847
15848 @node Washing Mail
15849 @subsection Washing Mail
15850 @cindex mail washing
15851 @cindex list server brain damage
15852 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15853
15854 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15855 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15856 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15857 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15858 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15859 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15860
15861 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15862 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15863 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15864 laugh.
15865
15866 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15867 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15868 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15869 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15873 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15874 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15875 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15876 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15877
15878 @table @code
15879 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15880 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15881 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15882 Emacs running on MS machines.
15883
15884 @end table
15885
15886 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15887 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15888 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15889 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15890
15891 @table @code
15892 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15893 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15894 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15895 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15896
15897 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15898 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15899 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15900 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15901 into a feature by documenting it.)
15902
15903 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15904 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15905 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15906 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15907 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15908 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15909 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15910 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15911
15912 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15913 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15914
15915 @lisp
15916 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15917 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15918 @end lisp
15919
15920 This can also be done non-destructively with
15921 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15922
15923 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15924 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15925 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15926
15927 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15928 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15929 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15930 @cindex Eudora
15931 @cindex Pegasus
15932 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15933 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15934 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15935 contain a line matching the regular expression
15936 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15937
15938 @end table
15939
15940 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15941 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15942 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15943 include:
15944
15945 @table @code
15946 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15947 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15948 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15949
15950 @end table
15951 @end table
15952
15953
15954 @node Duplicates
15955 @subsection Duplicates
15956
15957 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15958 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15959 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15960 @cindex duplicate mails
15961 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15962 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15963 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15964 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
15965 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15966 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15967 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15968 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15969 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15970 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15971 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15972 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15973 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15974
15975 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15976 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15977 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15978 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15979
15980 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15981 @code{nil}.
15982
15983 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15984 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15985 methods:
15986
15987 @lisp
15988 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15989 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15990 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15991 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15992 (any mail "mail.misc")
15993 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15994 [...] ))
15995 @end lisp
15996 @noindent
15997 Or something like:
15998 @lisp
15999 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16000 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16001 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16002 [...]))
16003 @end lisp
16004
16005 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16006 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16007 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16008 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16009 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16010
16011
16012 @node Not Reading Mail
16013 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16014
16015 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16016 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16017 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16018
16019 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16020 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16021 mail, which should help.
16022
16023 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16024 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16025 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16026 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16027 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16028 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16029 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16030 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16031 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16032 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16033 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16034
16035 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16036 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16037 incoming mail.
16038
16039
16040 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16041 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16042
16043 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16044 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16045 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16046
16047 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16048 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16049 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16050 Spool}).
16051
16052 @menu
16053 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16054 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16055 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16056 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16057 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16058 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16059 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16060 @end menu
16061
16062
16063
16064 @node Unix Mail Box
16065 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16066 @cindex nnmbox
16067 @cindex unix mail box
16068
16069 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16070 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16071 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16072 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16073 which group it belongs in.
16074
16075 Virtual server settings:
16076
16077 @table @code
16078 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16079 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16080 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16081 @file{~/mbox}.
16082
16083 @item nnmbox-active-file
16084 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16085 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16086 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16087
16088 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16089 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16090 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16091 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16092 @end table
16093
16094
16095 @node Babyl
16096 @subsubsection Babyl
16097 @cindex nnbabyl
16098
16099 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16100 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16101 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16102 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16103 group it belongs in.
16104
16105 Virtual server settings:
16106
16107 @table @code
16108 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16109 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16110 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16111
16112 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16113 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16114 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16115 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16116
16117 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16118 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16119 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16120 @code{t}
16121 @end table
16122
16123
16124 @node Mail Spool
16125 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16126 @cindex nnml
16127 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16128
16129 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16130 format. It should be used with some caution.
16131
16132 @vindex nnml-directory
16133 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16134 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16135 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16136 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16137
16138 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16139 care of all that.
16140
16141 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16142 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16143 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16144 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16145 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16146 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16147 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16148 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16149
16150 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16151 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16152 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16153 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16154
16155 Virtual server settings:
16156
16157 @table @code
16158 @item nnml-directory
16159 @vindex nnml-directory
16160 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16161 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16162 is @file{~/Mail}).
16163
16164 @item nnml-active-file
16165 @vindex nnml-active-file
16166 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16167 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16168
16169 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16170 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16171 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16172 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16173
16174 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16175 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16176 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16177 @code{t}.
16178
16179 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16180 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16181 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16182 default is @code{nil}.
16183
16184 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16185 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16186 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16187
16188 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16189 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16190 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16191
16192 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16193 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16194 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16195 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16196 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16197 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16198 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16199 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16200 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16201
16202 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16203 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16204 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16205 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16206 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16207
16208 @end table
16209
16210 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16211 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16212 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16213 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16214 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16215 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16216 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16217 Commands}).
16218
16219
16220 @node MH Spool
16221 @subsubsection MH Spool
16222 @cindex nnmh
16223 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16224
16225 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16226 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16227 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16228 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16229 for.
16230
16231 Virtual server settings:
16232
16233 @table @code
16234 @item nnmh-directory
16235 @vindex nnmh-directory
16236 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16237 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16238 @file{~/Mail})
16239
16240 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16241 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16242 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16243 @code{t}.
16244
16245 @item nnmh-be-safe
16246 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16247 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16248 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16249 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16250 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16251 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16252 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16253 @end table
16254
16255
16256 @node Maildir
16257 @subsubsection Maildir
16258 @cindex nnmaildir
16259 @cindex maildir
16260
16261 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16262 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16263 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16264 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16265 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16266 within a maildir.
16267
16268 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16269 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16270 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16271 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16272 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16273 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16274 that appear as group in Gnus.
16275
16276 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16277 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16278 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16279
16280 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16281 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16282 another, and you will keep your marks.
16283
16284 Virtual server settings:
16285
16286 @table @code
16287 @item directory
16288 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16289 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16290 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16291 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16292 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16293 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16294 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16295 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16296 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16297 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16298
16299 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16300 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16301 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16302 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16303 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16304 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16305 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16306 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16307 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16308 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16309 value.
16310
16311 @item target-prefix
16312 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16313 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16314 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16315 closed.
16316
16317 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16318 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16319 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16320 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16321 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16322 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16323 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16324 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16325 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16326
16327 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16328 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16329 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16330 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16331 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16332
16333 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16334 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16335 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16336 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16337 @code{force} argument.
16338
16339 @item directory-files
16340 This should be a function with the same interface as
16341 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16342 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16343 parameter is optional; the default is
16344 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16345 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16346 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16347 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16348 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16349 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16350
16351 @item get-new-mail
16352 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16353 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16354 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16355 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16356 value is @code{nil}.
16357
16358 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16359 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16360 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16361 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16362 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16363 @end table
16364
16365 @subsubsection Group parameters
16366
16367 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16368 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16369 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16370 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16371 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16372 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16373 another back end.
16374
16375 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16376 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16377 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16378 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16379 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16380 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16381 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16382 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16383 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16384
16385 @table @code
16386 @item expire-age
16387 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16388 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16389 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16390 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16391 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16392 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16393 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16394 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16395 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16396 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16397 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16398 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16399 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16400
16401 @item expire-group
16402 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16403 @example
16404 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16405 @end example
16406 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16407 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16408 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16409 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16410 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16411 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16412 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16413 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16414 article. So that form can refer to
16415 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16416 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16417 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16418 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16419
16420 @item read-only
16421 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16422 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16423 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16424 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16425 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16426 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16427 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16428 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16429 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16430 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16431 contain extra copies of the articles.
16432
16433 @item directory-files
16434 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16435 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16436 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16437 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16438
16439 @item distrust-Lines:
16440 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16441 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16442 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16443
16444 @item always-marks
16445 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16446 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16447 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16448 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16449 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16450 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16451
16452 @item never-marks
16453 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16454 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16455 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16456 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16457 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16458 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16459 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16460
16461 @item nov-cache-size
16462 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16463 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16464 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16465 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16466 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16467 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16468 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16469 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16470 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16471 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16472 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16473 @end table
16474
16475 @subsubsection Article identification
16476 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16477 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16478 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16479 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16480 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16481 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16482 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16483 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16484 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16485 request the article in the summary buffer.
16486
16487 @subsubsection NOV data
16488 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16489 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16490 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16491 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16492 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16493 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16494 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16495 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16496 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16497 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16498 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16499
16500 @subsubsection Article marks
16501 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16502 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16503 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16504 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16505 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16506 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16507 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16508 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16509
16510 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16511 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16512 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16513 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16514 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16515 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16516 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16517 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16518 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16519
16520
16521 @node Mail Folders
16522 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16523 @cindex nnfolder
16524 @cindex mbox folders
16525 @cindex mail folders
16526
16527 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16528 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16529 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16530 numbers and arrival dates.
16531
16532 Virtual server settings:
16533
16534 @table @code
16535 @item nnfolder-directory
16536 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16537 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16538 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16539 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16540
16541 @item nnfolder-active-file
16542 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16543 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16544
16545 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16546 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16547 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16548 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16549
16550 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16551 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16552 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16553 default is @code{t}
16554
16555 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16556 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16557 @cindex backup files
16558 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16559 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16560 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16561 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16562
16563 @lisp
16564 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16565 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16566
16567 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16568 @end lisp
16569
16570 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16571 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16572 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16573 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16574 extract some information from it before removing it.
16575
16576 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16577 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16578 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16579 default is @code{nil}.
16580
16581 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16582 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16583 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16584
16585 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16586 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16587 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16588 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16589
16590 @end table
16591
16592
16593 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16594 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16595 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16596 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16597 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16598 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16599 though.
16600
16601 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16602 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16603
16604 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16605 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16606 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16607 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16608 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16609
16610 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16611 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16612 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16613 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16614 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16615 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16616 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16617 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16618 via NFS).
16619
16620 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16621 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16622 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16623 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16624
16625 @table @code
16626 @item nnmbox
16627
16628 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16629 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16630 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16631 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16632 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16633 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16634 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16635 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16636 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16637 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16638 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16639 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16640 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16641 what's where.
16642
16643 @item nnbabyl
16644
16645 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16646 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16647 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16648 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16649 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16650 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16651 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16652 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16653 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16654 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16655 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16656 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16657 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16658 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16659 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16660
16661 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16662 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16663 look at your mail.
16664
16665 @item nnml
16666
16667 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16668 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16669 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16670 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16671 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16672 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16673 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16674 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16675 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16676 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16677 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16678 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16679 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16680 provided by the active file and overviews.
16681
16682 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16683 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16684 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16685 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16686 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16687 wins big.
16688
16689 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16690 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16691 tiny files.
16692
16693 @item nnmh
16694
16695 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16696 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16697 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16698 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16699 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16700 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16701 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16702
16703 @item nnfolder
16704
16705 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16706 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16707 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16708 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16709 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16710 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16711 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16712 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16713 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16714
16715 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16716 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16717 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16718 friendly mail back end all over.
16719
16720 @item nnmaildir
16721
16722 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16723 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16724 mail back ends.
16725
16726 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16727 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16728 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16729 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16730 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16731 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16732 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16733 file system.
16734
16735 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16736 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16737 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16738 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16739 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16740 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16741 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16742 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16743 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16744 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16745 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16746
16747 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16748 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16749 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16750 else, and still have your marks.
16751
16752 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16753 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16754 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16755 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16756 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16757 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16758 removed in the future.
16759
16760 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16761 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16762 on your file system.
16763
16764 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16765 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16766
16767 @end table
16768
16769
16770 @node Browsing the Web
16771 @section Browsing the Web
16772 @cindex web
16773 @cindex browsing the web
16774 @cindex www
16775 @cindex http
16776
16777 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16778 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16779 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16780 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16781 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16782 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16783 even know what a news group is.
16784
16785 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16786 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16787 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16788 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16789 you mad in the end.
16790
16791 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16792 to do it instead?
16793
16794 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16795 interfaces to these sources.
16796
16797 @menu
16798 * Archiving Mail::
16799 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16800 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16801 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16802 @end menu
16803
16804 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16805 alternatives to work.
16806
16807 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16808 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16809 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16810 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16811 though, you should be ok.
16812
16813 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16814 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16815 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16816 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16817 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16818
16819 @node Archiving Mail
16820 @subsection Archiving Mail
16821 @cindex archiving mail
16822 @cindex backup of mail
16823
16824 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16825 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16826 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16827 marks is fairly simple.
16828
16829 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16830 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16831 though.)
16832
16833 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16834 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16835 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16836 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16837 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16838 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16839 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16840 before you restore the data.
16841
16842 @node Web Searches
16843 @subsection Web Searches
16844 @cindex nnweb
16845 @cindex Google
16846 @cindex dejanews
16847 @cindex gmane
16848 @cindex Usenet searches
16849 @cindex searching the Usenet
16850
16851 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16852 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16853 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16854 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16855 searches without having to use a browser.
16856
16857 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16858 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16859 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16860 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16861 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16862
16863 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16864 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16865 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16866 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16867 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16868 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16869 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16870 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16871 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16872 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16873 group as read.
16874
16875 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16876 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16877 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16878 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16879 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16880 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16881
16882 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16883 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16884 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16885
16886 Virtual server variables:
16887
16888 @table @code
16889 @item nnweb-type
16890 @vindex nnweb-type
16891 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16892 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16893 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16894
16895 @item nnweb-search
16896 @vindex nnweb-search
16897 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16898
16899 @item nnweb-max-hits
16900 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16901 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16902 999.
16903
16904 @item nnweb-type-definition
16905 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16906 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16907 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16908 present:
16909
16910 @table @code
16911 @item article
16912 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16913 understands.
16914
16915 @item map
16916 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16917
16918 @item search
16919 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16920
16921 @item address
16922 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16923 to.
16924
16925 @item id
16926 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16927 @end table
16928
16929 @end table
16930
16931
16932 @node RSS
16933 @subsection RSS
16934 @cindex nnrss
16935 @cindex RSS
16936
16937 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16938 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16939 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16940 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16941 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16942
16943 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16944 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16945
16946 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16947 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16948 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16949 group names.
16950
16951 @kindex G R (Group)
16952 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16953 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16954 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16955 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16956
16957 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16958 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16959 subscribe to groups.
16960
16961 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16962 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16963 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16964 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16965 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16966 information.
16967
16968 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16969 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16970 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16971
16972 @cindex OPML
16973 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16974 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16975 Markup Language).
16976
16977 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16978 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16979 file.
16980 @end defun
16981
16982 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16983 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16984 @acronym{OPML} format.
16985 @end defun
16986
16987 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16988
16989 @table @code
16990 @item nnrss-directory
16991 @vindex nnrss-directory
16992 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16993 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16994
16995 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16996 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16997 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16998 data files. The default is the value of
16999 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17000 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17001
17002 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17003 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17004 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17005 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17006 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17007 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17008 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17009 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17010
17011 @item nnrss-use-local
17012 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17013 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17014 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17015 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17016 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17017 download script using @command{wget}.
17018 @end table
17019
17020 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17021 the summary buffer.
17022
17023 @lisp
17024 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17025 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17026
17027 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17028 (let ((descr
17029 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17030 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17031 @end lisp
17032
17033 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17034 summary buffer.
17035
17036 @lisp
17037 (require 'browse-url)
17038
17039 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17040 (interactive "p")
17041 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17042 (mail-header-extra
17043 (gnus-data-header
17044 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17045 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17046 (if url
17047 (progn
17048 (browse-url (cdr url))
17049 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17050 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17051
17052 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17053 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17054 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17055 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17056 @end lisp
17057
17058 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17059 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17060 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17061 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17062 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17063 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17064 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17065 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17066 @code{nnrss} groups:
17067
17068 @lisp
17069 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17070 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17071 '(add-to-list
17072 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17073 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17074 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17075
17076 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17077 (add-to-list
17078 'gnus-parameters
17079 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17080 @end lisp
17081
17082
17083 @node Customizing W3
17084 @subsection Customizing W3
17085 @cindex W3
17086 @cindex html
17087 @cindex url
17088 @cindex Netscape
17089
17090 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17091 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17092 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17093 users.
17094
17095 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17096 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17097 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17098
17099 @lisp
17100 (eval-after-load "w3"
17101 '(progn
17102 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17103 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17104 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17105 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17106 (browse-url url)
17107 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17108 @end lisp
17109
17110 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17111 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17112 follow the link.
17113
17114
17115 @node Other Sources
17116 @section Other Sources
17117
17118 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17119 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17120 newsgroups.
17121
17122 @menu
17123 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17124 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17125 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17126 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17127 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17128 @end menu
17129
17130
17131 @node Directory Groups
17132 @subsection Directory Groups
17133 @cindex nndir
17134 @cindex directory groups
17135
17136 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17137 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17138 names, of course.
17139
17140 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17141 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17142 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17143 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17144
17145 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17146 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17147 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17148 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17149 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17150
17151 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17152
17153 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17154 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17155 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17156 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17157
17158
17159 @node Anything Groups
17160 @subsection Anything Groups
17161 @cindex nneething
17162
17163 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17164 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17165 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17166 true.
17167
17168 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17169 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17170 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17171 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17172 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17173 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17174 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17175 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17176 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17177 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17178 elements.
17179
17180 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17181 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17182 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17183 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17184
17185 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17186 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17187 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17188 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17189
17190 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17191 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17192 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17193 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17194 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17195 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17196 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17197 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17198
17199 Some variables:
17200
17201 @table @code
17202 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17203 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17204 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17205 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17206
17207 @item nneething-exclude-files
17208 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17209 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17210 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17211
17212 @item nneething-include-files
17213 @vindex nneething-include-files
17214 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17215 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17216
17217 @item nneething-map-file
17218 @vindex nneething-map-file
17219 Name of the map files.
17220 @end table
17221
17222
17223 @node Document Groups
17224 @subsection Document Groups
17225 @cindex nndoc
17226 @cindex documentation group
17227 @cindex help group
17228
17229 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17230 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17231
17232 @table @code
17233 @cindex Babyl
17234 @item babyl
17235 The Babyl format.
17236
17237 @cindex mbox
17238 @cindex Unix mbox
17239 @item mbox
17240 The standard Unix mbox file.
17241
17242 @cindex MMDF mail box
17243 @item mmdf
17244 The MMDF mail box format.
17245
17246 @item news
17247 Several news articles appended into a file.
17248
17249 @cindex rnews batch files
17250 @item rnews
17251 The rnews batch transport format.
17252
17253 @item nsmail
17254 Netscape mail boxes.
17255
17256 @item mime-parts
17257 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17258
17259 @item standard-digest
17260 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17261
17262 @item mime-digest
17263 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17264
17265 @item lanl-gov-announce
17266 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17267
17268 @cindex git commit messages
17269 @item git
17270 @code{git} commit messages.
17271
17272 @cindex forwarded messages
17273 @item rfc822-forward
17274 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17275
17276 @item outlook
17277 The Outlook mail box.
17278
17279 @item oe-dbx
17280 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17281
17282 @item exim-bounce
17283 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17284
17285 @item forward
17286 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17287
17288 @item rfc934
17289 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17290
17291 @item mailman
17292 A mailman digest.
17293
17294 @item clari-briefs
17295 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17296
17297 @item slack-digest
17298 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17299
17300 @item mail-in-mail
17301 The last resort.
17302 @end table
17303
17304 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17305 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17306 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17307 file is.
17308
17309 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17310 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17311 group. And that's it.
17312
17313 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17314 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17315 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17316 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17317 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17318 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17319 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17320 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17321 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17322 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17323
17324 Virtual server variables:
17325
17326 @table @code
17327 @item nndoc-article-type
17328 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17329 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17330 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17331 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17332 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17333 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17334
17335 @item nndoc-post-type
17336 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17337 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17338 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17339 and @code{news}.
17340 @end table
17341
17342 @menu
17343 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17344 @end menu
17345
17346
17347 @node Document Server Internals
17348 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17349
17350 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17351 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17352 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17353 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17354
17355 First, here's an example document type definition:
17356
17357 @example
17358 (mmdf
17359 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17360 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17361 @end example
17362
17363 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17364 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17365 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17366 types can be defined with very few settings:
17367
17368 @table @code
17369 @item first-article
17370 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17371 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17372 totally ignored.
17373
17374 @item article-begin
17375 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17376 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17377 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17378 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17379
17380 @item article-begin-function
17381 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17382 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17383
17384 @item head-begin
17385 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17386 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17387 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17388
17389 @item head-begin-function
17390 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17391 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17392
17393 @item head-end
17394 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17395 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17396
17397 @item body-begin
17398 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17399 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17400 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17401
17402 @item body-begin-function
17403 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17404 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17405
17406 @item body-end
17407 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17408 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17409 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17410
17411 @item body-end-function
17412 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17413 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17414
17415 @item file-begin
17416 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17417 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17418
17419 @item file-end
17420 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17421 regexp will be totally ignored.
17422
17423 @end table
17424
17425 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17426 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17427 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17428 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17429 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17430
17431 @table @code
17432 @item prepare-body-function
17433 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17434 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17435 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17436
17437 @item article-transform-function
17438 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17439 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17440 body of the article.
17441
17442 @item generate-head-function
17443 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17444 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17445 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17446 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17447
17448 @item generate-article-function
17449 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17450 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17451 parameter when requesting all articles.
17452
17453 @item dissection-function
17454 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17455 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17456 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17457 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17458 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17459 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17460
17461 @end table
17462
17463 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17464 digests:
17465
17466 @example
17467 (standard-digest
17468 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17469 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17470 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17471 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17472 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17473 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17474 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17475 (subtype digest guess))
17476 @end example
17477
17478 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17479 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17480 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17481 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17482 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17483
17484 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17485 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17486 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17487 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17488 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17489 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17490 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17491 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17492 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17493 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17494 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17495 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17496
17497
17498 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17499 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17500 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17501 @cindex gateways
17502
17503 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17504 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17505 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17506
17507 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17508 used to post with.
17509
17510 Server variables:
17511
17512 @table @code
17513 @item nngateway-address
17514 @vindex nngateway-address
17515 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17516
17517 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17518 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17519 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17520 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17521 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17522 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17523 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17524 gateway address.
17525
17526 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17527 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17528 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17529
17530 @example
17531 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17532 @end example
17533
17534 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17535
17536 @example
17537 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17538 @end example
17539
17540 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17541
17542 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17543 @table @code
17544
17545 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17546 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17547 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17548
17549 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17550
17551 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17552 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17553 @code{nngateway-address}.
17554 @end table
17555
17556 @end table
17557
17558 Here's an example:
17559
17560 @lisp
17561 (setq gnus-post-method
17562 '(nngateway
17563 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17564 (nngateway-header-transformation
17565 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17566 @end lisp
17567
17568 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17569
17570 @lisp
17571 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17572 @end lisp
17573
17574
17575 @node The Empty Backend
17576 @subsection The Empty Backend
17577 @cindex nnnil
17578
17579 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17580 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17581 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17582 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17583
17584 @lisp
17585 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17586 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17587 '((nnimap "foo")
17588 (nnml "")))
17589 @end lisp
17590
17591
17592 @node Combined Groups
17593 @section Combined Groups
17594
17595 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17596 groups.
17597
17598 @menu
17599 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17600 @end menu
17601
17602
17603 @node Virtual Groups
17604 @subsection Virtual Groups
17605 @cindex nnvirtual
17606 @cindex virtual groups
17607 @cindex merging groups
17608
17609 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17610 other groups.
17611
17612 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17613 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17614 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17615
17616 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17617 regexp to match component groups.
17618
17619 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17620 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17621 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17622 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17623 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17624 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17625 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17626 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17627
17628 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17629 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17630
17631 @lisp
17632 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17633 @end lisp
17634
17635 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17636 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17637
17638 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17639 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17640 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17641 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17642
17643 @example
17644 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17645 @end example
17646
17647 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17648 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17649 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17650
17651 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17652 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17653 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17654 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17655 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17656
17657 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17658 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17659 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17660
17661 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17662 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17663 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17664 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17665 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17666 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17667 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17668 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17669 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17670 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17671 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17672
17673 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17674 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17675 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17676 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17677 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17678 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17679 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17680
17681 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17682 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17683
17684 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17685 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17686 inherited.
17687
17688
17689 @node Email Based Diary
17690 @section Email Based Diary
17691 @cindex diary
17692 @cindex email based diary
17693 @cindex calendar
17694
17695 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17696 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17697 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17698 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17699 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17700 namely, as event reminders.
17701
17702 Here is a typical scenario:
17703
17704 @itemize @bullet
17705 @item
17706 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17707 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17708 @item
17709 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17710 @item
17711 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17712 @item
17713 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17714 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17715 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17716 @item
17717 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17718 of the night you're gonna have.
17719 @item
17720 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17721 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17722 @end itemize
17723
17724 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17725 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17726 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17727 explained in the sections below.
17728
17729 @menu
17730 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17731 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17732 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17733 @end menu
17734
17735
17736 @node The NNDiary Back End
17737 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17738 @cindex nndiary
17739 @cindex the nndiary back end
17740
17741 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17742 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17743 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17744 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17745 directory per group.
17746
17747 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17748 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17749 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17750 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17751
17752 @menu
17753 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17754 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17755 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17756 @end menu
17757
17758 @node Diary Messages
17759 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17760 @cindex nndiary messages
17761 @cindex nndiary mails
17762
17763 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17764 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17765 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17766 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17767 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17768 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17769 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17770
17771 @itemize @bullet
17772 @item
17773 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17774 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17775 (separated by a comma).
17776 @item
17777 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17778 @item
17779 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17780 @item
17781 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17782 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17783 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17784 @item
17785 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17786 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17787 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17788 @item
17789 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17790 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17791 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17792 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17793 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17794 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17795 @end itemize
17796
17797 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17798 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17799 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17800 what to do then):
17801
17802 @example
17803 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17804 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17805 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17806 X-Diary-Month: *
17807 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17808 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17809 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17810 @end example
17811
17812 @node Running NNDiary
17813 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17814 @cindex running nndiary
17815 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17816
17817 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17818 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17819 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17820 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17821 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17822 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17823
17824 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17825 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17826 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17827 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17828 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17829 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17830 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17831 mode.
17832
17833 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17834 things to do:
17835
17836 @itemize @bullet
17837 @item
17838 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17839 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17840
17841 @lisp
17842 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17843 @end lisp
17844 @item
17845 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17846 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17847 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17848 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17849 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17850
17851 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17852 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17853
17854 @example
17855 :0 HD :
17856 * ^X-Diary
17857 .nndiary
17858 @end example
17859 @end itemize
17860
17861 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17862 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17863
17864 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17865 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17866 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17867 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17868 @end defvar
17869
17870 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17871 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17872 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17873 @end defvar
17874
17875 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17876 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17877 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17878
17879 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17880 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17881 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17882 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17883 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17884
17885 @node Customizing NNDiary
17886 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17887 @cindex customizing nndiary
17888 @cindex nndiary customization
17889
17890 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17891 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17892 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17893 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17894
17895 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17896 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17897 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17898 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17899 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17900 mail.
17901 @end defvar
17902
17903 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17904 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17905 default).
17906 @end defvar
17907
17908
17909 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17910 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17911 @cindex gnus-diary
17912 @cindex the gnus diary library
17913
17914 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17915 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17916 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17917 useful things for you.
17918
17919 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17920
17921 @lisp
17922 (require 'gnus-diary)
17923 @end lisp
17924
17925 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17926 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17927 (sorry if you used them before).
17928
17929
17930 @menu
17931 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17932 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17933 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17934 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17935 @end menu
17936
17937 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17938 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17939 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17940 @cindex diary summary line format
17941
17942 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17943 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17944 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17945 see the event's date.
17946
17947 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17948 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17949 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17950 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17951 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17952
17953 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17954 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17955 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17956
17957 @example
17958 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17959 @end example
17960
17961 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17962 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17963
17964 @lisp
17965 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17966 @end lisp
17967
17968 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17969 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17970 with the following user options:
17971
17972 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17973 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17974 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17975 diary groups'parameters.
17976 @end defvar
17977
17978 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
17979 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
17980 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
17981 @end defvar
17982
17983 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
17984 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
17985 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
17986 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
17987 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
17988 @end defvar
17989
17990 @node Diary Articles Sorting
17991 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
17992 @cindex diary articles sorting
17993 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
17994 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
17995 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
17996 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
17997
17998 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
17999 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18000 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18001 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18002 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18003
18004 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18005 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18006 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18007 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18008 Parameters}).
18009
18010 @node Diary Headers Generation
18011 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18012 @cindex diary headers generation
18013 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18014
18015 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18016 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18017 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18018 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18019 needed.
18020
18021 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18022 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18023 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18024 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18025 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18026
18027 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18028 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18029 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18030 instance.
18031
18032 @node Diary Group Parameters
18033 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18034 @cindex diary group parameters
18035
18036 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18037 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18038 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18039 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18040 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18041 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18042 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18043 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18044
18045 @node Sending or Not Sending
18046 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18047
18048 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18049 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18050
18051 @itemize @bullet
18052 @item
18053 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18054 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18055 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18056 sending the diary message to them as well.
18057 @item
18058 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18059 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18060 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18061 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18062 @end itemize
18063
18064 @node Gnus Unplugged
18065 @section Gnus Unplugged
18066 @cindex offline
18067 @cindex unplugged
18068 @cindex agent
18069 @cindex Gnus agent
18070 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18071
18072 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18073 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18074 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18075 read news. Believe it or not.
18076
18077 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18078 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18079 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18080 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18081 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18082
18083 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18084 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18085 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18086 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18087 reading news on a machine.
18088
18089 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18090 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18091 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18092
18093 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18094
18095 @menu
18096 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18097 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18098 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18099 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18100 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18101 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18102 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18103 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18104 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18105 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18106 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18107 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18108 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18109 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18110 @end menu
18111
18112
18113 @node Agent Basics
18114 @subsection Agent Basics
18115
18116 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18117
18118 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18119 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18120 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18121 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18122
18123 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18124 connected to the net continuously.
18125
18126 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18127 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18128
18129 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18130 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18131 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18132 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18133 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18134
18135 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18136 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18137 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18138 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18139 they're kinda like plugged always).
18140
18141 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18142 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18143 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18144 the culprit.
18145
18146 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18147 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18148 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18149 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18150 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18151
18152 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18153
18154 @itemize @bullet
18155
18156 @item
18157 @findex gnus-unplugged
18158 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18159 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18160 already fetched while in this mode.
18161
18162 @item
18163 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18164 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18165 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18166 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18167 Source Specifiers}).
18168
18169 @item
18170 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18171 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18172 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18173 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18174 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18175
18176 @item
18177 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18178 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18179 then you read the news offline.
18180
18181 @item
18182 And then you go to step 2.
18183 @end itemize
18184
18185 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18186 the Agent.
18187
18188 @itemize @bullet
18189
18190 @item
18191 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18192 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18193 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18194 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18195 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18196 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18197 no servers are agentized.
18198
18199 @item
18200 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18201 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18202 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18203 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18204
18205 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18206 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18207 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18208 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18209 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18210 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18211 configure them.
18212
18213 @item
18214 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18215 @end itemize
18216
18217
18218 @node Agent Categories
18219 @subsection Agent Categories
18220
18221 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18222 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18223 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18224 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18225 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18226 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18227 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18228
18229 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18230 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18231 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18232 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18233 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18234
18235 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18236 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18237 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18238 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18239 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18240 sink.
18241
18242 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18243 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18244 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18245 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18246 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18247 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18248 your settings.
18249
18250 @menu
18251 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18252 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18253 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18254 @end menu
18255
18256
18257 @node Category Syntax
18258 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18259
18260 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18261 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18262 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18263 listed below.
18264
18265 @cindex Agent Parameters
18266 @table @code
18267 @item agent-groups
18268 The list of groups that are in this category.
18269
18270 @item agent-predicate
18271 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18272 are eligible for downloading; and
18273
18274 @item agent-score
18275 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18276 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18277 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18278
18279 @item agent-enable-expiration
18280 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18281 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18282 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18283 only groups that should not be expired.
18284
18285 @item agent-days-until-old
18286 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18287 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18288
18289 @item agent-low-score
18290 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18291
18292 @item agent-high-score
18293 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18294
18295 @item agent-short-article
18296 an integer that overrides the value of
18297 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18298
18299 @item agent-long-article
18300 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18301
18302 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18303 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18304 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18305 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18306 undownloaded faces.
18307 @end table
18308
18309 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18310 created.
18311
18312 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18313 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18314 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18315 category.
18316
18317 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18318 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18319 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18320 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18321
18322 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18323 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18324 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18325
18326 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18327 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18328 operators sprinkled in between.
18329
18330 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18331
18332 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18333 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18334
18335 @lisp
18336 short
18337 @end lisp
18338
18339 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18340 short (for some value of ``short'').
18341
18342 Here's a more complex predicate:
18343
18344 @lisp
18345 (or high
18346 (and
18347 (not low)
18348 (not long)))
18349 @end lisp
18350
18351 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18352 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18353 drift.
18354
18355 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18356 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18357 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18358
18359 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18360 you want to do, you can write your own.
18361
18362 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18363 bound to the value determined by calling
18364 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18365 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18366 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18367 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18368 predicate to individual groups.
18369
18370 @table @code
18371 @item short
18372 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18373 lines; default 100.
18374
18375 @item long
18376 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18377 lines; default 200.
18378
18379 @item low
18380 True if the article has a download score less than
18381 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18382
18383 @item high
18384 True if the article has a download score greater than
18385 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18386
18387 @item spam
18388 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18389 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18390 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18391
18392 @item true
18393 Always true.
18394
18395 @item false
18396 Always false.
18397 @end table
18398
18399 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18400 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18401 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18402 useful values.
18403
18404 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18405 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18406 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18407 something along the lines of the following:
18408
18409 @lisp
18410 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18411 "Say whether an article is old."
18412 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18413 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18414 @end lisp
18415
18416 with the predicate then defined as:
18417
18418 @lisp
18419 (not my-article-old-p)
18420 @end lisp
18421
18422 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18423 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18424 wherever.
18425
18426 @lisp
18427 (require 'gnus-agent)
18428 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18429 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18430 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18431 @end lisp
18432
18433 and simply specify your predicate as:
18434
18435 @lisp
18436 (not old)
18437 @end lisp
18438
18439 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18440 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18441 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18442 just don't give a damn.
18443
18444 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18445 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18446 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18447 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18448 parameters like so:
18449
18450 @lisp
18451 (agent-predicate . short)
18452 @end lisp
18453
18454 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18455 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18456 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18457
18458 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18459
18460 @lisp
18461 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18462 @end lisp
18463
18464 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18465 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18466 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18467
18468
18469 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18470 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18471 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18472 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18473 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18474 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18475
18476 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18477 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18478 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18479 if it's to be specific to that group.
18480
18481 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18482 three forms:
18483
18484 @enumerate
18485 @item
18486 Score rule
18487
18488 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18489 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18490
18491 example:
18492
18493 @itemize @bullet
18494 @item
18495 Category specification
18496
18497 @lisp
18498 (("from"
18499 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18500 ("lines"
18501 (500 -100 nil <)))
18502 @end lisp
18503
18504 @item
18505 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18506
18507 @lisp
18508 (agent-score ("from"
18509 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18510 ("lines"
18511 (500 -100 nil <)))
18512 @end lisp
18513
18514 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18515 @end itemize
18516
18517 @item
18518 Agent score file
18519
18520 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18521 keywords stated above.
18522
18523 example:
18524
18525 @itemize @bullet
18526 @item
18527 Category specification
18528
18529 @lisp
18530 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18531 @end lisp
18532
18533 or perhaps
18534
18535 @lisp
18536 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18537 @end lisp
18538
18539 @item
18540 Group Parameter specification
18541
18542 @lisp
18543 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18544 @end lisp
18545
18546 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18547 about parenthesis?
18548 @end itemize
18549
18550 @item
18551 Use @code{normal} score files
18552
18553 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18554 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18555 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18556 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18557
18558 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18559 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18560 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18561 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18562
18563 @itemize @bullet
18564 @item
18565 Category Specification
18566
18567 @lisp
18568 file
18569 @end lisp
18570
18571 @item
18572 Group Parameter specification
18573
18574 @lisp
18575 (agent-score . file)
18576 @end lisp
18577 @end itemize
18578 @end enumerate
18579
18580 @node Category Buffer
18581 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18582
18583 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18584 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18585 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18586
18587 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18588
18589 @table @kbd
18590 @item q
18591 @kindex q (Category)
18592 @findex gnus-category-exit
18593 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18594
18595 @item e
18596 @kindex e (Category)
18597 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18598 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18599 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18600
18601 @item k
18602 @kindex k (Category)
18603 @findex gnus-category-kill
18604 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18605
18606 @item c
18607 @kindex c (Category)
18608 @findex gnus-category-copy
18609 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18610
18611 @item a
18612 @kindex a (Category)
18613 @findex gnus-category-add
18614 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18615
18616 @item p
18617 @kindex p (Category)
18618 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18619 Edit the predicate of the current category
18620 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18621
18622 @item g
18623 @kindex g (Category)
18624 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18625 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18626 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18627
18628 @item s
18629 @kindex s (Category)
18630 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18631 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18632 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18633
18634 @item l
18635 @kindex l (Category)
18636 @findex gnus-category-list
18637 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18638 @end table
18639
18640
18641 @node Category Variables
18642 @subsubsection Category Variables
18643
18644 @table @code
18645 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18646 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18647 Hook run in category buffers.
18648
18649 @item gnus-category-line-format
18650 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18651 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18652 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18653
18654 @table @samp
18655 @item c
18656 The name of the category.
18657
18658 @item g
18659 The number of groups in the category.
18660 @end table
18661
18662 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18663 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18664 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18665
18666 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18667 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18668 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18669
18670 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18671 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18672 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18673
18674 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18675 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18676 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18677 0.
18678
18679 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18680 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18681 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18682 0.
18683
18684 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18685 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18686 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18687 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18688 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18689 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18690 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18691 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18692 read.
18693 Default 7.
18694
18695 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18696 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18697 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18698 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18699 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18700 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18701 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18702
18703 @end table
18704
18705
18706 @node Agent Commands
18707 @subsection Agent Commands
18708 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18709 @kindex J j (Agent)
18710
18711 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18712 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18713 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18714
18715
18716 @menu
18717 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18718 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18719 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18720 @end menu
18721
18722
18723
18724
18725 @node Group Agent Commands
18726 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18727
18728 @table @kbd
18729 @item J u
18730 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18731 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18732 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18733 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18734
18735 @item J c
18736 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18737 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18738 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18739
18740 @item J s
18741 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18742 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18743 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18744 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18745
18746 @item J S
18747 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18748 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18749 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18750 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18751
18752 @item J a
18753 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18754 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18755 Add the current group to an Agent category
18756 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18757 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18758
18759 @item J r
18760 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18761 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18762 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18763 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18764 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18765
18766 @item J Y
18767 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18768 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18769 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18770
18771
18772 @end table
18773
18774
18775 @node Summary Agent Commands
18776 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18777
18778 @table @kbd
18779 @item J #
18780 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18781 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18782 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18783
18784 @item J M-#
18785 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18786 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18787 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18788 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18789
18790 @cindex %
18791 @item @@
18792 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18793 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18794 Toggle whether to download the article
18795 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18796 default.
18797
18798 @item J c
18799 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18800 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18801 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18802
18803 @item J S
18804 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18805 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18806 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18807 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18808
18809 @item J s
18810 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18811 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18812 Download all processable articles in this group.
18813 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18814
18815 @item J u
18816 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18817 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18818 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18819 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18820
18821 @end table
18822
18823
18824 @node Server Agent Commands
18825 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18826
18827 @table @kbd
18828 @item J a
18829 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18830 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18831 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18832 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18833
18834 @item J r
18835 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18836 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18837 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18838 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18839
18840 @end table
18841
18842
18843 @node Agent Visuals
18844 @subsection Agent Visuals
18845
18846 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18847 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18848 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18849 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18850 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18851 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18852 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18853 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18854 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18855 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18856
18857 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18858 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18859 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18860 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18861 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18862 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18863 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18864 articles will be available when unplugged.
18865
18866 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18867 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18868 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18869 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18870 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18871 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18872 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18873 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18874
18875 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18876 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18877 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18878 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18879 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18880 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18881 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18882 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18883 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18884
18885 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18886 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18887 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18888 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18889 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18890 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18891 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18892 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18893 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18894 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18895
18896 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18897 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18898 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18899 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18900 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18901 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18902
18903 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18904 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18905 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18906 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18907 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18908 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18909 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18910 expiring'' articles.
18911
18912 @node Agent as Cache
18913 @subsection Agent as Cache
18914
18915 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18916 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18917 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18918 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18919 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18920 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18921 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18922 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18923 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18924
18925 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18926 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18927 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18928 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18929 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18930
18931 @node Agent Expiry
18932 @subsection Agent Expiry
18933
18934 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18935 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18936 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18937 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18938 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18939 @cindex agent expiry
18940 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18941 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18942
18943 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18944 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18945 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18946 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18947 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18948 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18949 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18950 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18951
18952 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18953 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18954
18955 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18956 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18957
18958 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18959 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18960 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18961 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18962 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18963 be kept indefinitely.
18964
18965 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18966 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18967 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18968 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18969
18970 @node Agent Regeneration
18971 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18972
18973 @cindex agent regeneration
18974 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18975 @cindex regeneration
18976
18977 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18978 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18979 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18980 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18981 internal inconsistencies.
18982
18983 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18984 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18985 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18986 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18987 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18988 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18989
18990 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18991 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18992 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18993 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18994 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18995 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18996
18997 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18998 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18999 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19000 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19001 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19002 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19003 agent as unread.
19004
19005 @node Agent and flags
19006 @subsection Agent and flags
19007
19008 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19009 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc) on the server. Sadly,
19010 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19011 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19012 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19013 to the flags in its own files.
19014
19015 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19016 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19017 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19018
19019 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19020 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19021 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19022 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19023 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19024 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19025
19026 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19027 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19028 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19029 in the group buffer.
19030
19031 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19032 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19033 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19034 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19035 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19036 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19037 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19038 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19039
19040 @node Agent and IMAP
19041 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19042
19043 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19044 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19045 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19046 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19047
19048 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19049 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19050
19051 @itemize @bullet
19052
19053 @item
19054 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19055
19056 @item
19057 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19058
19059 @end itemize
19060
19061 @node Outgoing Messages
19062 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19063
19064 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19065 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19066 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19067
19068 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19069 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19070 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19071
19072 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19073 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19074 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19075 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19076 mail at any time.
19077
19078 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19079 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19080 ask you to confirm your action (see
19081 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19082
19083 @node Agent Variables
19084 @subsection Agent Variables
19085
19086 @table @code
19087 @item gnus-agent
19088 @vindex gnus-agent
19089 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19090 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19091 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19092 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19093
19094 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19095 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19096
19097
19098 @item gnus-agent-directory
19099 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19100 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19101 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19102
19103 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19104 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19105 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19106 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19107 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19108 by default.
19109
19110 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19111 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19112 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19113
19114 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19115 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19116 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19117
19118 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19119 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19120 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19121
19122 @item gnus-agent-cache
19123 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19124 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19125 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19126 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19127
19128 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19129 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19130 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19131 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19132 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19133 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19134 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19135 online status.
19136
19137 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19138 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19139 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19140 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19141 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19142 read. The default is @code{t}.
19143
19144 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19145 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19146 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19147 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19148 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19149 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19150 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19151
19152 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19153 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19154 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19155 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19156 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19157 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19158 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19159 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19160 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19161 over and over again.
19162
19163 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19164 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19165 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19166 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19167 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19168 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19169 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19170 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19171 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19172 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19173 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19174 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19175 see any cycling.
19176
19177 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19178 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19179 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19180 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19181 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19182 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19183 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19184 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19185 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19186
19187 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19188 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19189 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19190 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19191 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19192 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19193
19194 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19195 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19196 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19197 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19198 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19199
19200 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19201 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19202 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19203 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19204 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19205 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19206
19207 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19208 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19209 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19210 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19211 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19212
19213 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19214 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19215 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19216 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19217 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19218 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19219 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19220 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19221 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19222 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19223 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19224
19225 @end table
19226
19227
19228 @node Example Setup
19229 @subsection Example Setup
19230
19231 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19232 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19233 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19234
19235 @lisp
19236 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19237 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19238 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19239
19240 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19241 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19242 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19243
19244 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19245 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19246
19247 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19248 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19249 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19250 @end lisp
19251
19252 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19253 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19254 gnus}.
19255
19256 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19257 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19258 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19259 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19260 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19261 once.
19262
19263 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19264 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19265 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19266 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19267 back all the killed groups.)
19268
19269 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19270 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19271 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19272
19273
19274 @node Batching Agents
19275 @subsection Batching Agents
19276 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19277
19278 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19279 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19280 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19281
19282 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19283 following incantation:
19284
19285 @example
19286 #!/bin/sh
19287 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19288 @end example
19289
19290
19291 @node Agent Caveats
19292 @subsection Agent Caveats
19293
19294 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19295 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19296 may ask:
19297
19298 @table @dfn
19299 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19300
19301 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19302 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19303 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19304
19305 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19306 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19307
19308 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19309
19310 @end table
19311
19312 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19313 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19314 locally stored articles.
19315
19316
19317 @node Scoring
19318 @chapter Scoring
19319 @cindex scoring
19320
19321 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19322 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19323 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19324 attention!
19325
19326 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19327 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19328 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19329 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19330 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19331
19332 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19333 before generating the summary buffer.
19334
19335 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19336 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19337 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19338
19339 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19340 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19341 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19342 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19343
19344 @menu
19345 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19346 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19347 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19348 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19349 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19350 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19351 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19352 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19353 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19354 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19355 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19356 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19357 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19358 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19359 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19360 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19361 @end menu
19362
19363
19364 @node Summary Score Commands
19365 @section Summary Score Commands
19366 @cindex score commands
19367
19368 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19369 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19370 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19371 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19372 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19373
19374 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19375 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19376 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19377 score file the current one.
19378
19379 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19380
19381 @table @kbd
19382
19383 @item V s
19384 @kindex V s (Summary)
19385 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19386 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19387
19388 @item V S
19389 @kindex V S (Summary)
19390 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19391 Display the score of the current article
19392 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19393
19394 @item V t
19395 @kindex V t (Summary)
19396 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19397 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19398 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19399 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19400 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19401 score file and edit it.
19402
19403 @item V w
19404 @kindex V w (Summary)
19405 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19406 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19407
19408 @item V R
19409 @kindex V R (Summary)
19410 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19411 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19412 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19413 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19414 effect you're having.
19415
19416 @item V c
19417 @kindex V c (Summary)
19418 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19419 Make a different score file the current
19420 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19421
19422 @item V e
19423 @kindex V e (Summary)
19424 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19425 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19426 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19427 File Editing}).
19428
19429 @item V f
19430 @kindex V f (Summary)
19431 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19432 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19433 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19434
19435 @item V F
19436 @kindex V F (Summary)
19437 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19438 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19439 after editing score files.
19440
19441 @item V C
19442 @kindex V C (Summary)
19443 @findex gnus-score-customize
19444 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19445 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19446
19447 @end table
19448
19449 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19450
19451 @table @kbd
19452
19453 @item V m
19454 @kindex V m (Summary)
19455 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19456 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19457 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19458
19459 @item V x
19460 @kindex V x (Summary)
19461 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19462 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19463 expunge all articles below this score
19464 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19465 @end table
19466
19467 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19468 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19469 them.)
19470
19471 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19472 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19473
19474 @enumerate
19475 @item
19476 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19477 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19478 @item
19479 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19480 keys are available:
19481 @table @kbd
19482
19483 @item a
19484 Score on the author name.
19485
19486 @item s
19487 Score on the subject line.
19488
19489 @item x
19490 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19491
19492 @item r
19493 Score on the @code{References} line.
19494
19495 @item d
19496 Score on the date.
19497
19498 @item l
19499 Score on the number of lines.
19500
19501 @item i
19502 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19503
19504 @item e
19505 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19506 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19507
19508 @item f
19509 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19510 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19511 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19512
19513 @item b
19514 Score on the body.
19515
19516 @item h
19517 Score on the head.
19518
19519 @item t
19520 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19521 files.)
19522
19523 @end table
19524
19525 @item
19526 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19527 what headers you are scoring on.
19528
19529 @table @code
19530
19531 @item strings
19532
19533 @table @kbd
19534
19535 @item e
19536 Exact matching.
19537
19538 @item s
19539 Substring matching.
19540
19541 @item f
19542 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19543
19544 @item r
19545 Regexp matching
19546 @end table
19547
19548 @item date
19549 @table @kbd
19550
19551 @item b
19552 Before date.
19553
19554 @item a
19555 After date.
19556
19557 @item n
19558 This date.
19559 @end table
19560
19561 @item number
19562 @table @kbd
19563
19564 @item <
19565 Less than number.
19566
19567 @item =
19568 Equal to number.
19569
19570 @item >
19571 Greater than number.
19572 @end table
19573 @end table
19574
19575 @item
19576 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19577 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19578 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19579 file.
19580 @table @kbd
19581
19582 @item t
19583 Temporary score entry.
19584
19585 @item p
19586 Permanent score entry.
19587
19588 @item i
19589 Immediately scoring.
19590 @end table
19591
19592 @item
19593 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19594 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19595 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19596
19597 @end enumerate
19598
19599 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19600 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19601 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19602 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19603
19604 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19605 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19606 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19607 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19608 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19609
19610 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19611 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19612 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19613 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19614 current score file.
19615
19616 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19617 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19618 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19619
19620
19621 @node Group Score Commands
19622 @section Group Score Commands
19623 @cindex group score commands
19624
19625 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19626
19627 @table @kbd
19628
19629 @item W e
19630 @kindex W e (Group)
19631 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19632 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19633 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19634
19635 @item W f
19636 @kindex W f (Group)
19637 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19638 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19639 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19640 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19641
19642 @end table
19643
19644 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19645
19646 @findex gnus-batch-score
19647 @cindex batch scoring
19648 @example
19649 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19650 @end example
19651
19652
19653 @node Score Variables
19654 @section Score Variables
19655 @cindex score variables
19656
19657 @table @code
19658
19659 @item gnus-use-scoring
19660 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19661 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19662 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19663
19664 @item gnus-kill-killed
19665 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19666 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19667 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19668 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19669 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19670 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19671 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19672
19673 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19674 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19675 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19676 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19677 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19678
19679 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19680 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19681 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19682 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19683
19684 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19685 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19686 @cindex score cache
19687 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19688 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19689 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19690 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19691 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19692 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19693 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19694 be cached.
19695
19696 @item gnus-save-score
19697 @vindex gnus-save-score
19698 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19699 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19700 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19701
19702 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19703 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19704 across group visits.
19705
19706 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19707 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19708 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19709 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19710 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19711 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19712 manually entered data.
19713
19714 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19715 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19716 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19717
19718 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19719 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19720 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19721 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19722 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19723 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19724
19725 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19726 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19727 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19728 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19729
19730 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19731 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19732 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19733 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19734
19735 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19736 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19737 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19738 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19739
19740 Predefined functions available are:
19741 @table @code
19742
19743 @item gnus-score-find-single
19744 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19745 Only apply the group's own score file.
19746
19747 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19748 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19749 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19750 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19751 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19752 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19753 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19754 then a regexp match is done.
19755
19756 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19757 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19758
19759 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19760 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19761 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19762 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19763
19764 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19765 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19766 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19767 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19768 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19769 server.
19770
19771 @end table
19772 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19773 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19774 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19775 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19776 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19777 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19778 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19779 Phu.
19780
19781 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19782 overall score file, you could use the value
19783 @example
19784 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19785 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19786 @end example
19787
19788 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19789 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19790 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19791 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19792 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19793
19794 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19795 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19796 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19797 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19798 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19799 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19800 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19801 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19802
19803 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19804 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19805 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19806
19807 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19808 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19809 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19810 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19811 threading---according to the current value of
19812 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19813 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19814 simplified in this manner.
19815
19816 @end table
19817
19818
19819 @node Score File Format
19820 @section Score File Format
19821 @cindex score file format
19822
19823 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19824 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19825 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19826
19827 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19828
19829 @lisp
19830 (("from"
19831 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19832 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19833 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19834 ("subject"
19835 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19836 ("xref"
19837 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19838 ("lines"
19839 (2 -100 nil <))
19840 (mark 0)
19841 (expunge -1000)
19842 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19843 (read-only nil)
19844 (orphan -10)
19845 (adapt t)
19846 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19847 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19848 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19849 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19850 (eval (ding)))
19851 @end lisp
19852
19853 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19854 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19855
19856 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19857 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19858 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19859
19860 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19861
19862 @table @code
19863
19864 @item STRING
19865 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19866 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19867 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19868 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19869 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19870 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19871 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19872 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19873 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19874 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19875 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19876 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19877 to articles that matches these score entries.
19878
19879 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19880 score entry has one to four elements.
19881 @enumerate
19882
19883 @item
19884 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19885 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19886 integer.
19887
19888 @item
19889 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19890 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19891 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19892 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19893 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19894 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19895
19896 @item
19897 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19898 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19899 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19900 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19901 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19902
19903 @item
19904 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19905 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19906 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19907 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19908 @table @dfn
19909
19910 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19911 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19912 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19913 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19914 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19915 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19916 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19917 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19918 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19919 instead, if you feel like.
19920
19921 @item Extra
19922 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19923 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19924 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19925 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19926 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19927 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19928 overviews:
19929
19930 @lisp
19931 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19932 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19933 @end lisp
19934
19935 @item Lines, Chars
19936 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19937 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19938
19939 These predicates are true if
19940
19941 @example
19942 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19943 @end example
19944
19945 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19946 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19947 following form:
19948
19949 @lisp
19950 (< header-value 4)
19951 @end lisp
19952
19953 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19954 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19955 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19956 it's not. I think.)
19957
19958 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19959 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19960 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19961 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19962
19963 @item Date
19964 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19965 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19966 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19967 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19968 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19969 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19970 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19971
19972 @cindex ISO8601
19973 @cindex date
19974 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19975 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19976 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19977 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19978 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19979 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19980 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19981 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19982 whole family, eh?)
19983
19984 @item Head, Body, All
19985 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
19986 header uses.
19987
19988 @item Followup
19989 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19990 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19991 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19992 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19993 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19994 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19995 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19996 files.)
19997
19998 @item Thread
19999 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20000 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20001 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20002 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20003 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20004 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20005 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20006 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20007 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20008 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20009 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20010 @end table
20011 @end enumerate
20012
20013 @cindex score file atoms
20014 @item mark
20015 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20016 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20017
20018 @item expunge
20019 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20020 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20021
20022 @item mark-and-expunge
20023 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20024 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20025 summary buffer.
20026
20027 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20028 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20029 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20030 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20031 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20032
20033 @item files
20034 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20035 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20036 this one was.
20037
20038 @item exclude-files
20039 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20040 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20041 other.
20042
20043 @item eval
20044 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20045 ignored when handling global score files.
20046
20047 @item read-only
20048 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20049 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20050 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20051 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20052
20053 @item orphan
20054 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20055 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20056 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20057 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20058
20059 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20060
20061 @example
20062 (orphan -500)
20063 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20064 @end example
20065
20066 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20067 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20068 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20069 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20070 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20071
20072 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20073 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20074 scoring rules exist.
20075
20076 @item adapt
20077 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20078 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20079 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20080 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20081 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20082 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20083 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20084 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20085 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20086 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20087 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20088 it.
20089
20090 @item adapt-file
20091 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20092 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20093 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20094 file for a number of groups.
20095
20096 @item local
20097 @cindex local variables
20098 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20099 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20100 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20101 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20102 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20103 be evaluated.
20104 @end table
20105
20106
20107 @node Score File Editing
20108 @section Score File Editing
20109
20110 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20111 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20112 with a mode for that.
20113
20114 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20115 additional commands:
20116
20117 @table @kbd
20118
20119 @item C-c C-c
20120 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20121 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20122 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20123 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20124
20125 @item C-c C-d
20126 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20127 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20128 Insert the current date in numerical format
20129 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20130 you were wondering.
20131
20132 @item C-c C-p
20133 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20134 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20135 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20136 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20137 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20138 you.
20139
20140 @end table
20141
20142 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20143
20144 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20145 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20146
20147 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20148 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20149
20150
20151 @node Adaptive Scoring
20152 @section Adaptive Scoring
20153 @cindex adaptive scoring
20154
20155 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20156 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20157 stupidity, to be precise.
20158
20159 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20160 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20161 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20162 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20163 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20164 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20165 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20166 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20167 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20168
20169 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20170 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20171 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20172 might look something like this:
20173
20174 @lisp
20175 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20176 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20177 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20178 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20179 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20180 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20181 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20182 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20183 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20184 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20185 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20186 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20187 @end lisp
20188
20189 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20190 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20191 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20192 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20193 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20194 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20195 entries.
20196
20197 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20198 will be applied to each article.
20199
20200 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20201 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20202 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20203 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20204
20205 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20206 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20207 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20208 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20209
20210 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20211 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20212 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20213 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20214
20215 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20216 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20217 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20218 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20219 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20220 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20221
20222 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20223 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20224 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20225
20226 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20227 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20228 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20229
20230 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20231 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20232 let you use different rules in different groups.
20233
20234 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20235 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20236 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20237 is @file{ADAPT}.
20238
20239 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20240 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20241 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20242 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20243
20244 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20245 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20246 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20247 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20248 the length of the match is less than
20249 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20250 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20251 this problem.
20252
20253 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20254 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20255 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20256 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20257 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20258
20259 @lisp
20260 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20261 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20262 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20263 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20264 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20265 @end lisp
20266
20267 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20268 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20269 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20270 score with 30 points.
20271
20272 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20273 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20274 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20275 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20276 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20277
20278 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20279 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20280 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20281 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20282 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20283
20284 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20285 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20286 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20287 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20288
20289 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20290 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20291 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20292 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20293
20294 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20295 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20296 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20297 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20298 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20299
20300 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20301 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20302 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20303
20304 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20305 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20306 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20307 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20308
20309
20310 @node Home Score File
20311 @section Home Score File
20312
20313 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20314 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20315 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20316 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20317
20318 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20319 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20320 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20321
20322 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20323 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20324 be:
20325
20326 @enumerate
20327 @item
20328 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20329 groups.
20330
20331 @item
20332 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20333 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20334 parameter.
20335
20336 @item
20337 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20338
20339 @enumerate
20340 @item
20341 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20342 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20343
20344 @item
20345 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20346 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20347 name of the group as the parameter.
20348
20349 @item
20350 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20351 @end enumerate
20352
20353 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20354 for matches.
20355
20356 @end enumerate
20357
20358 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20359
20360 @lisp
20361 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20362 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20363 @end lisp
20364
20365 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20366 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20367
20368 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20369 @lisp
20370 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20371 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20372 @end lisp
20373
20374 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20375 Other functions include
20376
20377 @table @code
20378 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20379 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20380 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20381 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20382
20383 @end table
20384
20385 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20386 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20387 their own home score files:
20388
20389 @lisp
20390 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20391 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20392 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20393 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20394 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20395 @end lisp
20396
20397 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20398 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20399 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20400 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20401 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20402
20403 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20404 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20405 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20406 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20407 precedence over this variable.
20408
20409
20410 @node Followups To Yourself
20411 @section Followups To Yourself
20412
20413 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20414 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20415 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20416 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20417 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20418 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20419
20420 @table @code
20421
20422 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20423 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20424 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20425 article.
20426
20427 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20428 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20429 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20430 your own article.
20431 @end table
20432
20433 @vindex message-sent-hook
20434 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20435 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20436 @lisp
20437 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20438 @end lisp
20439
20440
20441 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20442 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20443 mine:
20444
20445 @example
20446 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20447 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20448 @end example
20449
20450 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20451 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20452 myself:
20453
20454 @lisp
20455 ("references"
20456 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20457 1000 nil r))
20458 @end lisp
20459
20460 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20461 is system-dependent.
20462
20463
20464 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20465 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20466 @cindex scoring on other headers
20467
20468 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20469 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20470 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20471 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20472 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20473
20474 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20475 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20476 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20477 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20478 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20479 inhibited for all groups.
20480
20481 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20482 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20483 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20484 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20485 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20486
20487 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20488
20489 @lisp
20490 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20491 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20492 @end lisp
20493
20494 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20495 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20496 time if you have much mail.
20497
20498 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20499 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20500
20501 See? Simple.
20502
20503
20504 @node Scoring Tips
20505 @section Scoring Tips
20506 @cindex scoring tips
20507
20508 @table @dfn
20509
20510 @item Crossposts
20511 @cindex crossposts
20512 @cindex scoring crossposts
20513 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20514 the @code{Xref} header.
20515 @lisp
20516 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20517 @end lisp
20518
20519 @item Multiple crossposts
20520 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20521 more than, say, 3 groups:
20522 @lisp
20523 ("xref"
20524 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20525 -1000 nil r))
20526 @end lisp
20527
20528 @item Matching on the body
20529 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20530 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20531 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20532 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20533 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20534 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20535 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20536 the matches.
20537
20538 @item Marking as read
20539 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20540 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20541 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20542 @lisp
20543 ((mark -100))
20544 @end lisp
20545 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20546
20547 @item Negated character classes
20548 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20549 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20550 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20551 @end table
20552
20553
20554 @node Reverse Scoring
20555 @section Reverse Scoring
20556 @cindex reverse scoring
20557
20558 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20559 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20560 like this in your score file:
20561
20562 @lisp
20563 (("subject"
20564 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20565 (mark 1)
20566 (expunge 1))
20567 @end lisp
20568
20569 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20570 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20571
20572
20573 @node Global Score Files
20574 @section Global Score Files
20575 @cindex global score files
20576
20577 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20578 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20579 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20580
20581 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20582 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20583 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20584
20585 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20586 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20587 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20588 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20589 files are applicable to which group.
20590
20591 To use the score file
20592 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20593 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20594 say this:
20595
20596 @lisp
20597 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20598 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20599 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20600 @end lisp
20601
20602 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20603 @noindent
20604 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20605 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20606 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20607 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20608
20609 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20610 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20611
20612 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20613 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20614 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20615 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20616 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20617 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20618
20619 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20620 head:
20621
20622 @itemize @bullet
20623
20624 @item
20625 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20626 @item
20627 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20628 @item
20629 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20630 @item
20631 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20632 lowered out of existence.
20633 @item
20634 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20635 articles completely.
20636
20637 @item
20638 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20639 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20640 old articles for a long time.
20641 @end itemize
20642
20643 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20644 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20645 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20646 holding our breath yet?
20647
20648
20649 @node Kill Files
20650 @section Kill Files
20651 @cindex kill files
20652
20653 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20654 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20655 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20656
20657 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20658 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20659 files into score files.
20660
20661 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20662 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20663 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20664 that isn't a very good idea.
20665
20666 Normal kill files look like this:
20667
20668 @lisp
20669 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20670 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20671 (gnus-expunge "X")
20672 @end lisp
20673
20674 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20675 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20676
20677 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20678 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20679 interpreting it.
20680
20681 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20682
20683 @table @kbd
20684
20685 @item M-k
20686 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20687 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20688 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20689
20690 @item M-K
20691 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20692 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20693 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20694 @end table
20695
20696 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20697
20698 @table @kbd
20699
20700 @item M-k
20701 @kindex M-k (Group)
20702 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20703 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20704
20705 @item M-K
20706 @kindex M-K (Group)
20707 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20708 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20709 @end table
20710
20711 Kill file variables:
20712
20713 @table @code
20714 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20715 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20716 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20717 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20718 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20719 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20720 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20721
20722 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20723 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20724 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20725 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20726 kills.
20727
20728 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20729 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20730 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20731 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20732 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20733 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20734 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20735 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20736 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20737
20738 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20739 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20740 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20741
20742 @end table
20743
20744
20745 @node Converting Kill Files
20746 @section Converting Kill Files
20747 @cindex kill files
20748 @cindex converting kill files
20749
20750 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20751 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20752 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20753 by hand.
20754
20755 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20756 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20757 from
20758 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20759
20760 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20761 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20762 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20763 before.
20764
20765
20766 @node Advanced Scoring
20767 @section Advanced Scoring
20768
20769 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20770 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20771 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20772 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20773 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20774
20775 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20776 scoring patterns.
20777
20778 @menu
20779 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20780 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20781 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20782 @end menu
20783
20784
20785 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20786 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20787
20788 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20789 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20790 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20791 non-@code{nil} value.
20792
20793 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20794 operator, and various match operators.
20795
20796 Logical operators:
20797
20798 @table @code
20799 @item &
20800 @itemx and
20801 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20802 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20803 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20804 @code{true}.
20805
20806 @item |
20807 @itemx or
20808 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20809 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20810 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20811
20812 @item !
20813 @itemx not
20814 @itemx ¬
20815 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20816 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20817
20818 @end table
20819
20820 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20821 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20822 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20823 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20824 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20825 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20826 the ancestry you want to go.
20827
20828 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20829 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20830 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20831 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20832 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20833
20834
20835 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20836 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20837
20838 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20839 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20840 of parentheses.
20841
20842 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20843 when he's talking about Gnus:
20844
20845 @example
20846 @group
20847 ((&
20848 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20849 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20850 1000)
20851 @end group
20852 @end example
20853
20854 Quite simple, huh?
20855
20856 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20857
20858 @example
20859 ((&
20860 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20861 (|
20862 ("subject" "Gnus")
20863 ("lines" 100 >)))
20864 1000)
20865 @end example
20866
20867 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20868 really don't want to read what he's written:
20869
20870 @example
20871 ((&
20872 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20873 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20874 -100000)
20875 @end example
20876
20877 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20878 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20879 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20880 very interesting:
20881
20882 @example
20883 ((&
20884 (1-
20885 (&
20886 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20887 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20888 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20889 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20890 1000)
20891 @end example
20892
20893 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20894 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20895 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20896 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20897
20898 @example
20899 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20900 -200)
20901 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20902 200)
20903 @end example
20904
20905 The possibilities are endless.
20906
20907 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20908 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20909
20910 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20911 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20912 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20913 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20914 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20915 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20916 @samp{subject}) first.
20917
20918 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20919 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20920 something like:
20921
20922 @example
20923 ...
20924 (1-
20925 (1-
20926 ("from" "lars")))
20927 ...
20928 @end example
20929
20930 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20931 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20932
20933 @example
20934 (1-
20935 (&
20936 ("from" "Lars")
20937 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20938 @end example
20939
20940 than it is to say:
20941
20942 @example
20943 (&
20944 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20945 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20946 @end example
20947
20948
20949 @node Score Decays
20950 @section Score Decays
20951 @cindex score decays
20952 @cindex decays
20953
20954 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20955 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20956 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20957 use them in any sensible way.
20958
20959 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20960 @findex gnus-decay-score
20961 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20962 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20963 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20964 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20965 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20966 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20967 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20968 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20969 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20970 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20971 function:
20972
20973 @lisp
20974 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20975 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20976 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20977 (let ((n (- score
20978 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20979 (min (abs score)
20980 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20981 (* (abs score)
20982 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20983 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20984 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
20985 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20986 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20987 (string-to-number
20988 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20989 (floor n))))
20990 @end lisp
20991
20992 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20993 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20994 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20995 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20996
20997 @enumerate
20998 @item
20999 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21000
21001 @item
21002 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21003
21004 @item
21005 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21006 score.
21007 @end enumerate
21008
21009 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21010 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21011 the new score, which should be an integer.
21012
21013 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21014 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21015
21016 @node Searching
21017 @chapter Searching
21018 @cindex searching
21019
21020 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21021 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21022 as well.
21023
21024 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21025 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21026 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21027 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21028
21029 @menu
21030 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21031 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21032 @end menu
21033
21034 @node nnir
21035 @section nnir
21036 @cindex nnir
21037
21038 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21039 within gnus.
21040
21041 @menu
21042 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21043 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21044 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21045 @end menu
21046
21047 @node What is nnir?
21048 @subsection What is nnir?
21049
21050 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21051 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21052 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21053 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21054 interface.
21055
21056 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21057 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21058 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21059
21060
21061 @node Basic Usage
21062 @subsection Basic Usage
21063
21064 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21065 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21066 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21067 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21068 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21069 using the usual commands.
21070
21071 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21072 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21073 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21074 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21075 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21076 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21077 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21078 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21079 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21080 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21081 whatever. Go nuts.
21082
21083 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21084 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21085 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21086 will search all the groups under that heading.
21087
21088 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21089 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21090 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21091 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21092 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21093
21094 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21095 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21096 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21097 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21098 special search features for each engine separately.
21099
21100
21101 @node Setting up nnir
21102 @subsection Setting up nnir
21103
21104 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21105 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21106 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21107 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21108 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21109 a backend.
21110
21111 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21112 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21113 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21114 query language anyway.
21115
21116 @menu
21117 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21118 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21119 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21120 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21121 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21122 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21123 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21124 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21125 @end menu
21126
21127 @node Associating Engines
21128 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21129
21130
21131 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21132 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21133 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21134 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21135 named @code{home} you can use
21136
21137 @lisp
21138 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21139 '((nnml "home"
21140 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21141 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21142 @end lisp
21143
21144 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21145 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21146 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21147 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21148 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21149 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21150 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21151 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21152 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21153 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21154 could change this to
21155
21156 @lisp
21157 '((nnimap . namazu)
21158 (nntp . gmane))
21159 @end lisp
21160
21161 @node The imap Engine
21162 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21163
21164 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21165
21166 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21167 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21168 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21169
21170 @table @samp
21171
21172 @item Boolean query operators
21173 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21174 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21175 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21176 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
21177 term.
21178
21179 @item Automatic AND queries
21180 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21181 expression intended to match all components.
21182
21183 @item Phrase searches
21184 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21185 literal string.
21186
21187 @end table
21188
21189 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21190 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21191 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21192 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21193 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21194 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21195 the query to the Message-ID header.
21196
21197 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21198 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21199 RFC3501.
21200
21201 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21202 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21203 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21204
21205 @lisp
21206 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21207 @end lisp
21208
21209 @node The gmane Engine
21210 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21211
21212 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21213
21214 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21215
21216 @table @samp
21217 @item Boolean query operators
21218 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21219 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21220 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21221 recognized.
21222
21223 @item Required and excluded terms
21224 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21225 @minus{}american
21226
21227 @item Unicode handling
21228 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21229 in any language.
21230
21231 @item Stopwords
21232 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21233 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21234 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21235
21236 @end table
21237
21238 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21239 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21240 name (or part of a name) to match.
21241
21242 @node The swish++ Engine
21243 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21244
21245 FIXME: Say something more here.
21246
21247 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21248 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21249
21250 @table @code
21251
21252 @item nnir-swish++-program
21253 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21254
21255 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21256 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21257 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21258
21259 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21260 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21261 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21262
21263 @end table
21264
21265 @node The swish-e Engine
21266 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21267
21268 FIXME: Say something more here.
21269
21270 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21271 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21272
21273 @table @code
21274
21275 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21276 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21277
21278 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21279 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21280 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21281
21282 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21283 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21284 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21285
21286 @end table
21287
21288 @node The namazu Engine
21289 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21290
21291 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21292 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21293 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21294 variable.
21295
21296 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21297 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21298 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21299 instead of `.').
21300
21301 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21302 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21303 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21304 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21305 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21306 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21307 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21308
21309 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21310 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21311 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21312 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21313 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21314 information on valid switches.
21315
21316 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21317 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21318
21319 @cartouche
21320 @example
21321 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21322
21323 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21324 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21325
21326 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21327 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21328
21329 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21330 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21331
21332 # The max length of a word.
21333 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21334
21335 # The max length of a field.
21336 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21337 @end example
21338 @end cartouche
21339
21340 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21341 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21342 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21343 the following command:
21344
21345 @example
21346 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21347 @end example
21348
21349 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21350 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21351
21352 @node The hyrex Engine
21353 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21354 This engine is obsolete.
21355
21356 @node Customizations
21357 @subsubsection Customizations
21358
21359 @table @code
21360
21361 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21362 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
21363 are
21364 @example
21365 (nnimap . imap)
21366 (nntp . gmane)
21367 @end example
21368
21369 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21370 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21371 when searching all groups on a server.
21372
21373 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21374 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21375 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21376 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21377
21378 @example
21379 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21380 %G Article original full group name (string)
21381 %g Article original short group name (string)
21382 @end example
21383
21384 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21385
21386 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21387 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21388 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21389 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21390 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21391 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21392 should return @code{nil}
21393
21394 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21395 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21396
21397
21398 @end table
21399
21400
21401 @node nnmairix
21402 @section nnmairix
21403
21404 @cindex mairix
21405 @cindex nnmairix
21406 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21407 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21408 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21409 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21410
21411 @menu
21412 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21413 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21414 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21415 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21416 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21417 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21418 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21419 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21420 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21421 @end menu
21422
21423 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21424 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21425 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21426
21427 @node About mairix
21428 @subsection About mairix
21429
21430 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21431 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21432 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21433 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21434 be found at
21435 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21436
21437 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21438 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21439 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21440 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21441 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21442 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21443 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21444 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21445 up.
21446
21447 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21448 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21449 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21450 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21451 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21452 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21453 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21454 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21455 searches.
21456
21457 @node nnmairix requirements
21458 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21459
21460 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21461 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21462 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21463 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21464
21465 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21466 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21467 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21468 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21469
21470 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21471 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21472 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21473 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21474 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21475 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21476
21477 @node What nnmairix does
21478 @subsection What nnmairix does
21479
21480 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21481 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21482 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21483 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21484 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21485 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21486 mails are in different folders.
21487
21488 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21489 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21490 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21491 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21492 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21493 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21494
21495 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21496 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21497 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21498 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21499 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21500 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21501 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21502 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21503 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21504 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21505 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21506
21507 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21508 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21509 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21510 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21511 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21512 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21513 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21514 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21515 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21516 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21517 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21518 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21519 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21520 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21521 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21522 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21523
21524 @node Setting up mairix
21525 @subsection Setting up mairix
21526
21527 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21528
21529 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21530 (at least) the following entries:
21531
21532 @example
21533 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21534 base=~/Maildir
21535 @end example
21536
21537 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21538 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21539 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21540 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21541
21542 @example
21543 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21544 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21545 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21546 @end example
21547
21548 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21549 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21550 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21551 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21552 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21553
21554 @example
21555 omit=zz_mairix-*
21556 @end example
21557
21558 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21559 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21560 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21561 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21562
21563 @example
21564 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21565 database= ... location of database file ...
21566 @end example
21567
21568 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21569 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21570 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21571
21572 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21573
21574 @example
21575 base=~/Maildir
21576 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21577 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21578 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21579 mformat=maildir
21580 omit=zz_mairix-*
21581 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21582 @end example
21583
21584 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21585 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21586 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21587 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21588 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21589 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21590 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21591 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21592 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21593 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21594 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21595 The other lines should be obvious.
21596
21597 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21598 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21599 than you are used to.
21600
21601 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21602 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21603 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21604
21605 @node Configuring nnmairix
21606 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21607
21608 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21609 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21610 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21611 server. You will have to specify the following:
21612
21613 @itemize @bullet
21614
21615 @item
21616 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21617 want.
21618
21619 @item
21620 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21621 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21622 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21623 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21624 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21625 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21626 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21627 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21628 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21629 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21630 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21631 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21632 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21633 @code{nnimap} server here.
21634
21635 @item
21636 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21637 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21638 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21639 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21640 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21641 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21642 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21643
21644 @item
21645 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21646 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21647 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21648 like.
21649
21650 @item
21651 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21652 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21653 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21654 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21655 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21656
21657 @end itemize
21658
21659 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21660 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21661
21662 In group mode:
21663
21664 @table @kbd
21665
21666 @item G b c
21667 @kindex G b c (Group)
21668 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21669 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21670 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21671 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21672
21673 @item G b s
21674 @kindex G b s (Group)
21675 @findex nnmairix-search
21676 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21677 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21678 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21679
21680 @item G b m
21681 @kindex G b m (Group)
21682 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21683 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21684 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21685 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21686
21687 @item G b i
21688 @kindex G b i (Group)
21689 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21690 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21691 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21692
21693 @item G b g
21694 @kindex G b g (Group)
21695 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21696 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21697 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21698 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21699 @kbd{M-g}.
21700
21701 @item G b q
21702 @kindex G b q (Group)
21703 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21704 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21705 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21706
21707 @item G b t
21708 @kindex G b t (Group)
21709 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21710 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21711 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21712 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21713
21714 @item G b u
21715 @kindex G b u (Group)
21716 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21717 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21718 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21719 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21720 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21721 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21722 options).
21723
21724 @item G b r
21725 @kindex G b r (Group)
21726 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21727 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21728 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21729
21730 @item G b d
21731 @kindex G b d (Group)
21732 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21733 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21734 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21735 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21736
21737 @item G b a
21738 @kindex G b a (Group)
21739 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21740 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21741 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21742 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21743 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21744 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21745 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21746 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21747 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21748
21749 @item G b p
21750 @kindex G b p (Group)
21751 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21752 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21753 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21754 marks}).
21755
21756 @item G b o
21757 @kindex G b o (Group)
21758 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21759 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21760 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21761
21762 @end table
21763
21764 In summary mode:
21765
21766 @table @kbd
21767
21768 @item $ m
21769 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21770 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21771 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21772 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21773 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21774
21775 @item $ g
21776 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21777 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21778 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21779 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21780 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21781
21782 @item $ t
21783 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21784 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21785 Searches thread for the current article
21786 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21787 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21788 current article and enabled threads.
21789
21790 @item $ f
21791 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21792 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21793 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21794 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21795 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21796
21797 @item $ o
21798 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21799 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21800 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21801 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21802 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21803 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21804 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21805 article file name as a fallback method.
21806
21807 @item $ u
21808 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21809 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21810 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21811 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21812 tips and tricks}).
21813
21814 @end table
21815
21816 @node Propagating marks
21817 @subsection Propagating marks
21818
21819 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21820 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21821 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21822
21823 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21824
21825 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21826 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21827 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21828 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21829 be useful to you.
21830
21831 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21832 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21833 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21834 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21835 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21836 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21837 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21838 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21839 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21840 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21841
21842 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21843 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21844 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21845 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21846 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21847 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21848 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21849
21850 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21851 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21852 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21853 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21854 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21855 even more cumbersome.
21856
21857 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21858 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21859 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21860
21861 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21862 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21863 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21864 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21865 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21866 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21867 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21868
21869 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21870 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21871 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21872 magically be set for the original article, too.
21873
21874 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21875
21876 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21877 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21878 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21879 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21880 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21881 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21882 details).
21883
21884 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21885 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21886 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21887 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21888 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21889 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21890 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21891
21892 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21893 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21894 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21895 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21896 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21897 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21898 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21899
21900 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21901 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21902 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21903 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21904 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21905 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21906 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21907 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21908 maildir as its file format.
21909
21910 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21911 If you work with this setup, just set
21912 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21913 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21914 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21915 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21916 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21917 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21918
21919 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21920 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21921
21922 @itemize
21923 @item
21924 Checking Mail
21925
21926 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21927 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21928 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21929 Levels}).
21930
21931 I use the following to check for mails:
21932
21933 @lisp
21934 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21935 (interactive "P")
21936 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21937 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21938 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21939 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21940
21941 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21942 @end lisp
21943
21944 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21945 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21946 details.
21947
21948 @item
21949 Example: search group for ticked articles
21950
21951 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21952 articles always stay unread:
21953
21954 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
21955 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21956
21957 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21958 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21959
21960 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21961 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21962 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21963 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21964 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21965 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21966 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21967 e.g., by marking an article as read.
21968
21969 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21970 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21971 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21972 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21973 snippet and the doc string for details.
21974
21975 @item
21976 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
21977
21978 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
21979 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
21980 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
21981 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
21982 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
21983 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
21984 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
21985 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
21986 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
21987 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
21988 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
21989 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
21990
21991 @lisp
21992 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
21993 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
21994 @end lisp
21995
21996 @end itemize
21997
21998 @node nnmairix caveats
21999 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22000
22001 @itemize
22002 @item
22003 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22004 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22005 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22006 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22007 an example server definition:
22008
22009 @lisp
22010 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22011 @end lisp
22012
22013 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22014 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22015 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22016 mairix.)
22017
22018 @item
22019 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22020 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22021 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22022 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22023 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22024 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22025 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22026
22027 @item
22028 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22029 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22030
22031 @item
22032 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22033 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22034
22035 @item
22036 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22037
22038 @item
22039 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22040 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22041 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22042 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22043 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22044 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22045 folders.
22046
22047 @item
22048 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22049 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22050 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22051 it is gone for good.
22052
22053 @item
22054 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22055 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22056 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22057 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22058 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22059 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22060 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22061 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22062 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22063
22064 @item
22065 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22066 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22067
22068 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22069 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22070 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22071 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22072 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22073 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22074 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22075 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22076 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22077 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22078 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22079 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22080
22081 @end itemize
22082
22083 @iftex
22084 @iflatex
22085 @chapter Message
22086 @include message.texi
22087 @chapter Emacs MIME
22088 @include emacs-mime.texi
22089 @chapter Sieve
22090 @include sieve.texi
22091 @chapter EasyPG
22092 @include epa.texi
22093 @chapter SASL
22094 @include sasl.texi
22095 @end iflatex
22096 @end iftex
22097
22098 @node Various
22099 @chapter Various
22100
22101 @menu
22102 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22103 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22104 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22105 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22106 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22107 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22108 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22109 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22110 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22111 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22112 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22113 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22114 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22115 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22116 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22117 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22118 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22119 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22120 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22121 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22122 @end menu
22123
22124
22125 @node Process/Prefix
22126 @section Process/Prefix
22127 @cindex process/prefix convention
22128
22129 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22130 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22131
22132 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22133 command to be performed on.
22134
22135 It goes like this:
22136
22137 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22138 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22139 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22140 with the current one.
22141
22142 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22143 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22144 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22145
22146 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22147 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22148 the process mark.
22149
22150 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22151 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22152
22153 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22154 are avoided.
22155
22156 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22157 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22158 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22159 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22160
22161 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22162 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22163 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22164 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22165 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22166 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22167 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22168 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22169
22170 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22171 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22172 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22173 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22174 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22175
22176
22177 @node Interactive
22178 @section Interactive
22179 @cindex interaction
22180
22181 @table @code
22182
22183 @item gnus-novice-user
22184 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22185 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22186 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22187 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22188 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22189 default.
22190
22191 @item gnus-expert-user
22192 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22193 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22194 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22195 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22196 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22197 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22198 confirmation.
22199
22200 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22201 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22202 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22203 is @code{t} by default.
22204
22205 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22206 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22207 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22208 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22209 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22210 @end table
22211
22212
22213 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22214 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22215 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22216
22217 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22218 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22219 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22220 rule of 900 to the current article.
22221
22222 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22223 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22224 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22225 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22226 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22227 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22228 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22229
22230 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22231 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22232 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22233 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22234 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22235 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22236 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22237 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22238 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22239
22240 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22241 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22242 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22243
22244 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22245 Interactive}.
22246
22247
22248 @node Formatting Variables
22249 @section Formatting Variables
22250 @cindex formatting variables
22251
22252 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22253 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22254 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22255 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22256 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22257 be annoyed by.
22258
22259 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22260 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22261 lots of percentages everywhere.
22262
22263 @menu
22264 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22265 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22266 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22267 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22268 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22269 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22270 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22271 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22272 @end menu
22273
22274 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22275 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22276 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22277 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22278 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22279 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22280 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22281 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22282
22283 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22284 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22285
22286 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22287 @findex gnus-update-format
22288 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22289 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22290 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22291 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22292
22293
22294
22295 @node Formatting Basics
22296 @subsection Formatting Basics
22297
22298 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22299 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22300 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22301
22302 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22303 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22304 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22305 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22306 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22307 the right instead.
22308
22309 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22310 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22311 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22312 less than 4 characters wide.
22313
22314 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22315 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22316
22317
22318 @node Mode Line Formatting
22319 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22320
22321 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22322 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22323 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22324 with the following two differences:
22325
22326 @enumerate
22327
22328 @item
22329 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22330
22331 @item
22332 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22333 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22334 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22335 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22336 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22337 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22338 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22339
22340 @end enumerate
22341
22342
22343 @node Advanced Formatting
22344 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22345
22346 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22347 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22348 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22349 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22350
22351 These are the valid modifiers:
22352
22353 @table @code
22354 @item pad
22355 @itemx pad-left
22356 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22357 length.
22358
22359 @item pad-right
22360 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22361 length.
22362
22363 @item max
22364 @itemx max-left
22365 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22366
22367 @item max-right
22368 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22369 length.
22370
22371 @item cut
22372 @itemx cut-left
22373 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22374
22375 @item cut-right
22376 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22377
22378 @item ignore
22379 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22380
22381 @item form
22382 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22383 used.
22384
22385 Here's an example:
22386
22387 @lisp
22388 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22389 @end lisp
22390
22391 @end table
22392
22393 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22394 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22395 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22396 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22397 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22398 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22399 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22400
22401 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22402 last operation, padding.
22403
22404
22405 @node User-Defined Specs
22406 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22407
22408 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22409 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22410 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22411 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22412 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22413 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22414 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22415 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22416 should protect against that.
22417
22418 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22419 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22420
22421 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22422 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22423 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22424 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22425 inserted.
22426
22427
22428 @node Formatting Fonts
22429 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22430
22431 @cindex %(, %)
22432 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22433 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22434 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22435 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22436 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22437 over it.
22438
22439 @cindex %@{, %@}
22440 @vindex gnus-face-0
22441 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22442 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22443 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22444 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22445 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22446 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22447
22448 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22449 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22450 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22451 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22452 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22453 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22454 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22455 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22456 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22457 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22458 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22459 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22460 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22461 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22462 paragraph.)
22463
22464 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22465
22466 @lisp
22467 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22468 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22469 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22470
22471 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22472 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22473 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22474 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22475 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22476 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22477 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22478
22479 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22480 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22481 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22482 @end lisp
22483
22484 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22485 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22486
22487 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22488 mode-line variables.
22489
22490 @node Positioning Point
22491 @subsection Positioning Point
22492
22493 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22494 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22495 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22496
22497 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22498
22499 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22500 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22501 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22502
22503 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22504 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22505 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22506 place point there.
22507
22508
22509 @node Tabulation
22510 @subsection Tabulation
22511
22512 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22513 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22514 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22515 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22516
22517 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22518 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22519
22520 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22521 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22522 This is the soft tabulator.
22523
22524 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22525 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22526 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22527
22528
22529 @node Wide Characters
22530 @subsection Wide Characters
22531
22532 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22533 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22534 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22535
22536 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22537 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22538 these countries, that's not true.
22539
22540 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22541 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22542 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22543 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22544 for Emacs.
22545
22546
22547 @node Window Layout
22548 @section Window Layout
22549 @cindex window layout
22550
22551 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22552
22553 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22554 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22555 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22556 @code{t} by default.
22557
22558 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22559 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22560
22561 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22562 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22563 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22564
22565 @lisp
22566 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22567 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22568 (article 1.0))))
22569 @end lisp
22570
22571 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22572 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22573 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22574 possible names is listed below.
22575
22576 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22577 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22578
22579 @lisp
22580 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22581 (article 1.0)))
22582 @end lisp
22583
22584 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22585 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22586 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22587 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22588 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22589 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22590 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22591 size spec per split.
22592
22593 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22594 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22595 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22596 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22597 present) gets focus.
22598
22599 Here's a more complicated example:
22600
22601 @lisp
22602 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22603 (summary 0.25 point)
22604 (article 1.0)))
22605 @end lisp
22606
22607 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22608 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22609 occupy, not a percentage.
22610
22611 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22612 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22613 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22614 be used as a split.
22615
22616 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22617
22618 @lisp
22619 (article (horizontal 1.0
22620 (vertical 0.5
22621 (group 1.0))
22622 (vertical 1.0
22623 (summary 0.25 point)
22624 (article 1.0))))
22625 @end lisp
22626
22627 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22628 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22629
22630 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22631 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22632 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22633 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22634 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22635
22636 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22637 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22638 lines from the splits.
22639
22640 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22641 may look like:
22642
22643 @example
22644 @group
22645 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22646 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22647 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22648 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22649 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22650 size = number | frame-params
22651 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22652 @end group
22653 @end example
22654
22655 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22656 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22657 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22658 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22659
22660 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22661 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22662 @cindex window height
22663 @cindex window width
22664 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22665 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22666 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22667 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22668 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22669 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22670
22671 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22672 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22673 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22674 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22675
22676 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22677 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22678 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22679 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22680 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22681 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22682 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22683 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22684 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22685 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22686 configuration list.
22687
22688 @lisp
22689 (gnus-configure-frame
22690 '(horizontal 1.0
22691 (vertical 10
22692 (group 1.0)
22693 (article 0.3 point))
22694 (vertical 1.0
22695 (article 1.0)
22696 (horizontal 4
22697 (group 1.0)
22698 (article 10)))))
22699 @end lisp
22700
22701 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22702 @code{frame} split:
22703
22704 @lisp
22705 (gnus-configure-frame
22706 '(frame 1.0
22707 (vertical 1.0
22708 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22709 (article 1.0))
22710 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22711 (user-position . t)
22712 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22713 (picon 1.0))))
22714
22715 @end lisp
22716
22717 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22718 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22719 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22720 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22721 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22722 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22723 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22724 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22725 is such a plist.
22726 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22727 be found in its default value.
22728
22729 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22730 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22731 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22732 might be used:
22733
22734 @lisp
22735 (message (horizontal 1.0
22736 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22737 (vertical 0.24
22738 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22739 '(summary 0.5))
22740 (group 1.0))))
22741 @end lisp
22742
22743 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22744 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22745 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22746
22747 @lisp
22748 (message
22749 (frame 1.0
22750 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22751 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22752 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22753 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22754 (name . "Message"))
22755 (message 1.0 point))))
22756 @end lisp
22757
22758 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22759 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22760 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22761 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22762 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22763
22764 @lisp
22765 (gnus-add-configuration
22766 '(article (vertical 1.0
22767 (group 4)
22768 (summary .25 point)
22769 (article 1.0))))
22770 @end lisp
22771
22772 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22773 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22774 Gnus has been loaded.
22775
22776 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22777 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22778 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22779 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22780 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22781
22782 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22783 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22784 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22785 windows resized.
22786
22787 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22788
22789 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22790 and when they're used:
22791
22792 @table @code
22793 @item group
22794 The group buffer.
22795
22796 @item summary
22797 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22798
22799 @item article
22800 Selecting an article.
22801
22802 @item server
22803 The server buffer.
22804
22805 @item browse
22806 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22807
22808 @item message
22809 Composing a (new) message.
22810
22811 @item only-article
22812 Showing only the article buffer.
22813
22814 @item edit-article
22815 Editing an article.
22816
22817 @item edit-form
22818 Editing group parameters and the like.
22819
22820 @item edit-score
22821 Editing a server definition.
22822
22823 @item post
22824 Composing a news message.
22825
22826 @item reply
22827 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22828
22829 @item forward
22830 Forwarding a message.
22831
22832 @item reply-yank
22833 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22834
22835 @item mail-bound
22836 Bouncing a message.
22837
22838 @item pipe
22839 Sending an article to an external process.
22840
22841 @item bug
22842 Sending a bug report.
22843
22844 @item score-trace
22845 Displaying the score trace.
22846
22847 @item score-words
22848 Displaying the score words.
22849
22850 @item split-trace
22851 Displaying the split trace.
22852
22853 @item compose-bounce
22854 Composing a bounce message.
22855
22856 @item mml-preview
22857 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22858
22859 @end table
22860
22861
22862 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22863
22864 @itemize @bullet
22865 @item
22866 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22867 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22868
22869 @ifinfo
22870 @example
22871 +---+---------+
22872 | G | Summary |
22873 | r +---------+
22874 | o | |
22875 | u | Article |
22876 | p | |
22877 +---+---------+
22878 @end example
22879 @end ifinfo
22880
22881 @lisp
22882 (gnus-add-configuration
22883 '(article
22884 (horizontal 1.0
22885 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22886 (vertical 1.0
22887 (summary 0.16 point)
22888 (article 1.0)))))
22889
22890 (gnus-add-configuration
22891 '(summary
22892 (horizontal 1.0
22893 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22894 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22895 @end lisp
22896
22897 @end itemize
22898
22899
22900 @node Faces and Fonts
22901 @section Faces and Fonts
22902 @cindex faces
22903 @cindex fonts
22904 @cindex colors
22905
22906 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22907 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22908 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22909 interface.
22910
22911
22912 @node Mode Lines
22913 @section Mode Lines
22914 @cindex mode lines
22915
22916 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22917 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22918 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22919 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22920 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22921 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22922 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22923 quicker.
22924
22925 @cindex display-time
22926
22927 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22928 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22929 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22930 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22931 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22932 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22933 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22934 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
22935 this variable:
22936
22937 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22938 @lisp
22939 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22940 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22941 (+ 21
22942 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22943 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22944 (length display-time-string)))))
22945 @end lisp
22946
22947 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22948 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22949 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22950 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22951 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22952
22953
22954 @node Highlighting and Menus
22955 @section Highlighting and Menus
22956 @cindex visual
22957 @cindex highlighting
22958 @cindex menus
22959
22960 @vindex gnus-visual
22961 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22962 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22963 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22964 file.
22965
22966 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22967 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22968
22969 @table @code
22970 @item group-highlight
22971 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22972 @item summary-highlight
22973 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22974 @item article-highlight
22975 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22976 @item highlight
22977 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22978 @item group-menu
22979 Create menus in the group buffer.
22980 @item summary-menu
22981 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22982 @item article-menu
22983 Create menus in the article buffer.
22984 @item browse-menu
22985 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22986 @item server-menu
22987 Create menus in the server buffer.
22988 @item score-menu
22989 Create menus in the score buffers.
22990 @item menu
22991 Create menus in all buffers.
22992 @end table
22993
22994 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22995 buffers, you could say something like:
22996
22997 @lisp
22998 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22999 @end lisp
23000
23001 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23002
23003 @lisp
23004 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23005 @end lisp
23006
23007 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23008 in all Gnus buffers.
23009
23010 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23011
23012 @table @code
23013 @item gnus-mouse-face
23014 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23015 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23016 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23017
23018 @end table
23019
23020 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23021
23022 @table @code
23023
23024 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23025 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23026 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23027
23028 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23029 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23030 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23031
23032 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23033 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23034 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23035
23036 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23037 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23038 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23039
23040 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23041 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23042 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23043
23044 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23045 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23046 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23047
23048 @end table
23049
23050
23051 @node Daemons
23052 @section Daemons
23053 @cindex demons
23054 @cindex daemons
23055
23056 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23057 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23058 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23059 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23060 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23061
23062 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23063 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23064 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23065
23066 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23067 been idle for thirty minutes:
23068
23069 @lisp
23070 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23071 @end lisp
23072
23073 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23074 Emacs is idle:
23075
23076 @lisp
23077 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23078 @end lisp
23079
23080 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23081 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23082 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23083
23084 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23085 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23086 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23087 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23088
23089 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23090 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23091 @var{idle} minutes.
23092
23093 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23094 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23095 minutes.
23096
23097 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23098 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23099 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23100
23101 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23102 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23103 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23104 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23105
23106 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23107 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23108
23109 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23110 @lisp
23111 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23112 @end lisp
23113
23114 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23115 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23116 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23117 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23118 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23119 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23120 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23121 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23122 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23123 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23124
23125 @findex gnus-demon-init
23126 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23127 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23128 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23129 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23130 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23131
23132 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23133 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23134 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23135 behave.
23136
23137
23138 @node Undo
23139 @section Undo
23140 @cindex undo
23141
23142 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23143 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23144 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23145
23146 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23147 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23148 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23149 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23150 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23151 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23152 @code{undo} function.
23153
23154 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23155 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23156 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23157 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23158 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23159 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23160 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23161 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23162 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23163 never be totally undoable.
23164
23165 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23166 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23167 @findex gnus-undo
23168 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23169 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23170 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23171 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23172 command.
23173
23174
23175 @node Predicate Specifiers
23176 @section Predicate Specifiers
23177 @cindex predicate specifiers
23178
23179 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23180 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23181 to type all that much.
23182
23183 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23184
23185 Here's an example:
23186
23187 @lisp
23188 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23189 gnus-article-unread-p)
23190 @end lisp
23191
23192 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23193 functions all take one parameter.
23194
23195 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23196 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23197 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23198 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23199 specifier.
23200
23201
23202 @node Moderation
23203 @section Moderation
23204 @cindex moderation
23205
23206 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23207 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23208 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23209 get a copy.
23210
23211 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23212 buffers. Put
23213
23214 @lisp
23215 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23216 @end lisp
23217
23218 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23219
23220 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23221 supposed to work:
23222
23223 @enumerate
23224 @item
23225 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23226 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23227 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23228
23229 @item
23230 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23231 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23232
23233 @item
23234 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23235 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23236 @kbd{c} command.
23237 @end enumerate
23238
23239 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23240
23241 @lisp
23242 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23243 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23244 @end lisp
23245
23246
23247 @node Fetching a Group
23248 @section Fetching a Group
23249 @cindex fetching a group
23250
23251 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23252 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23253 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23254 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23255 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23256 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23257
23258
23259 @node Image Enhancements
23260 @section Image Enhancements
23261
23262 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23263 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23264 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23265
23266 @menu
23267 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23268 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23269 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23270 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23271 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23272 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23273 @end menu
23274
23275
23276 @node X-Face
23277 @subsection X-Face
23278 @cindex x-face
23279
23280 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23281 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23282 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23283 readers.
23284
23285 @cindex x-face
23286 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23287 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23288 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23289 @iftex
23290 @iflatex
23291 \include{xface}
23292 @end iflatex
23293 @end iftex
23294 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23295
23296 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23297 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23298 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23299 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23300 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23301 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23302 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23303 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23304 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23305 @code{display} program.
23306
23307 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23308 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23309 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23310 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23311 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23312 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23313 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23314 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23315
23316 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23317 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23318 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23319 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23320 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23321 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23322
23323 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23324 @code{xface}).
23325
23326 @noindent
23327 Face and variable:
23328
23329 @table @code
23330 @item gnus-x-face
23331 @vindex gnus-x-face
23332 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23333 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23334 default colors are black and white.
23335
23336 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23337 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23338 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23339 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23340 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23341 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23342
23343 @lisp
23344 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23345 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23346 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23347 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23348
23349 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23350 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23351 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23352 (png . (:relief -2))))
23353 @end lisp
23354
23355 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23356 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23357 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23358 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23359 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23360 @samp{libcompface} library.
23361 @end table
23362
23363 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23364 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23365 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23366 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23367 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23368 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23369
23370 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23371 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23372 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23373 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23374 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23375 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23376 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23377 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23378 header data as a string.
23379
23380 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23381 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23382 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23383 randomly generated data.
23384
23385 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23386 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23387 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23388 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23389 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23390
23391 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23392 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23393
23394 @lisp
23395 (setq message-required-news-headers
23396 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23397 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23398 @end lisp
23399
23400 Using the last function would be something like this:
23401
23402 @lisp
23403 (setq message-required-news-headers
23404 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23405 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23406 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23407 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23408 @end lisp
23409
23410
23411 @node Face
23412 @subsection Face
23413 @cindex face
23414
23415 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23416
23417 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23418 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23419 represent the author of the message.
23420
23421 @cindex face
23422 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23423 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23424 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23425 specifications.
23426
23427 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23428 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23429
23430 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23431 PNG images.
23432 @c Maybe add this:
23433 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23434 @c (featurep 'png)
23435 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23436
23437 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23438 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23439
23440 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23441 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23442 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23443
23444 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23445 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23446 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23447 converts the file to Face format by using the
23448 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23449
23450 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23451 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23452
23453 @lisp
23454 (setq message-required-news-headers
23455 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23456 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23457 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23458 @end lisp
23459
23460
23461 @node Smileys
23462 @subsection Smileys
23463 @cindex smileys
23464
23465 @iftex
23466 @iflatex
23467 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23468 \input{smiley}
23469 @end iflatex
23470 @end iftex
23471
23472 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23473 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23474
23475 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23476 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23477
23478 @lisp
23479 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23480 @end lisp
23481
23482 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23483 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23484 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23485 text and maps that to file names.
23486
23487 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23488 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23489 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23490 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23491 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23492 displayed.
23493
23494 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23495
23496 @table @code
23497
23498 @item smiley-style
23499 @vindex smiley-style
23500 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23501 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23502 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23503 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23504 face.
23505
23506 @item smiley-data-directory
23507 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23508 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23509 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23510
23511 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23512 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23513 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23514
23515 @end table
23516
23517
23518 @node Picons
23519 @subsection Picons
23520
23521 @iftex
23522 @iflatex
23523 \include{picons}
23524 @end iflatex
23525 @end iftex
23526
23527 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23528 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23529 over your shoulder as you read news.
23530
23531 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23532
23533 @iftex
23534 @iflatex
23535 \margindex{}
23536 @end iflatex
23537 @end iftex
23538
23539 @quotation
23540 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23541 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23542 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23543 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23544 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23545 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23546 @code{GIF} formats.
23547 @end quotation
23548
23549 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23550 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23551 point your Web browser at
23552 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23553
23554 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23555 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23556
23557 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23558 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23559 Picons databases.
23560
23561 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23562 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23563 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23564 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23565
23566 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23567 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23568 properties applied to picons.
23569
23570 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23571
23572 @table @code
23573
23574 @item gnus-picon-databases
23575 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23576 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23577 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23578 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23579 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23580
23581 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23582 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23583 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23584 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23585
23586 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23587 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23588 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23589 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23590
23591 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23592 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23593 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23594 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23595 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23596
23597 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23598 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23599 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23600 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23601
23602 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23603 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23604 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23605 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23606 interesting.
23607
23608 @end table
23609
23610 @node Gravatars
23611 @subsection Gravatars
23612
23613 @iftex
23614 @iflatex
23615 \include{gravatars}
23616 @end iflatex
23617 @end iftex
23618
23619 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23620
23621 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23622
23623 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23624
23625 @table @code
23626
23627 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23628 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23629 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23630 number for the size is enough.
23631
23632 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23633 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23634 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23635
23636 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23637 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23638 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23639 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23640 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23641
23642 @end table
23643
23644 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23645 @lisp
23646 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23647 @end lisp
23648
23649 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23650
23651 @lisp
23652 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23653 @end lisp
23654
23655
23656 @node XVarious
23657 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23658
23659 @table @code
23660 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23661 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23662 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23663 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23664 unusual directory structure.
23665
23666 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23667 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23668 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23669 default.
23670
23671 @end table
23672
23673 @subsubsection Toolbar
23674
23675 @table @code
23676
23677 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23678 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23679 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23680 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23681 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23682 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23683 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23684 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23685
23686 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23687 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23688 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23689 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23690 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23691 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23692
23693 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23694 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23695 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23696
23697 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23698 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23699 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23700
23701 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23702 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23703 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23704
23705 @end table
23706
23707 @iftex
23708 @iflatex
23709 \margindex{}
23710 @end iflatex
23711 @end iftex
23712
23713
23714 @node Fuzzy Matching
23715 @section Fuzzy Matching
23716 @cindex fuzzy matching
23717
23718 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23719 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23720
23721 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23722 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23723 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23724
23725 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23726 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23727 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23728 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23729 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23730
23731
23732 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23733 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23734 @cindex email spam
23735 @cindex spam
23736 @cindex UCE
23737 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23738
23739 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23740 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23741 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23742 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23743 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23744 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23745 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23746 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23747 in the end.
23748
23749 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23750 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23751 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23752 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23753 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23754 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23755
23756 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23757
23758 @menu
23759 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23760 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23761 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23762 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23763 @end menu
23764
23765 @node The problem of spam
23766 @subsection The problem of spam
23767 @cindex email spam
23768 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23769 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23770 @cindex UCE
23771 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23772
23773 First, some background on spam.
23774
23775 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23776 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23777 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23778 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23779 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23780 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23781 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23782 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23783 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23784
23785 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23786 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23787 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23788 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23789 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23790 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23791 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23792 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23793 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23794 and processing.
23795
23796 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23797 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23798 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23799 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23800 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23801 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23802 from Bulgarian IPs.
23803
23804 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23805 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23806 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23807 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23808
23809 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23810 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23811 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23812 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23813
23814 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23815 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23816 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23817 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23818 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23819 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23820 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23821 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23822 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23823
23824 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23825 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23826 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23827 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23828 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23829 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23830 down for some time because of the incident.
23831
23832 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23833 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23834 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23835 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23836 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23837 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23838 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23839 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23840 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23841 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23842 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23843
23844 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23845 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23846 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23847 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23848 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23849 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23850 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23851 spam plague.
23852
23853 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23854 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23855 @cindex email spam
23856 @cindex spam
23857 @cindex UCE
23858 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23859
23860 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23861 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23862
23863 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23864 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23865 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23866 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23867 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23868 part of the mail address.)
23869
23870 @lisp
23871 (setq message-default-news-headers
23872 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23873 @end lisp
23874
23875 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23876 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23877
23878 @lisp
23879 (...
23880 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23881 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23882 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23883 "spam"))
23884 ...)
23885 @end lisp
23886
23887 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23888 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23889 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23890 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23891
23892 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23893 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23894 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23895 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23896 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23897 your fancy split rule in this way:
23898
23899 @lisp
23900 (
23901 ...
23902 (to "larsi" "misc")
23903 "spam")
23904 @end lisp
23905
23906 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23907 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23908 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23909 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23910 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23911
23912 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23913 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23914 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23915 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23916
23917 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23918
23919
23920 @node SpamAssassin
23921 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23922 @cindex SpamAssassin
23923 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23924 @cindex DCC
23925
23926 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23927 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23928 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23929 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23930 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23931 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23932 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23933
23934 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23935 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23936 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23937 recipes.
23938
23939 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23940 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23941 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23942 Specifiers}) follow.
23943
23944 @lisp
23945 (setq mail-sources
23946 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23947 (pop :user "jrl"
23948 :server "pophost"
23949 :postscript
23950 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23951 @end lisp
23952
23953 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23954 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23955 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23956
23957 @lisp
23958 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23959 ...))
23960 @end lisp
23961
23962 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23963
23964 @lisp
23965 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23966 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23967 ...))
23968 @end lisp
23969
23970 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23971 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23972 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23973 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23974
23975 @lisp
23976 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23977 ...))
23978 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23979 (save-excursion
23980 (save-restriction
23981 (widen)
23982 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23983 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23984 "spam"))))
23985 @end lisp
23986
23987 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
23988 downloaded by default. You need to set
23989 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23990 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
23991
23992 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23993 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23994 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23995
23996 @lisp
23997 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23998 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23999 (interactive)
24000 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24001 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24002 @end lisp
24003
24004 @node Hashcash
24005 @subsection Hashcash
24006 @cindex hashcash
24007
24008 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24009 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24010 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24011 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24012 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24013
24014 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24015 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24016 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24017 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24018 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24019 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24020 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24021 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24022 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24023 one of them separately.
24024
24025 @cindex X-Hashcash
24026 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24027 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24028 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24029 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24030 need to install to use this feature, see
24031 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24032 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24033
24034 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24035 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24036 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24037
24038 @lisp
24039 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24040 @end lisp
24041
24042 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24043
24044 @table @code
24045
24046 @item hashcash-default-payment
24047 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24048 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24049 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24050 include 17 to 29.
24051
24052 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24053 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24054 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24055 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24056 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24057 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24058 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24059 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24060 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24061
24062 @item hashcash-path
24063 @vindex hashcash-path
24064 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24065 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24066 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24067 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24068 when you generate hashcash payments.
24069
24070 @end table
24071
24072 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24073 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24074 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24075 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24076 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24077 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24078 Hashcash Payments}).
24079
24080 @node Spam Package
24081 @section Spam Package
24082 @cindex spam filtering
24083 @cindex spam
24084
24085 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24086 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24087 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24088 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24089
24090 @menu
24091 * Spam Package Introduction::
24092 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24093 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24094 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24095 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24096 * Spam Back Ends::
24097 * Extending the Spam package::
24098 * Spam Statistics Package::
24099 @end menu
24100
24101 @node Spam Package Introduction
24102 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24103 @cindex spam filtering
24104 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24105 @cindex spam
24106
24107 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24108 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24109
24110 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24111 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24112
24113 @cindex spam-initialize
24114 @vindex spam-use-stat
24115 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24116 @code{spam-initialize}:
24117
24118 @example
24119 (spam-initialize)
24120 @end example
24121
24122 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24123 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24124 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24125 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24126 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24127
24128 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24129 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24130
24131 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24132 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24133
24134 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24135 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24136 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24137 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24138 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24139
24140 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24141 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24142 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24143 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24144 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24145 Groups}.
24146
24147 @cindex spam back ends
24148 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24149 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24150 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24151 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24152 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24153
24154 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24155 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24156
24157 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24158 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24159 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24160 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24161 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24162 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24163 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24164
24165 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24166 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24167 point, the Spam package does several things:
24168
24169 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24170 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24171 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24172 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24173 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24174 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24175 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24176 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24177 Ham Processors}.
24178
24179 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24180 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24181 group:
24182
24183 @table @kbd
24184 @item $
24185 @itemx M-d
24186 @itemx M s x
24187 @itemx S x
24188 @kindex $ (Summary)
24189 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24190 @kindex S x (Summary)
24191 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24192 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24193 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24194 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24195 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24196 @end table
24197
24198 @noindent
24199 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24200 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24201
24202 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24203 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24204 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24205 to be processed as ham by setting
24206 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24207 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24208
24209 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24210 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24211 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24212 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24213 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24214 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24215 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24216 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24217 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24218 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24219 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24220 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24221
24222 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24223 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24224 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24225 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24226 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24227 Configuration Examples}.
24228
24229 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24230 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24231 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24232 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24233
24234 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24235 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24236
24237 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24238 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24239 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24240
24241 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24242 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24243 @cindex spam filtering
24244 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24245 @cindex spam
24246
24247 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24248 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24249 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24250 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24251 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24252
24253 @example
24254 (: spam-split)
24255 @end example
24256
24257 @vindex spam-split-group
24258 @noindent
24259 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24260 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24261 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24262 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24263 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24264 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24265 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24266 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24267 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24268
24269 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24270
24271 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24272 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24273 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24274 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24275 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24276 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24277 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24278 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24279 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24280 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24281 IMAP Splitting}.
24282
24283 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24284 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24285 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24286 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24287 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24288 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24289 ends, and the following split rule:
24290
24291 @example
24292 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24293 (any "ding" "ding")
24294 (: spam-split)
24295 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24296 "mail")
24297 @end example
24298
24299 @noindent
24300 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24301 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24302 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24303 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24304 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24305 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24306
24307 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24308 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24309 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24310 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24311
24312 @example
24313 nnimap-split-fancy
24314 '(|
24315 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24316 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24317 (any "ding" "ding")
24318 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24319 (: spam-split)
24320 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24321 "mail")
24322 @end example
24323
24324 @noindent
24325 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24326 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24327 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24328 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24329 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24330 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24331 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24332
24333 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24334 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24335 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24336 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24337
24338 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24339 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24340 @c don't.}
24341
24342 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24343 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24344
24345 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24346 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24347 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24348 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24349
24350 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24351 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24352 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24353 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24354
24355 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24356 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24357 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24358
24359 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24360 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24361 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24362 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24363 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24364 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24365 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24366
24367 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24368 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24369 @cindex spam filtering
24370 @cindex spam filtering variables
24371 @cindex spam variables
24372 @cindex spam
24373
24374 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24375 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24376 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24377 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24378 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24379 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24380 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24381
24382 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24383 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24384 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24385 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24386
24387 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24388 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24389 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24390 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24391 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24392 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24393 by customizing the corresponding variable
24394 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24395 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24396 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24397 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24398 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24399 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24400 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24401 default.
24402
24403 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24404 @cindex $
24405 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24406 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24407 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24408 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24409 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24410 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24411 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24412 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24413 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24414 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24415 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24416 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24417 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24418
24419 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24420 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24421 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24422 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24423 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24424 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24425 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24426 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24427
24428 @defvar ham-marks
24429 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24430 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24431 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24432 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24433 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24434 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24435 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24436 happy for you.
24437 @end defvar
24438
24439 @defvar spam-marks
24440 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24441 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24442 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24443 you really want to.
24444 @end defvar
24445
24446 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24447 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24448 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24449 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24450 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24451 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24452 and nothing else.
24453
24454 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24455 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24456 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24457 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24458 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24459 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24460 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24461 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24462 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24463 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24464 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24465 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24466 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24467 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24468 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24469
24470 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24471 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24472
24473 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24474 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24475 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24476
24477 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24478 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24479
24480 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24481 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24482 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24483 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24484 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24485
24486 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24487 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24488 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24489 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24490 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24491 it there.
24492
24493 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24494 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24495 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24496 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24497 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24498 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24499 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24500 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24501 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24502 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24503 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24504 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24505 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24506
24507 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24508 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24509
24510 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24511 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24512 training} groups.
24513
24514 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24515 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24516 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24517 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24518 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24519 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24520 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24521
24522 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24523 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24524 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24525 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24526
24527 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24528 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24529 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24530 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24531 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24532 from the mail server.
24533
24534 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24535 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24536 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24537 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24538
24539 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24540 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24541 @cindex spam filtering
24542 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24543 @cindex spam configuration examples
24544 @cindex spam
24545
24546 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24547
24548 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24549 @example
24550 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24551 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24552 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24553 (spam-initialize)
24554
24555 (setq
24556 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24557 spam-use-BBDB t
24558 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24559 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24560 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24561 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24562 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24563 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24564 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24565 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24566 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24567 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24568 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24569 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24570 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24571 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24572 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24573 (any "ding" "ding")
24574 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24575 (: spam-split)
24576 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24577 "mail"))
24578
24579 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24580
24581 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24582 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24583 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24584 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24585
24586 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24587
24588 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24589 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24590 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24591 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24592 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24593
24594 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24595 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24596
24597 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24598
24599 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24600 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24601
24602 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24603 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24604 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24605
24606 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24607
24608 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24609 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24610
24611 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24612 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24613 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24614 (ham-marks
24615 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24616 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24617 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24618 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24619
24620 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24621 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24622 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24623
24624 @end example
24625
24626 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24627 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24628
24629 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24630 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24631 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24632 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24633 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24634 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24635 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24636 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24637 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24638
24639 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24640 does most of the job for me:
24641
24642 @lisp
24643 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24644 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24645 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24646 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24647 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24648 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24649 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24650 @end lisp
24651
24652 @itemize
24653
24654 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24655
24656 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24657 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24658 bogofilter or DCC).
24659
24660 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24661 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24662 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24663 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24664 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24665 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24666 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24667
24668 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24669 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24670 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24671 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24672 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24673 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24674
24675 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24676
24677 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24678 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24679 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24680 @samp{training.spam}.
24681 @end itemize
24682
24683 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24684
24685 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24686
24687 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24688 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24689 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24690
24691 @lisp
24692 ("^gmane\\."
24693 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24694 @end lisp
24695
24696 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24697 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24698 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24699 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24700 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24701
24702 @node Spam Back Ends
24703 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24704 @cindex spam back ends
24705
24706 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24707 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24708 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24709 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24710 Processors}).
24711
24712 @menu
24713 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24714 * BBDB Whitelists::
24715 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24716 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24717 * Blackholes::
24718 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24719 * Bogofilter::
24720 * SpamAssassin back end::
24721 * ifile spam filtering::
24722 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24723 * SpamOracle::
24724 @end menu
24725
24726 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24727 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24728 @cindex spam filtering
24729 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24730 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24731 @cindex spam
24732
24733 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24734
24735 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24736 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24737 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24738 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24739 be spammers.
24740
24741 @end defvar
24742
24743 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24744
24745 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24746 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24747 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24748 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24749 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24750
24751 @end defvar
24752
24753 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24754
24755 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24756 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24757 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24758
24759 @end defvar
24760
24761 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24762
24763 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24764 customizing the group parameters or the
24765 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24766 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24767 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24768
24769 @emph{WARNING}
24770
24771 Instead of the obsolete
24772 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24773 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24774 the same way, we promise.
24775
24776 @end defvar
24777
24778 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24779
24780 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24781 customizing the group parameters or the
24782 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24783 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24784 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24785 whitelist.
24786
24787 @emph{WARNING}
24788
24789 Instead of the obsolete
24790 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24791 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24792 the same way, we promise.
24793
24794 @end defvar
24795
24796 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24797 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24798 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24799 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24800 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24801
24802 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24803 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24804 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24805 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24806
24807 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24808 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24809 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24810 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24811 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24812 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24813
24814 @node BBDB Whitelists
24815 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24816 @cindex spam filtering
24817 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24818 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24819 @cindex spam
24820
24821 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24822
24823 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24824 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24825 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24826 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24827 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24828 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24829 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24830
24831 @end defvar
24832
24833 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24834
24835 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24836 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24837 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24838 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24839 classified as spammers.
24840
24841 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24842 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24843 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24844 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24845 will be exclusive.
24846
24847 @end defvar
24848
24849 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24850
24851 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24852 customizing the group parameters or the
24853 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24854 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24855 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24856 BBDB.
24857
24858 @emph{WARNING}
24859
24860 Instead of the obsolete
24861 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24862 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24863 the same way, we promise.
24864
24865 @end defvar
24866
24867 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24868 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24869 @cindex spam reporting
24870 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24871 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24872 @cindex spam
24873
24874 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24875
24876 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24877 customizing the group parameters or the
24878 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24879 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24880 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24881 HTTP request.
24882
24883 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24884
24885 @emph{WARNING}
24886
24887 Instead of the obsolete
24888 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24889 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24890 same way, we promise.
24891
24892 @end defvar
24893
24894 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24895
24896 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24897 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24898 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24899 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24900 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24901
24902 @end defvar
24903
24904 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24905
24906 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24907 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24908 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24909
24910 @end defvar
24911
24912 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24913 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24914 @cindex spam filtering
24915 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24916 @cindex spam
24917
24918 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24919
24920 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24921 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24922 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24923 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24924 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24925 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24926
24927 @end defvar
24928
24929 @node Blackholes
24930 @subsubsection Blackholes
24931 @cindex spam filtering
24932 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24933 @cindex spam
24934
24935 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24936
24937 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24938 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24939 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24940 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24941 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24942 contains outdated servers.
24943
24944 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24945 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24946 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24947 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24948 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24949 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24950
24951 @end defvar
24952
24953 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24954
24955 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24956
24957 @end defvar
24958
24959 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24960
24961 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24962 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24963
24964 @end defvar
24965
24966 @defvar spam-use-dig
24967
24968 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24969 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24970
24971 @end defvar
24972
24973 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24974 ham processor for blackholes.
24975
24976 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24977 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24978 @cindex spam filtering
24979 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24980 @cindex spam
24981
24982 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24983
24984 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24985 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24986 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24987 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24988 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24989 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24990
24991 @end defvar
24992
24993 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24994
24995 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24996 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24997
24998 @end defvar
24999
25000 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25001
25002 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25003 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25004
25005 @end defvar
25006
25007 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25008 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25009
25010 @node Bogofilter
25011 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25012 @cindex spam filtering
25013 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25014 @cindex spam
25015
25016 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25017
25018 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25019 speedy Bogofilter.
25020
25021 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25022 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25023 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25024 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25025 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25026 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25027
25028 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25029 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25030 documentation.
25031
25032 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25033 processing will be turned off.
25034
25035 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25036
25037 @end defvar
25038
25039 @table @kbd
25040 @item M s t
25041 @itemx S t
25042 @kindex M s t
25043 @kindex S t
25044 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25045 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25046 @end table
25047
25048 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25049
25050 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25051 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25052 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25053 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25054 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25055 installation documents for details.
25056
25057 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25058
25059 @end defvar
25060
25061 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25062 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25063 customizing the group parameters or the
25064 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25065 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25066 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25067
25068 @emph{WARNING}
25069
25070 Instead of the obsolete
25071 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25072 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25073 the same way, we promise.
25074 @end defvar
25075
25076 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25077 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25078 customizing the group parameters or the
25079 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25080 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25081 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25082 of non-spam messages.
25083
25084 @emph{WARNING}
25085
25086 Instead of the obsolete
25087 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25088 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25089 the same way, we promise.
25090 @end defvar
25091
25092 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25093
25094 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25095 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25096 database directory.
25097
25098 @end defvar
25099
25100 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25101 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25102 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25103 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25104 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25105 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25106
25107 @node SpamAssassin back end
25108 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25109 @cindex spam filtering
25110 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25111 @cindex spam
25112
25113 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25114
25115 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25116
25117 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25118 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25119 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25120 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25121 mode.
25122
25123 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25124 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25125 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25126 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25127 instead.
25128
25129 You should not enable this if you use
25130 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25131
25132 @end defvar
25133
25134 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25135
25136 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25137 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25138
25139 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25140
25141 @end defvar
25142
25143 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25144
25145 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25146 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25147 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25148 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25149
25150 @end defvar
25151
25152 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25153 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25154 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25155 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25156 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25157 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25158 to test this functionality.
25159
25160 @node ifile spam filtering
25161 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25162 @cindex spam filtering
25163 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25164 @cindex spam
25165
25166 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25167
25168 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25169 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25170
25171 @end defvar
25172
25173 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25174
25175 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25176 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25177 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25178
25179 @end defvar
25180
25181 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25182
25183 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25184 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25185 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25186 @end defvar
25187
25188 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25189
25190 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25191 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25192
25193 @end defvar
25194
25195 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25196 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25197 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25198 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25199 functionality.
25200
25201 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25202 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25203 @cindex spam filtering
25204 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25205 @cindex spam-stat
25206 @cindex spam
25207
25208 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25209 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25210 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25211 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25212 spam-stat dictionary}.
25213
25214 @defvar spam-use-stat
25215
25216 @end defvar
25217
25218 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25219 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25220 customizing the group parameters or the
25221 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25222 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25223 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25224
25225 @emph{WARNING}
25226
25227 Instead of the obsolete
25228 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25229 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25230 the same way, we promise.
25231 @end defvar
25232
25233 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25234 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25235 customizing the group parameters or the
25236 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25237 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25238 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25239 of non-spam messages.
25240
25241 @emph{WARNING}
25242
25243 Instead of the obsolete
25244 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25245 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25246 the same way, we promise.
25247 @end defvar
25248
25249 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25250 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25251 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25252 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25253 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25254
25255 @node SpamOracle
25256 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25257 @cindex spam filtering
25258 @cindex SpamOracle
25259 @cindex spam
25260
25261 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25262 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25263 installed separately.
25264
25265 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25266 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25267 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25268 mail as a spam mail or not.
25269
25270 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25271 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25272 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25273
25274 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25275 call SpamOracle.
25276
25277 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25278 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25279 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25280 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25281 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25282 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25283 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25284 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25285
25286 @example
25287 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25288 spam-split-group "Junk"
25289 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25290 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25291 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25292 @end example
25293
25294 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25295 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25296 SpamOracle.
25297 @end defvar
25298
25299 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25300 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25301 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25302 can be customized.
25303 @end defvar
25304
25305 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25306 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25307 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25308 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25309 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25310 database to live somewhere special, set
25311 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25312 @end defvar
25313
25314 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25315 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25316 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25317 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25318 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25319 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25320 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25321 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25322 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25323 @xref{Spam Package}.
25324
25325 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25326 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25327 customizing the group parameter or the
25328 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25329 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25330 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25331
25332 @emph{WARNING}
25333
25334 Instead of the obsolete
25335 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25336 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25337 the same way, we promise.
25338 @end defvar
25339
25340 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25341 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25342 customizing the group parameter or the
25343 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25344 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25345 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25346 messages.
25347
25348 @emph{WARNING}
25349
25350 Instead of the obsolete
25351 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25352 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25353 the same way, we promise.
25354 @end defvar
25355
25356 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25357 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25358 messages.
25359 @example
25360 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25361 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25362 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25363 @end example
25364 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25365 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25366 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25367 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25368 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25369 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25370
25371 @node Extending the Spam package
25372 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25373 @cindex spam filtering
25374 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25375 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25376
25377 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25378 incoming mail, provide the following:
25379
25380 @enumerate
25381
25382 @item
25383 Code
25384
25385 @lisp
25386 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25387 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25388 @end lisp
25389
25390 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25391
25392 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25393 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25394 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25395 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25396 register/unregister spam and ham.
25397
25398 @item
25399 Functionality
25400
25401 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25402 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25403 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25404 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25405 why you aren't.
25406
25407 @end enumerate
25408
25409 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25410
25411 @enumerate
25412
25413 @item
25414 Code
25415
25416 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25417 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25418
25419 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25420 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25421 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25422 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25423
25424 @lisp
25425 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25426 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25427 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25428
25429 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25430 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25431 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25432
25433 @end lisp
25434
25435 @item
25436 Gnus parameters
25437
25438 Add
25439 @lisp
25440 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25441 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25442 @end lisp
25443 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25444 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25445 variable customization.
25446
25447 Add
25448 @lisp
25449 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25450 @end lisp
25451 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25452 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25453
25454 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25455 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25456
25457
25458 @enumerate
25459
25460 @item
25461 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25462
25463 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25464 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25465 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25466
25467 @item
25468 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25469
25470 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25471 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25472 such a back end.
25473
25474 @item
25475 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25476
25477 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25478 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25479 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25480 back ends.
25481
25482 @item
25483 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25484
25485 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25486 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25487 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25488
25489 @item
25490 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25491
25492 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25493 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25494 set up this way.
25495
25496 @item
25497 @code{spam-install-backend}
25498
25499 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25500 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25501 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25502
25503 @item
25504 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25505
25506 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25507 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25508 never install such a back end.
25509 @end enumerate
25510
25511 @end enumerate
25512
25513 @node Spam Statistics Package
25514 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25515 @cindex Paul Graham
25516 @cindex Graham, Paul
25517 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25518 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25519 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25520
25521 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25522 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25523 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25524 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25525 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25526 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25527 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25528 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25529 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25530 or not.
25531
25532 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25533 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25534 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25535 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25536 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25537 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25538 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25539 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25540
25541 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25542 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25543 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25544
25545 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25546 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25547 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25548 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25549 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25550
25551 @menu
25552 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25553 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25554 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25555 @end menu
25556
25557 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25558 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25559
25560 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25561 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25562 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25563 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25564 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25565
25566 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25567 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25568 per mail. Use the following:
25569
25570 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25571 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25572 is treated as one spam mail.
25573 @end defun
25574
25575 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25576 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25577 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25578 @end defun
25579
25580 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25581 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25582 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25583 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25584 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25585 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25586
25587 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25588 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25589 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25590 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25591 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25592
25593 @defvar spam-stat
25594 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25595 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25596 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25597 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25598 @end defvar
25599
25600 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25601 reset the dictionary.
25602
25603 @defun spam-stat-reset
25604 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25605 @end defun
25606
25607 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25608 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25609 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25610 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25611 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25612 only non-spam mails.
25613
25614 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25615 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25616 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25617 @end defun
25618
25619 @defun spam-stat-save
25620 Save the dictionary.
25621 @end defun
25622
25623 @defvar spam-stat-file
25624 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25625 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25626 @end defvar
25627
25628 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25629 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25630
25631 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25632 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25633
25634 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25635
25636 @lisp
25637 (require 'spam-stat)
25638 (spam-stat-load)
25639 @end lisp
25640
25641 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25642 created.
25643
25644 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25645 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25646 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25647 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25648
25649 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25650 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25651 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25652 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25653
25654 @lisp
25655 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25656 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25657 "mail.misc"))
25658 @end lisp
25659
25660 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25661 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25662 @end defvar
25663
25664 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25665 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25666 expression are considered potential spam.
25667
25668 @lisp
25669 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25670 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25671 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25672 "mail.misc"))
25673 @end lisp
25674
25675 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25676 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25677 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25678 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25679 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25680
25681 @lisp
25682 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25683 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25684 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25685 "mail.misc"))
25686 @end lisp
25687
25688 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25689 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25690 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25691 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25692 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25693 dictionary!
25694
25695 @lisp
25696 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25697 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25698 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25699 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25700 "mail.misc"))
25701 @end lisp
25702
25703
25704 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25705 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25706
25707 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25708
25709 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25710 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25711 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25712 @end defun
25713
25714 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25715 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25716 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25717 @end defun
25718
25719 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25720 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25721 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25722 already been processed as non-spam.
25723 @end defun
25724
25725 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25726 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25727 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25728 been processed as spam.
25729 @end defun
25730
25731 @defun spam-stat-save
25732 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25733 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25734 @end defun
25735
25736 @defun spam-stat-load
25737 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25738 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25739 @end defun
25740
25741 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25742 Return the spam score for a word.
25743 @end defun
25744
25745 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25746 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25747 @end defun
25748
25749 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25750 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25751 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25752 @end defun
25753
25754 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25755 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25756
25757 @lisp
25758 (require 'spam-stat)
25759 (spam-stat-load)
25760 @end lisp
25761
25762 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25763
25764 @smallexample
25765 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25766 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25767 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25768 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25769 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25770 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25771 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25772 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25773 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25774 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25775 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25776 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25777 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25778 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25779 @end smallexample
25780
25781 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25782
25783 @smallexample
25784 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25785 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25786 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25787 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25788 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25789 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25790 @end smallexample
25791
25792 @node The Gnus Registry
25793 @section The Gnus Registry
25794 @cindex registry
25795 @cindex split
25796 @cindex track
25797
25798 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25799 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25800 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25801 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25802 features are pretty cool.
25803
25804 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25805 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25806
25807 @enumerate
25808 @item
25809 Split messages to their parent
25810
25811 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25812 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25813 available.
25814
25815 @item
25816 Refer to messages by ID
25817
25818 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25819 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25820 of the group the message is in.
25821
25822 @item
25823 Store custom flags and keywords
25824
25825 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25826 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25827 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25828 etc. backends.
25829
25830 @item
25831 Store arbitrary data
25832
25833 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25834 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25835 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25836 @end enumerate
25837
25838 @menu
25839 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25840 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25841 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25842 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25843 * Store arbitrary data::
25844 @end menu
25845
25846 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25847 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25848
25849 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25850
25851 @lisp
25852 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25853
25854 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25855 @end lisp
25856
25857 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25858 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25859 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.) so
25860 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25861 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25862
25863 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25864 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25865
25866 @lisp
25867 (setq
25868 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25869 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25870 ("nnrss" t)
25871 ("spam" t)
25872 ("train" t))
25873 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25874 ;; this is the default
25875 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25876 @end lisp
25877
25878 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25879 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25880 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25881 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25882 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25883 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25884
25885 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25886 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25887 the general settings.
25888
25889 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25890 The groups that will not be followed by
25891 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25892 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25893 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25894 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25895 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25896 @end defvar
25897
25898 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25899 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25900 registry will keep.
25901 @end defvar
25902
25903 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25904 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25905 the registry will keep after pruning.
25906 @end defvar
25907
25908 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25909 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25910 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25911 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25912 @end defvar
25913
25914 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25915 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25916
25917 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25918 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25919 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25920 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25921
25922 @vindex nnregistry
25923 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25924
25925 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25926 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25927 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25928 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25929 lines:
25930
25931 @example
25932 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25933 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25934 ;; knows where the article is.
25935 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25936
25937 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25938
25939 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25940 '(current
25941 (nnregistry)
25942 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25943 @end example
25944
25945 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25946 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25947 all else fails, using Gmane.
25948
25949 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25950 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25951
25952 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25953
25954 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25955 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25956 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25957 strategy.
25958
25959 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25960 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25961 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25962 have to put a rule like this:
25963
25964 @lisp
25965 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25966
25967 ;; split to parent: you need this
25968 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25969
25970 ;; other rules, as an example
25971 (: spam-split)
25972 ;; default mailbox
25973 "mail")
25974 @end lisp
25975
25976 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
25977 following variables.
25978
25979 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
25980 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
25981 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
25982 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
25983 people don't stick to the same groups.
25984 @end defvar
25985
25986 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
25987 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
25988 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
25989 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
25990 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
25991 works best.
25992 @end defvar
25993
25994 @node Store custom flags and keywords
25995 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
25996
25997 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
25998 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
25999 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26000
26001 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26002 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26003 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26004 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26005 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26006 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26007
26008 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26009 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26010 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26011 letter.
26012 @end defvar
26013
26014 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26015 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26016 will offer the available marks for completion.
26017 @end defun
26018
26019 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26020 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26021 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26022 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26023
26024 @lisp
26025 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26026 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26027 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26028
26029 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26030 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26031 @end lisp
26032
26033
26034 @node Store arbitrary data
26035 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26036
26037 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26038 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26039 storage).
26040
26041 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26042 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26043 @end defun
26044
26045 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26046 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26047 @end defun
26048
26049 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26050 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26051 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26052 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26053 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26054 precious.
26055 @end defvar
26056
26057 @node Other modes
26058 @section Interaction with other modes
26059
26060 @subsection Dired
26061 @cindex dired
26062
26063 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26064 buffers. It is enabled with
26065 @lisp
26066 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26067 @end lisp
26068
26069 @table @kbd
26070 @item C-c C-m C-a
26071 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26072 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26073 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26074 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26075
26076 @item C-c C-m C-l
26077 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26078 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26079 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26080 buffer.
26081
26082 @item C-c C-m C-p
26083 @findex gnus-dired-print
26084 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26085 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26086 @end table
26087
26088 @node Various Various
26089 @section Various Various
26090 @cindex mode lines
26091 @cindex highlights
26092
26093 @table @code
26094
26095 @item gnus-home-directory
26096 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26097 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26098 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26099
26100 @item gnus-directory
26101 @vindex gnus-directory
26102 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26103 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26104 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26105
26106 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26107 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26108 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26109 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26110
26111 @item gnus-default-directory
26112 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26113 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26114 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26115 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26116 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26117 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26118 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26119
26120 @item gnus-verbose
26121 @vindex gnus-verbose
26122 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26123 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26124 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26125 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26126 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26127
26128 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26129 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26130 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26131 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26132
26133 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26134 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26135 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26136 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26137 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26138 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26139 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26140 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26141 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26142 displayed in the echo area.
26143
26144 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26145 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26146 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26147 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26148 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26149 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26150 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26151 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26152 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26153 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26154
26155 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26156 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26157 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26158 read when doing the operation described above.
26159
26160 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26161 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26162 @cindex file names
26163 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26164 @cindex characters in file names
26165 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26166 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26167 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26168
26169 @lisp
26170 @group
26171 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26172 '((?: . ?_)))
26173 @end group
26174 @end lisp
26175
26176 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26177 Windows (phooey) systems.
26178
26179 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26180 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26181 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26182 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26183 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26184
26185 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26186 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26187 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26188 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26189 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26190
26191 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26192 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26193 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26194
26195 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26196 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26197
26198 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26199 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26200 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26201 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26202 group).
26203
26204 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26205
26206 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26207 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26208 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26209 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26210 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26211 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26212 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26213 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26214 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26215
26216 @end table
26217
26218 @node The End
26219 @chapter The End
26220
26221 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26222 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26223
26224 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26225
26226 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26227
26228 @quotation
26229 @strong{Te Deum}
26230
26231 @sp 1
26232 Not because of victories @*
26233 I sing,@*
26234 having none,@*
26235 but for the common sunshine,@*
26236 the breeze,@*
26237 the largess of the spring.
26238
26239 @sp 1
26240 Not for victory@*
26241 but for the day's work done@*
26242 as well as I was able;@*
26243 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26244 but at the common table.@*
26245 @end quotation
26246
26247
26248 @node Appendices
26249 @chapter Appendices
26250
26251 @menu
26252 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26253 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26254 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26255 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26256 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26257 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26258 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26259 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26260 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26261 @end menu
26262
26263
26264 @node XEmacs
26265 @section XEmacs
26266 @cindex XEmacs
26267 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26268
26269 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26270 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26271 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26272 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26273 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26274 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26275
26276
26277 @node History
26278 @section History
26279
26280 @cindex history
26281 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26282 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26283
26284 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26285 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26286 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26287 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26288 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26289
26290 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26291 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26292 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26293 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26294 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26295 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26296
26297 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26298 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26299 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26300 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26301
26302 @menu
26303 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26304 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26305 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26306 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26307 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26308 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26309 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26310 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26311 @end menu
26312
26313
26314 @node Gnus Versions
26315 @subsection Gnus Versions
26316 @cindex ding Gnus
26317 @cindex September Gnus
26318 @cindex Red Gnus
26319 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26320 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26321 @cindex Oort Gnus
26322 @cindex No Gnus
26323 @cindex Ma Gnus
26324 @cindex Gnus versions
26325
26326 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26327 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26328 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26329
26330 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26331 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26332
26333 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26334 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26335
26336 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26337 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26338
26339 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26340 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26341 1999.
26342
26343 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26344 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26345
26346 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26347
26348 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26349 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26350 with the information when possible).
26351
26352 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26353
26354 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26355 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26356 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26357 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26358 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26359 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26360 that instead.
26361
26362
26363 @node Why?
26364 @subsection Why?
26365
26366 What's the point of Gnus?
26367
26368 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26369 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26370 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26371 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26372 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26373 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26374 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26375 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26376 keep track of millions of people who post?
26377
26378 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26379 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26380 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26381 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26382 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26383 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26384 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26385 every one of you to explore and invent.
26386
26387 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26388 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26389
26390
26391 @node Compatibility
26392 @subsection Compatibility
26393
26394 @cindex compatibility
26395 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26396 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26397 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26398
26399 Our motto is:
26400 @quotation
26401 @cartouche
26402 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26403 @end cartouche
26404 @end quotation
26405
26406 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26407 their names.
26408
26409 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26410 Articles}.
26411
26412 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26413 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26414 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26415 important variables have their values copied into their global
26416 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26417 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26418
26419 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26420 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26421 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26422 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26423 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26424 peculiar results.
26425
26426 @cindex hilit19
26427 @cindex highlighting
26428 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26429 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26430 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26431 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26432 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26433 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26434 Away!
26435
26436 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26437 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26438 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26439 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26440
26441 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26442 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26443 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26444 to stop doing it the old way.
26445
26446 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26447
26448 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26449 @findex gnus-bug
26450 @cindex reporting bugs
26451 @cindex bugs
26452 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26453 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26454 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26455
26456 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26457 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26458 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26459 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26460 up at you.
26461
26462
26463 @node Conformity
26464 @subsection Conformity
26465
26466 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26467 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26468 with, of course.
26469
26470 @table @strong
26471
26472 @item RFC (2)822
26473 @cindex RFC 822
26474 @cindex RFC 2822
26475 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26476
26477 @item RFC 1036
26478 @cindex RFC 1036
26479 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26480
26481 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26482 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26483 We do have some breaches to this one.
26484
26485 @table @emph
26486
26487 @item X-Newsreader
26488 @itemx User-Agent
26489 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26490 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26491 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26492 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26493 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26494 @end table
26495
26496 @item USEFOR
26497 @cindex USEFOR
26498 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26499 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26500 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26501 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26502
26503 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26504 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26505 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26506
26507 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26508 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26509
26510 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26511 @cindex RFC 1991
26512 @cindex RFC 2440
26513 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26514 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26515 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26516 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26517 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26518 decryption).
26519
26520 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26521 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26522 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26523 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26524
26525 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26526 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26527
26528 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26529 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26530 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26531 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26532 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26533 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26534 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26535 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26536
26537 @end table
26538
26539 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26540 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26541 know.
26542
26543
26544 @node Emacsen
26545 @subsection Emacsen
26546 @cindex Emacsen
26547 @cindex XEmacs
26548 @cindex Mule
26549 @cindex Emacs
26550
26551 This version of Gnus should work on:
26552
26553 @itemize @bullet
26554
26555 @item
26556 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26557
26558 @item
26559 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26560
26561 @end itemize
26562
26563 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26564 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26565 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26566 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26567
26568 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26569 @c synced here!
26570
26571 @node Gnus Development
26572 @subsection Gnus Development
26573
26574 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26575 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26576 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26577 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26578 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26579 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26580 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26581 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26582
26583 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26584 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26585 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26586 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26587 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26588 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26589 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26590 in Emacs.
26591
26592 @cindex Incoming*
26593 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26594 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26595 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26596 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26597 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26598
26599 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26600 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26601 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26602 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26603 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26604 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26605 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26606 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26607 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26608 can't be assumed to do so.
26609
26610 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26611 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26612 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26613
26614 @cindex Incoming*
26615 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26616 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26617 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26618 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26619 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26620
26621 @node Contributors
26622 @subsection Contributors
26623 @cindex contributors
26624
26625 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26626 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26627 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26628 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26629 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26630 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26631 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26632 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26633 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26634 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26635
26636 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26637 wrong show.
26638
26639 @itemize @bullet
26640
26641 @item
26642 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26643
26644 @item
26645 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26646 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26647 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26648 functionality and stuff.
26649
26650 @item
26651 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26652 well as numerous other things).
26653
26654 @item
26655 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26656
26657 @item
26658 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26659
26660 @item
26661 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26662
26663 @item
26664 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26665
26666 @item
26667 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26668 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26669
26670 @item
26671 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26672
26673 @item
26674 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26675
26676 @item
26677 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26678
26679 @item
26680 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26681
26682 @item
26683 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26684
26685 @item
26686 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26687
26688 @item
26689 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26690 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26691
26692 @item
26693 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26694
26695 @item
26696 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26697
26698 @item
26699 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26700
26701 @item
26702 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26703 .newsrc files.
26704
26705 @item
26706 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26707
26708 @item
26709 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26710
26711 @item
26712 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26713
26714 @item
26715 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26716 well as autoconf support.
26717
26718 @end itemize
26719
26720 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26721 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26722
26723 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26724
26725 Christopher Davis,
26726 Andrew Eskilsson,
26727 Kai Grossjohann,
26728 Kevin Greiner,
26729 Jesper Harder,
26730 Paul Jarc,
26731 Simon Josefsson,
26732 David K@aa{}gedal,
26733 Richard Pieri,
26734 Fabrice Popineau,
26735 Daniel Quinlan,
26736 Michael Shields,
26737 Reiner Steib,
26738 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26739 Jack Vinson,
26740 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26741 and
26742 Teodor Zlatanov.
26743
26744 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26745
26746 Jari Aalto,
26747 Adrian Aichner,
26748 Vladimir Alexiev,
26749 Russ Allbery,
26750 Peter Arius,
26751 Matt Armstrong,
26752 Marc Auslander,
26753 Miles Bader,
26754 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26755 Frank Bennett,
26756 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26757 Chris Bone,
26758 Mark Borges,
26759 Mark Boyns,
26760 Lance A. Brown,
26761 Rob Browning,
26762 Kees de Bruin,
26763 Martin Buchholz,
26764 Joe Buehler,
26765 Kevin Buhr,
26766 Alastair Burt,
26767 Joao Cachopo,
26768 Zlatko Calusic,
26769 Massimo Campostrini,
26770 Castor,
26771 David Charlap,
26772 Dan Christensen,
26773 Kevin Christian,
26774 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26775 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26776 Laura Conrad,
26777 Michael R. Cook,
26778 Glenn Coombs,
26779 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26780 Neil Crellin,
26781 Frank D. Cringle,
26782 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26783 Andre Deparade,
26784 Ulrik Dickow,
26785 Dave Disser,
26786 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26787 Joev Dubach,
26788 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26789 Dave Edmondson,
26790 Paul Eggert,
26791 Mark W. Eichin,
26792 Karl Eichwalder,
26793 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26794 Michael Ernst,
26795 Luc Van Eycken,
26796 Sam Falkner,
26797 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26798 Sigbjorn Finne,
26799 Sven Fischer,
26800 Paul Fisher,
26801 Decklin Foster,
26802 Gary D. Foster,
26803 Paul Franklin,
26804 Guy Geens,
26805 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26806 David S. Goldberg,
26807 Michelangelo Grigni,
26808 Dale Hagglund,
26809 D. Hall,
26810 Magnus Hammerin,
26811 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26812 Raja R. Harinath,
26813 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26814 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26815 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26816 Scott Hofmann,
26817 Tassilo Horn,
26818 Marc Horowitz,
26819 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26820 Richard Hoskins,
26821 Brad Howes,
26822 Miguel de Icaza,
26823 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26824 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26825 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26826 Lee Iverson,
26827 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26828 Rajappa Iyer,
26829 Andreas Jaeger,
26830 Adam P. Jenkins,
26831 Randell Jesup,
26832 Fred Johansen,
26833 Gareth Jones,
26834 Greg Klanderman,
26835 Karl Kleinpaste,
26836 Michael Klingbeil,
26837 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26838 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26839 Petr Konecny,
26840 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26841 Thor Kristoffersen,
26842 Jens Lautenbacher,
26843 Martin Larose,
26844 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26845 Joerg Lenneis,
26846 Carsten Leonhardt,
26847 James LewisMoss,
26848 Christian Limpach,
26849 Markus Linnala,
26850 Dave Love,
26851 Mike McEwan,
26852 Tonny Madsen,
26853 Shlomo Mahlab,
26854 Nat Makarevitch,
26855 Istvan Marko,
26856 David Martin,
26857 Jason R. Mastaler,
26858 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26859 Timo Metzemakers,
26860 Richard Mlynarik,
26861 Lantz Moore,
26862 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26863 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26864 Hrvoje Niksic,
26865 Andy Norman,
26866 Fred Oberhauser,
26867 C. R. Oldham,
26868 Alexandre Oliva,
26869 Ken Olstad,
26870 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26871 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26872 Ettore Perazzoli,
26873 William Perry,
26874 Stephen Peters,
26875 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26876 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26877 Matt Pharr,
26878 Andy Piper,
26879 John McClary Prevost,
26880 Bill Pringlemeir,
26881 Mike Pullen,
26882 Jim Radford,
26883 Colin Rafferty,
26884 Lasse Rasinen,
26885 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26886 Joe Reiss,
26887 Renaud Rioboo,
26888 Roland B. Roberts,
26889 Bart Robinson,
26890 Christian von Roques,
26891 Markus Rost,
26892 Jason Rumney,
26893 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26894 Jay Sachs,
26895 Dewey M. Sasser,
26896 Conrad Sauerwald,
26897 Loren Schall,
26898 Dan Schmidt,
26899 Ralph Schleicher,
26900 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26901 Andreas Schwab,
26902 Randal L. Schwartz,
26903 Danny Siu,
26904 Matt Simmons,
26905 Paul D. Smith,
26906 Jeff Sparkes,
26907 Toby Speight,
26908 Michael Sperber,
26909 Darren Stalder,
26910 Richard Stallman,
26911 Greg Stark,
26912 Sam Steingold,
26913 Paul Stevenson,
26914 Jonas Steverud,
26915 Paul Stodghill,
26916 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26917 Kurt Swanson,
26918 Samuel Tardieu,
26919 Teddy,
26920 Chuck Thompson,
26921 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26922 Philippe Troin,
26923 James Troup,
26924 Trung Tran-Duc,
26925 Jack Twilley,
26926 Aaron M. Ucko,
26927 Aki Vehtari,
26928 Didier Verna,
26929 Vladimir Volovich,
26930 Jan Vroonhof,
26931 Stefan Waldherr,
26932 Pete Ware,
26933 Barry A. Warsaw,
26934 Christoph Wedler,
26935 Joe Wells,
26936 Lee Willis,
26937 and
26938 Lloyd Zusman.
26939
26940
26941 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26942 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26943 (550kB and counting).
26944
26945 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26946 sure.
26947
26948 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26949 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26950
26951
26952 @node New Features
26953 @subsection New Features
26954 @cindex new features
26955
26956 @menu
26957 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26958 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26959 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26960 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26961 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26962 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26963 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26964 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26965 @end menu
26966
26967 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26968 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26969 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26970
26971 @node ding Gnus
26972 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26973
26974 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26975
26976 @itemize @bullet
26977
26978 @item
26979 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
26980 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
26981
26982 @item
26983 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
26984 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
26985
26986 @item
26987 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
26988
26989 @item
26990 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26991 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26992 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26993
26994 @item
26995 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26996 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26997 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26998 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26999
27000 @item
27001 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27002 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27003
27004 @item
27005 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27006 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27007 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27008
27009 @item
27010 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27011 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27012
27013 @item
27014 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27015 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27016 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27017
27018 @item
27019 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27020 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27021 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27022
27023 @item
27024 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27025 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27026
27027 @item
27028 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27029 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27030
27031 @item
27032 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27033 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27034
27035 @item
27036 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27037 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27038
27039 @item
27040 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27041 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27042
27043 @item
27044 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27045
27046 @item
27047 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27048 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27049
27050 @item
27051 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27052 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27053
27054 @item
27055 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27056 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27057
27058 @item
27059 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27060
27061 @item
27062 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27063 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27064
27065 @item
27066 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27067 Articles}).
27068
27069 @item
27070 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27071 Buttons}).
27072
27073 @item
27074 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27075 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27076
27077 @end itemize
27078
27079
27080 @node September Gnus
27081 @subsubsection September Gnus
27082
27083 @iftex
27084 @iflatex
27085 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27086 @end iflatex
27087 @end iftex
27088
27089 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27090
27091 @itemize @bullet
27092
27093 @item
27094 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27095 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27096 now obsolete.
27097
27098 @item
27099 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27100 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27101 Threading}).
27102
27103 @lisp
27104 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27105 @end lisp
27106
27107 @item
27108 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27109 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27110
27111 @item
27112 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27113 referred.
27114
27115 @item
27116 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27117
27118 @item
27119 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27120
27121 @item
27122 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27123
27124 @lisp
27125 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27126 @end lisp
27127
27128 @item
27129 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27130 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27131
27132 @lisp
27133 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27134 @end lisp
27135
27136 @item
27137 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27138 Groups}).
27139
27140 @item
27141 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27142 Topics}).
27143
27144 @lisp
27145 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27146 @end lisp
27147
27148 @item
27149 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27150
27151 @item
27152 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27153 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27154
27155 @lisp
27156 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27157 @end lisp
27158
27159 @item
27160 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27161 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27162
27163 @item
27164 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27165
27166 @item
27167 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27168 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27169 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27170
27171 @item
27172 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27173
27174 @item
27175 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27176
27177 @item
27178 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27179 Groups}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27183 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27184
27185 @item
27186 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27187 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27188
27189 @item
27190 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27191 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27192
27193 @item
27194 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27195 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27196 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27197
27198 @item
27199 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27200 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27201
27202 @item
27203 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27204
27205 @item
27206 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27207
27208 @item
27209 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27210
27211 @item
27212 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27213
27214 @item
27215 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27216 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27217
27218 @item
27219 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27220 Layout}).
27221
27222 @item
27223 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27224 @iftex
27225 @iflatex
27226 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27227 @end iflatex
27228 @end iftex
27229
27230 @item
27231 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27232
27233 @lisp
27234 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27235 @end lisp
27236
27237 @item
27238 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27239
27240 @item
27241 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27242
27243 @item
27244 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27245 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27246
27247 @lisp
27248 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27249 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27250 @end lisp
27251
27252 @item
27253 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27254 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27255
27256 @lisp
27257 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27258 @end lisp
27259
27260 @item
27261 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27262 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27263
27264 @item
27265 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27266
27267 @item
27268 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27269 Articles}).
27270
27271 @lisp
27272 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27273 @end lisp
27274
27275 @item
27276 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27277 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27278
27279 @lisp
27280 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27281 @end lisp
27282
27283 @item
27284 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27285 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27286
27287 @item
27288 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27289 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27290
27291 @lisp
27292 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27293 @end lisp
27294
27295 @item
27296 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27297
27298 @item
27299 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27300
27301 @item
27302 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27303
27304 @end itemize
27305
27306
27307 @node Red Gnus
27308 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27309
27310 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27311
27312 @iftex
27313 @iflatex
27314 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27315 @end iflatex
27316 @end iftex
27317
27318 @itemize @bullet
27319
27320 @item
27321 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27322
27323 @item
27324 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27325 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27326
27327 @item
27328 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27329 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27330 Scoring}).
27331
27332 @item
27333 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27334 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27335
27336 @item
27337 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27338
27339 @item
27340 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27341 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27342
27343 @lisp
27344 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27345 @end lisp
27346
27347 @item
27348 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27349 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27350 been added.
27351
27352 @item
27353 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27354 Server Internals}).
27355
27356 @item
27357 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27358 Parameters}).
27359
27360 @item
27361 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27362
27363 @item
27364 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27365 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27366
27367 @item
27368 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27369 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27370 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27371
27372 @item
27373 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27374 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27375
27376 @item
27377 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27378 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27379
27380 @item
27381 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27382 (@pxref{Undo}).
27383
27384 @item
27385 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27386 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27387
27388 @item
27389 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27390 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27391
27392 @lisp
27393 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27394 @end lisp
27395
27396 @item
27397 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27398
27399 @lisp
27400 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27401 @end lisp
27402
27403 @item
27404 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27405 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27406
27407 @item
27408 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27409 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27410
27411 @item
27412 A new command for reading collections of documents
27413 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27414 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27415
27416 @item
27417 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27418 Marks}).
27419
27420 @item
27421 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27422 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27423
27424 @item
27425 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27426 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27427 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27428
27429 @item
27430 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27431 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27432 Sorting}).
27433
27434 @item
27435 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27436 Groups}).
27437
27438 @item
27439 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27440 Commands}).
27441 @iftex
27442 @iflatex
27443 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27444 @end iflatex
27445 @end iftex
27446
27447 @item
27448 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27449 Variables}).
27450
27451 @item
27452 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27453 Mail}).
27454
27455 @item
27456 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27457 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27458
27459 @item
27460 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27461
27462 @end itemize
27463
27464
27465 @node Quassia Gnus
27466 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27467
27468 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27469
27470 @itemize @bullet
27471
27472 @item
27473 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27474 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27475 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27476
27477 @item
27478 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27479 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27480 group, which is created automatically.
27481
27482 @item
27483 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27484 values.
27485
27486 @item
27487 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27488
27489 @item
27490 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27491 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27492
27493 @item
27494 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27495 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27496
27497 @item
27498 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27499
27500 @item
27501 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27502 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27503
27504 @item
27505 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27506
27507 @item
27508 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27509 details.
27510
27511 @item
27512 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27513 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27514
27515 @item
27516 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27517 control over simplification.
27518
27519 @item
27520 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27521
27522 @item
27523 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27524 limit.
27525
27526 @item
27527 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27528
27529 @item
27530 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27531
27532 @item
27533 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27534 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27535 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27536
27537 @item
27538 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27539 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27540
27541 @item
27542 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27543 text---@kbd{W d}.
27544
27545 @item
27546 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27547 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27548
27549 @item
27550 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27551 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27552
27553 @item
27554 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27555 has been added.
27556
27557 @item
27558 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27559
27560 @item
27561 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27562
27563 @item
27564 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27565 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27566
27567 @item
27568 A new function for citing in Message has been
27569 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27570
27571 @item
27572 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27573
27574 @item
27575 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27576 been added.
27577
27578 @item
27579 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27580 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27581
27582 @item
27583 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27584 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27585
27586 @item
27587 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27588
27589 @item
27590 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27591
27592 @end itemize
27593
27594 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27595 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27596
27597 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27598
27599 @itemize @bullet
27600
27601 @item
27602 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27603 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27604
27605 If you used procmail like in
27606
27607 @lisp
27608 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27609 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27610 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27611 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27612 @end lisp
27613
27614 this now has changed to
27615
27616 @lisp
27617 (setq mail-sources
27618 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27619 :suffix ".in")))
27620 @end lisp
27621
27622 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27623
27624 @item
27625 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27626 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27627
27628 @item
27629 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27630 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27631
27632 @item
27633 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27634 called to position point.
27635
27636 @item
27637 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27638 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27639
27640 @item
27641 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27642 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27643
27644 @item
27645 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27646 subtly different manner.
27647
27648 @item
27649 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27650 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27651 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27652
27653 @item
27654 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27655
27656 @end itemize
27657
27658 @node Oort Gnus
27659 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27660 @cindex Oort Gnus
27661
27662 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27663
27664 @itemize @bullet
27665
27666 @item Installation changes
27667 @c ***********************
27668
27669 @itemize @bullet
27670 @item
27671 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27672
27673 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27674 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27675 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27676 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27677 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27678 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27679 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27680 isn't save in general.
27681
27682 @item
27683 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27684 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27685 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27686 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27687 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27688 remove-installed-shadows}.
27689
27690 @item
27691 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27692
27693 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27694 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27695 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27696 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27697 the second parameter.
27698
27699 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27700 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27701 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27702 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27703 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27704 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27705 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27706 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27707 cycle used under Unix systems.
27708
27709 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27710 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27711
27712 @item
27713 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27714
27715 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27716 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27717 hierarchy.
27718
27719 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27720 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27721 @item
27722 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27723
27724 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27725 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27726 lisp directory into load-path.
27727
27728 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27729 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27730
27731 @end itemize
27732
27733 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27734 @c *****************************************
27735
27736 @itemize @bullet
27737
27738 @item
27739 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27740 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27741
27742 @item
27743 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27744
27745 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27746 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27747
27748 @item
27749 Improved anti-spam features.
27750
27751 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27752 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27753 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27754 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27755 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27756 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27757
27758 @item
27759 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27760
27761 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27762 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27763 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27764 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27765 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27766
27767 @end itemize
27768
27769 @item Changes in group mode
27770 @c ************************
27771
27772 @itemize @bullet
27773
27774 @item
27775 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27776 using @kbd{G M}.
27777
27778 @item
27779 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27780
27781 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27782 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27783
27784 @item
27785 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27786
27787 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27788 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27789 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27790 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27791 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27792 parameters, a'la:
27793 @lisp
27794 (setq gnus-parameters
27795 '(("mail\\..*"
27796 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27797 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27798 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27799 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27800 @end lisp
27801
27802 @item
27803 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27804
27805 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27806 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27807 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27808 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27809 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27810 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27811 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27812 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27813 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27814
27815 @item
27816 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27817
27818 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27819 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27820 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27821
27822 @item
27823 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27824 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27825
27826 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27827 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27828 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27829 @lisp
27830 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27831 @end lisp
27832
27833 @item
27834 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27835 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27836 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27837
27838 @end itemize
27839
27840 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27841 @c **************************************
27842
27843 @itemize @bullet
27844
27845 @item
27846 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27847 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27848 region if the region is active.
27849
27850 @item
27851 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27852 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27853
27854 @item
27855 Article Buttons
27856
27857 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27858 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27859 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27860 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27861
27862 @item
27863 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27864
27865 @item
27866 Picons
27867
27868 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27869 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27870
27871 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27872 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27873 @xref{Picons}.
27874
27875 @item
27876 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27877 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27878
27879 @item
27880 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27881
27882 @item
27883 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27884 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27885
27886 @item
27887 Warn about email replies to news
27888
27889 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27890 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27891 you.
27892
27893 @item
27894 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27895 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27896 built.
27897
27898 @item
27899 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27900 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27901
27902 @item
27903 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27904 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27905
27906 @item
27907 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27908 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27909
27910 @item
27911 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27912
27913 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27914 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27915 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27916 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27917 citations.
27918
27919 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27920 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27921 Outlook (Express) articles.
27922
27923 @item
27924 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27925
27926 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27927 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27928 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27929 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27930
27931 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27932 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27933 message cited below.
27934
27935 @item
27936 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
27937 Emacs too.
27938
27939 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27940 disable it.
27941
27942 @item
27943 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27944
27945 @item
27946 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27947 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27948
27949 @item
27950 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27951
27952 @item
27953 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27954
27955 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27956 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27957 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27958 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27959 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27960 groups.
27961
27962 @item
27963 Deleting of attachments.
27964
27965 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27966 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27967 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27968 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27969 that support editing.
27970
27971 @item
27972 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27973
27974 The default value is determined from the
27975 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27976 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27977 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27978
27979 @item
27980 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27981
27982 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27983 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27984 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27985
27986 @item
27987 Extended format specs.
27988
27989 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27990 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27991 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27992 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27993 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27994 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27995
27996 @item
27997 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27998 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27999
28000 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28001 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28002 out other articles.
28003
28004 @item
28005 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28006
28007 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28008 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28009 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28010 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28011
28012 @item
28013 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28014
28015 @end itemize
28016
28017 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28018 @c ****************************************************
28019
28020 @itemize @bullet
28021
28022 @item
28023 Delayed articles
28024
28025 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28026 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28027 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28028
28029 @item
28030 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28031 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28032
28033 @item
28034 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28035 Gcc articles as read.
28036
28037 @item
28038 Externalizing of attachments
28039
28040 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28041 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28042 local files as external parts.
28043
28044 @item
28045 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28046 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28047
28048 @item
28049 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28050
28051 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28052 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28053 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28054 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28055 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28056 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28057 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28058 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28059 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28060
28061 @item
28062 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28063
28064 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28065 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28066 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28067 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28068 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28069 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28070
28071 @item
28072 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28073 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28074 @code{nil}.
28075
28076 @item
28077 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28078
28079 @item
28080 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28081
28082 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28083 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28084 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28085 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28086 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28087 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28088 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28089 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28090 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28091 was inserted directly.
28092
28093 @item
28094 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28095
28096 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28097 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28098 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28099 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28100 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28101
28102 @item
28103 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28104
28105 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28106 @lisp
28107 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28108 'bbdb-complete-name)
28109 @end lisp
28110
28111 @item
28112 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28113
28114 Add a new format of match like
28115 @lisp
28116 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28117 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28118 @end lisp
28119 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28120 @lisp
28121 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28122 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28123 @end lisp
28124
28125 @item
28126 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28127
28128 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28129 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28130 need add those two headers too.
28131
28132 @item
28133 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28134 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28135 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28136 versions.
28137
28138 @item
28139 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28140 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28141 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28142 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28143 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28144
28145 @item
28146 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28147
28148 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28149
28150 @item
28151 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28152
28153 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28154 the valid values.
28155
28156 @item
28157 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28158
28159 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28160 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28161 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28162 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28163 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28164 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28165 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28166 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28167
28168 @item
28169 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28170 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28171
28172 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28173 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28174 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28175 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28176
28177 @item
28178 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28179 C-m}.
28180
28181 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28182 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28183
28184 @item
28185 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28186 @code{best}.
28187
28188 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28189 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28190 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28191 invalidate the digital signature.
28192
28193 @item
28194 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28195 decompressed when activated.
28196 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28197
28198 @item
28199 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28200
28201 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28202 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28203 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28204 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28205 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28206 controls this.
28207
28208 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28209 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28210 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28211 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28212
28213 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28214 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28215 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28216 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28217
28218 @end itemize
28219
28220 @item Changes in back ends
28221 @c ***********************
28222
28223 @itemize @bullet
28224 @item
28225 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28226
28227 @item
28228 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28229
28230 @item
28231 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28232
28233 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28234
28235 @item
28236 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28237
28238 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28239 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28240 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28241 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28242 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28243 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28244 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28245 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28246 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28247 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28248 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28249
28250 @end itemize
28251
28252 @item Appearance
28253 @c *************
28254
28255 @itemize @bullet
28256
28257 @item
28258 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28259 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28260
28261 @item
28262 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28263 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28264 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28265 message, Message Manual}).
28266
28267 @item
28268 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28269 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28270 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28271 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28272
28273 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28274 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28275 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28276 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28277 @end itemize
28278
28279
28280 @item Miscellaneous changes
28281 @c ************************
28282
28283 @itemize @bullet
28284
28285 @item
28286 @code{gnus-agent}
28287
28288 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28289 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28290 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28291 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28292 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28293 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28294 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28295 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28296 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28297 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28298 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28299 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28300 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28301 is not needed any more.
28302
28303 @item
28304 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28305
28306 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28307 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28308 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28309
28310 @item
28311 Dired integration
28312
28313 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28314 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28315 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28316 entry.
28317
28318 @item
28319 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28320
28321 @item
28322 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28323
28324 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28325
28326 @end itemize
28327
28328 @end itemize
28329
28330 @node No Gnus
28331 @subsubsection No Gnus
28332 @cindex No Gnus
28333
28334 New features in No Gnus:
28335 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28336
28337 @include gnus-news.texi
28338
28339 @node Ma Gnus
28340 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28341 @cindex Ma Gnus
28342
28343 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28344 Gnus.
28345
28346 New features in Ma Gnus:
28347
28348 @itemize @bullet
28349
28350 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28351 @c ****************************************************
28352
28353 @itemize @bullet
28354
28355 @item
28356 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28357 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28358 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28359 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28360
28361 @end itemize
28362
28363 @end itemize
28364
28365 @iftex
28366
28367 @page
28368 @node The Manual
28369 @section The Manual
28370 @cindex colophon
28371 @cindex manual
28372
28373 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28374 either @code{texi2dvi}
28375 @iflatex
28376 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28377 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28378 @end iflatex
28379 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28380
28381 The following conventions have been used:
28382
28383 @enumerate
28384
28385 @item
28386 This is a @samp{string}
28387
28388 @item
28389 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28390
28391 @item
28392 This is a @file{file}
28393
28394 @item
28395 This is a @code{symbol}
28396
28397 @end enumerate
28398
28399 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28400 mean:
28401
28402 @lisp
28403 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28404 @end lisp
28405
28406 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28407
28408 @lisp
28409 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28410 @end lisp
28411
28412 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28413 ever get them confused.
28414
28415 @iflatex
28416 @c @head
28417 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28418 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28419 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28420 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28421 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28422 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28423 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28424 @end iflatex
28425
28426 @end iftex
28427
28428
28429 @node On Writing Manuals
28430 @section On Writing Manuals
28431
28432 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28433 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28434 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28435 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28436 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28437 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28438 in hand.
28439
28440 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28441 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28442 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28443 started with Gnus.
28444
28445 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28446 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28447
28448
28449 @page
28450 @node Terminology
28451 @section Terminology
28452
28453 @cindex terminology
28454 @table @dfn
28455
28456 @item news
28457 @cindex news
28458 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28459 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28460 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28461 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28462 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28463
28464 @item mail
28465 @cindex mail
28466 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28467 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28468 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28469 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28470
28471 @item reply
28472 @cindex reply
28473 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28474
28475 @item follow up
28476 @cindex follow up
28477 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28478 are reading.
28479
28480 @item back end
28481 @cindex back end
28482 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28483 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28484 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28485 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28486 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28487 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28488 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28489 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28490 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28491 number 4711''.
28492
28493 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28494 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28495 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28496 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28497 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28498 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28499
28500 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28501 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28502 access the articles.
28503
28504 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28505 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28506 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28507 confusing.
28508
28509 @item native
28510 @cindex native
28511 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28512 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28513 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28514
28515 @item foreign
28516 @cindex foreign
28517 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28518 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28519 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28520 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28521
28522 @item secondary
28523 @cindex secondary
28524 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28525 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28526 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28527
28528 @item article
28529 @cindex article
28530 A message that has been posted as news.
28531
28532 @item mail message
28533 @cindex mail message
28534 A message that has been mailed.
28535
28536 @item message
28537 @cindex message
28538 A mail message or news article
28539
28540 @item head
28541 @cindex head
28542 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
28543 put.
28544
28545 @item body
28546 @cindex body
28547 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28548 body.
28549
28550 @item header
28551 @cindex header
28552 A line from the head of an article.
28553
28554 @item headers
28555 @cindex headers
28556 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28557 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28558
28559 @item @acronym{NOV}
28560 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28561 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28562 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28563 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28564 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28565 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28566
28567 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28568 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28569 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28570 normal @sc{head} format.
28571
28572 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28573 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28574 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28575 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28576 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28577 references, etc.
28578
28579 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28580 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28581 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28582 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28583 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28584 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28585 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28586
28587 @item level
28588 @cindex levels
28589 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28590 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28591 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28592 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28593 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28594 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28595
28596 @item killed groups
28597 @cindex killed groups
28598 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28599 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28600
28601 @item zombie groups
28602 @cindex zombie groups
28603 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28604
28605 @item active file
28606 @cindex active file
28607 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28608 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28609 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28610
28611 @item bogus groups
28612 @cindex bogus groups
28613 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28614 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28615 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28616
28617 @item activating
28618 @cindex activating groups
28619 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28620 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28621 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28622
28623 @item spool
28624 @cindex spool
28625 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28626 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28627 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28628
28629 @item server
28630 @cindex server
28631 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28632
28633 @item select method
28634 @cindex select method
28635 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28636 server settings.
28637
28638 @item virtual server
28639 @cindex virtual server
28640 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28641 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28642 whole is a virtual server.
28643
28644 @item washing
28645 @cindex washing
28646 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28647 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28648 original.
28649
28650 @item ephemeral groups
28651 @cindex ephemeral groups
28652 @cindex temporary groups
28653 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28654 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28655 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28656
28657 @item solid groups
28658 @cindex solid groups
28659 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28660 group buffer are solid groups.
28661
28662 @item sparse articles
28663 @cindex sparse articles
28664 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28665 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28666
28667 @item threading
28668 @cindex threading
28669 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28670 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28671
28672 @item root
28673 @cindex root
28674 @cindex thread root
28675 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28676 articles in the thread.
28677
28678 @item parent
28679 @cindex parent
28680 An article that has responses.
28681
28682 @item child
28683 @cindex child
28684 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28685
28686 @item digest
28687 @cindex digest
28688 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28689 specified by RFC 1153.
28690
28691 @item splitting
28692 @cindex splitting, terminology
28693 @cindex mail sorting
28694 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28695 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28696 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28697
28698 @end table
28699
28700
28701 @page
28702 @node Customization
28703 @section Customization
28704 @cindex general customization
28705
28706 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28707 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28708 for some quite common situations.
28709
28710 @menu
28711 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28712 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28713 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28714 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28715 @end menu
28716
28717
28718 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28719 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28720
28721 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28722 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28723 Gnus has to get from the server.
28724
28725 @table @code
28726
28727 @item gnus-read-active-file
28728 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28729 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28730 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28731 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28732 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28733
28734 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28735 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28736 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28737 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28738 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28739 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28740 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28741 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28742 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28743 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28744 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28745
28746 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28747 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28748 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28749 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28750 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28751 variables.
28752 @end table
28753
28754
28755 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28756 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28757
28758 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28759 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28760 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28761
28762 @table @code
28763
28764 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28765 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28766 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28767 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28768 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28769
28770 @item gnus-visible-headers
28771 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28772 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28773 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28774 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28775
28776 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28777 @lisp
28778 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28779 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28780 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28781 @end lisp
28782
28783 @item gnus-use-full-window
28784 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28785 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28786 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28787 want to read them anyway.
28788
28789 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28790 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28791 hidden initially.
28792
28793
28794 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28795 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28796 lines, which might save some time.
28797 @end table
28798
28799
28800 @node Little Disk Space
28801 @subsection Little Disk Space
28802 @cindex disk space
28803
28804 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28805 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28806
28807 @table @code
28808
28809 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28810 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28811 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28812 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28813 default.
28814
28815 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28816 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28817 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28818 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28819 default.
28820
28821 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28822 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28823 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28824 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28825 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28826
28827 @end table
28828
28829
28830 @node Slow Machine
28831 @subsection Slow Machine
28832 @cindex slow machine
28833
28834 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28835 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28836
28837 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28838 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28839
28840 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28841 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28842 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28843
28844
28845 @page
28846 @node Troubleshooting
28847 @section Troubleshooting
28848 @cindex troubleshooting
28849
28850 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28851 problems, really.
28852
28853 Ahem.
28854
28855 @enumerate
28856
28857 @item
28858 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28859
28860 @item
28861 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28862 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28863 Gnus will work.
28864
28865 @item
28866 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28867 like @c
28868 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28869 @c
28870 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28871 files lying around. Delete these.
28872
28873 @item
28874 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28875 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28876
28877 @item
28878 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28879 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28880 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28881 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28882 something like that.
28883 @end enumerate
28884
28885 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28886
28887 @cindex bugs
28888 @cindex reporting bugs
28889
28890 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28891 @findex gnus-bug
28892 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28893 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28894 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28895 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28896
28897 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28898 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28899 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28900 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28901 time.
28902
28903 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28904 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28905 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28906 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28907 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28908 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28909
28910 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28911 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28912 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28913 the bug report.
28914
28915 @cindex patches
28916 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28917 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28918
28919 @cindex edebug
28920 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28921 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28922 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28923 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28924 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28925 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28926 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28927 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28928 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28929 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28930 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28931 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28932 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28933 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28934
28935 @cindex elp
28936 @cindex profile
28937 @cindex slow
28938 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28939 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28940 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28941 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28942 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28943
28944 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
28945 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28946 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28947 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
28948 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28949 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28950 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28951 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28952 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28953 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28954 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28955 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28956 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28957 work perfectly.
28958
28959 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28960 @cindex ding mailing list
28961 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28962 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28963 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28964 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28965
28966
28967 @page
28968 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28969 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28970
28971 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28972 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28973 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28974 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28975 it.
28976
28977 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
28978 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
28979 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
28980 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
28981 and general methods of operation.
28982
28983 @menu
28984 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
28985 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
28986 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
28987 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
28988 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
28989 * Group Info:: The group info format.
28990 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
28991 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
28992 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
28993 @end menu
28994
28995
28996 @node Gnus Utility Functions
28997 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
28998 @cindex Gnus utility functions
28999 @cindex utility functions
29000 @cindex functions
29001 @cindex internal variables
29002
29003 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29004 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29005 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29006
29007 @table @code
29008
29009 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29010 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29011 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29012
29013 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29014 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29015 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29016
29017 @item gnus-group-real-name
29018 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29019 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29020 name.
29021
29022 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29023 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29024 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29025 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29026
29027 @item gnus-get-info
29028 @findex gnus-get-info
29029 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29030
29031 @item gnus-group-unread
29032 @findex gnus-group-unread
29033 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29034 unknown.
29035
29036 @item gnus-active
29037 @findex gnus-active
29038 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29039 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29040
29041 @item gnus-set-active
29042 @findex gnus-set-active
29043 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29044
29045 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29046 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29047 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29048 exit.
29049
29050 @item gnus-continuum-version
29051 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29052 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29053 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29054 versions.
29055
29056 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29057 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29058 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29059
29060 @item gnus-news-group-p
29061 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29062 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29063
29064 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29065 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29066 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29067
29068 @item gnus-server-to-method
29069 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29070 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29071
29072 @item gnus-server-equal
29073 @findex gnus-server-equal
29074 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29075 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29076 this function will consider them equal.
29077
29078 @item gnus-group-native-p
29079 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29080 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29081
29082 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29083 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29084 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29085
29086 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29087 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29088 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29089
29090 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29091 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29092 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29093 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29094 @var{group}.
29095
29096 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29097 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29098 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29099
29100 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29101 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29102 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29103
29104 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29105 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29106 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29107 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29108
29109 @lisp
29110 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29111 @result{} t
29112 @end lisp
29113
29114 @item gnus-read-method
29115 @findex gnus-read-method
29116 Prompts the user for a select method.
29117
29118 @end table
29119
29120
29121 @node Back End Interface
29122 @subsection Back End Interface
29123
29124 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29125 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29126 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29127 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29128 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29129 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29130
29131 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29132 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29133 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29134 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29135 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29136 been opened, the function should fail.
29137
29138 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29139 name. Take this example:
29140
29141 @lisp
29142 (nntp "odd-one"
29143 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29144 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29145 @end lisp
29146
29147 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29148 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29149
29150 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29151 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29152 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29153
29154 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29155 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29156 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29157
29158 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29159 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29160 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29161 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29162 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29163 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29164 return value.
29165
29166 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29167 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29168 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29169 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29170 more.
29171
29172 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29173 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29174 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29175 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29176 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29177 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29178 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29179 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29180 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29181 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29182
29183 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29184 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29185 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29186 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29187 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29188 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29189 of numbers as long as possible.
29190
29191 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29192 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29193 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29194
29195 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29196 @code{nnchoke}.
29197
29198 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29199
29200 @menu
29201 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29202 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29203 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29204 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29205 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29206 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29207 @end menu
29208
29209
29210 @node Required Back End Functions
29211 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29212
29213 @table @code
29214
29215 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29216
29217 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29218 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29219 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29220 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29221
29222 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29223 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29224 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29225 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29226
29227 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29228 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29229 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29230 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29231 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29232 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29233 number, do maximum fetches.
29234
29235 Here's an example HEAD:
29236
29237 @example
29238 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29239 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29240 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29241 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29242 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29243 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29244 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29245 Lines: 26
29246 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29247 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29248 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29249 .
29250 @end example
29251
29252 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29253 these in the data buffer.
29254
29255 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29256
29257 @example
29258 headers = *head
29259 head = error / valid-head
29260 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29261 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29262 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29263 header = <text> eol
29264 @end example
29265
29266 @cindex BNF
29267 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29268
29269 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29270 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29271 separated by tabs.
29272
29273 @example
29274 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29275 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29276 field = <text except TAB>
29277 @end example
29278
29279 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29280 @pxref{Headers}.
29281
29282
29283 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29284
29285 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29286 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29287
29288 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29289 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29290 server. In fact, it should do so.
29291
29292 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29293 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29294
29295
29296 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29297
29298 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29299 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29300 reason.
29301
29302 There should be no data returned.
29303
29304
29305 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29306
29307 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29308 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29309 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29310 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29311
29312 There should be no data returned.
29313
29314
29315 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29316
29317 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29318 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29319 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29320 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29321
29322 There should be no data returned.
29323
29324
29325 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29326
29327 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29328
29329 There should be no data returned.
29330
29331
29332 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29333
29334 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29335 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29336 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29337 it would be nice if that were possible.
29338
29339 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29340 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29341 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29342 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29343 into its article buffer.
29344
29345 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29346 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29347 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29348 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29349 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29350 on successful article retrieval.
29351
29352
29353 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29354
29355 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29356 making @var{group} the current group.
29357
29358 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29359 the current group.
29360
29361 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29362 structure.
29363
29364 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29365
29366 @example
29367 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29368 @end example
29369
29370 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29371 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29372 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29373 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29374 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29375 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29376 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29377 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29378 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29379 highest as 0.
29380
29381 @example
29382 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29383 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29384 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29385 @end example
29386
29387
29388 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29389
29390 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29391 a no-op on most back ends.
29392
29393 There should be no data returned.
29394
29395
29396 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29397
29398 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29399 @emph{all}.
29400
29401 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29402
29403 @example
29404 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29405 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29406 @end example
29407
29408 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29409 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29410 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29411 and the highest as 0.
29412
29413 @example
29414 active-file = *active-line
29415 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29416 name = <string>
29417 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29418 @end example
29419
29420 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29421 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29422 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29423
29424
29425 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29426
29427 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29428 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29429 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29430 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29431 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29432 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29433
29434 There should be no result data from this function.
29435
29436 @end table
29437
29438
29439 @node Optional Back End Functions
29440 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29441
29442 @table @code
29443
29444 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29445
29446 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29447 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29448 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29449
29450 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29451 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29452 former is in the same format as the data from
29453 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29454 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29455
29456 @example
29457 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29458 @end example
29459
29460
29461 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29462
29463 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29464 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29465 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29466 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29467 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29468 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29469 the network resources).
29470
29471 There should be no result data from this function.
29472
29473
29474 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29475
29476 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29477 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29478 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29479 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29480 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29481 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29482 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29483 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29484
29485 There should be no result data from this function.
29486
29487
29488 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29489
29490 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29491 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
29492 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29493 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29494 propagate the mark information to the server.
29495
29496 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29497
29498 @example
29499 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29500 @end example
29501
29502 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29503 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29504 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29505 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29506 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29507 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29508 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29509 itself to these.
29510
29511 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29512 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29513 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29514 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29515
29516 An example action list:
29517
29518 @example
29519 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29520 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29521 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29522 @end example
29523
29524 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29525 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29526
29527 There should be no result data from this function.
29528
29529 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29530
29531 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29532 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29533 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29534 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29535 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29536
29537 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29538 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29539 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29540 expirable.
29541
29542 There should be no result data from this function.
29543
29544
29545 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29546
29547 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29548 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29549 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29550 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29551 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29552 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29553 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29554 local if that's practical.
29555
29556 There should be no result data from this function.
29557
29558
29559 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29560
29561 The result data from this function should be a description of
29562 @var{group}.
29563
29564 @example
29565 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29566 name = <string>
29567 description = <text>
29568 @end example
29569
29570 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29571
29572 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29573 groups available on the server.
29574
29575 @example
29576 description-buffer = *description-line
29577 @end example
29578
29579
29580 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29581
29582 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29583 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29584 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29585 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29586 in the active buffer format.
29587
29588 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29589 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29590 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29591 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29592 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29593 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29594 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29595
29596
29597 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29598
29599 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29600
29601 There should be no return data.
29602
29603
29604 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29605
29606 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29607 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29608 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29609 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29610 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29611 they are.
29612
29613 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29614 able to delete.
29615
29616 There should be no result data returned.
29617
29618
29619 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29620
29621 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29622 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29623
29624 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29625 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29626 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29627 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29628 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29629 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29630
29631 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29632 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29633 optimizations.
29634
29635 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29636 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29637
29638 There should be no data returned.
29639
29640
29641 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29642
29643 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29644 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29645 this function in short order.
29646
29647 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29648 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29649
29650 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29651 article for that group.
29652
29653 There should be no data returned.
29654
29655
29656 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29657
29658 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29659 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29660
29661 There should be no data returned.
29662
29663
29664 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29665
29666 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29667 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29668 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29669
29670 There should be no data returned.
29671
29672
29673 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29674
29675 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29676 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29677
29678 There should be no data returned.
29679
29680 @end table
29681
29682
29683 @node Error Messaging
29684 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29685
29686 @findex nnheader-report
29687 @findex nnheader-get-report
29688 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29689 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29690 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29691 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29692 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29693 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29694
29695 @lisp
29696 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29697
29698 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29699 @end lisp
29700
29701 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29702 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29703 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29704 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29705
29706 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29707 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29708 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29709
29710
29711 @node Writing New Back Ends
29712 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29713
29714 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29715 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29716 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29717 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29718 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29719 editing articles.
29720
29721 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29722 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29723 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29724
29725 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29726 package called @code{nnoo}.
29727
29728 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29729 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29730 following macros:
29731
29732 @table @code
29733
29734 @item nnoo-declare
29735 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29736 parameters. For instance:
29737
29738 @lisp
29739 (nnoo-declare nndir
29740 nnml nnmh)
29741 @end lisp
29742
29743 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29744 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29745
29746 @item defvoo
29747 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29748 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29749 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29750
29751 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29752 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29753 a function in those back ends.
29754
29755 @lisp
29756 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29757 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29758 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29759 @end lisp
29760
29761 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29762 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29763 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29764
29765 @item nnoo-define-basics
29766 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29767 have.
29768
29769 @lisp
29770 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29771 @end lisp
29772
29773 @item deffoo
29774 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29775 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29776 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29777
29778 @item nnoo-map-functions
29779 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29780 functions from the parent back ends.
29781
29782 @lisp
29783 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29784 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29785 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29786 @end lisp
29787
29788 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29789 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29790 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29791 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29792
29793 @item nnoo-import
29794 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29795 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29796 haven't already been defined.
29797
29798 @lisp
29799 (nnoo-import nndir
29800 (nnmh
29801 nnmh-request-list
29802 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29803 (nnml))
29804 @end lisp
29805
29806 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29807 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29808 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29809 defined now.
29810
29811 @end table
29812
29813 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29814
29815 @lisp
29816 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29817 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29818
29819 ;;; @r{Code:}
29820
29821 (require 'nnheader)
29822 (require 'nnmh)
29823 (require 'nnml)
29824 (require 'nnoo)
29825 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29826
29827 (nnoo-declare nndir
29828 nnml nnmh)
29829
29830 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29831 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29832 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29833
29834 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29835 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29836 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29837
29838 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29839 nil
29840 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29841 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29842 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29843
29844 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29845 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29846
29847 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29848
29849 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29850
29851 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29852 (setq nndir-directory
29853 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29854 server))
29855 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29856 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29857 (push `(nndir-current-group
29858 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29859 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29860 defs)
29861 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29862 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29863 defs)
29864 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29865
29866 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29867 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29868 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29869 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29870 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29871
29872 (nnoo-import nndir
29873 (nnmh
29874 nnmh-status-message
29875 nnmh-request-list
29876 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29877
29878 (provide 'nndir)
29879 @end lisp
29880
29881
29882 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29883 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29884
29885 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29886 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29887 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29888 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29889 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29890
29891 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29892 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29893
29894 Here's an example:
29895
29896 @lisp
29897 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29898 @end lisp
29899
29900 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29901
29902 The abilities can be:
29903
29904 @table @code
29905 @item mail
29906 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29907 @item post
29908 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29909 @item post-mail
29910 This back end supports both mail and news.
29911 @item none
29912 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29913 different.
29914 @item respool
29915 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29916 articles and groups.
29917 @item address
29918 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29919 true for almost all back ends.
29920 @item prompt-address
29921 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29922 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29923 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29924 @end table
29925
29926
29927 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29928 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29929
29930 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29931 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29932 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29933 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29934
29935 @lisp
29936 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29937 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29938 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29939 @end lisp
29940
29941 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29942 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29943 mail.
29944
29945 This function takes four parameters.
29946
29947 @table @var
29948 @item method
29949 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29950 the call.
29951
29952 @item exit-function
29953 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29954
29955 @item temp-directory
29956 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29957
29958 @item group
29959 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29960 performed for one group only.
29961 @end table
29962
29963 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29964 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29965 find the article number assigned to this article.
29966
29967 The function also uses the following variables:
29968 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29969 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29970 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29971 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29972 this:
29973
29974 @example
29975 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29976 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
29977 @end example
29978
29979
29980 @node Score File Syntax
29981 @subsection Score File Syntax
29982
29983 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
29984 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
29985 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
29986
29987 Here's a typical score file:
29988
29989 @lisp
29990 (("summary"
29991 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
29992 ("Gnus"))
29993 ("from"
29994 ("Lars" -1000))
29995 (mark -100))
29996 @end lisp
29997
29998 BNF definition of a score file:
29999
30000 @example
30001 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30002 element = rule / atom
30003 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30004 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30005 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30006 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30007 quote = <ascii 34>
30008 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30009 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30010 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30011 date-header = "date"
30012 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30013 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30014 score = "nil" / <integer>
30015 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30016 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30017 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30018 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30019 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30020 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30021 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30022 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30023 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30024 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30025 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30026 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30027 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30028 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30029 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30030 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30031 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30032 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30033 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30034 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30035 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30036 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30037 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30038 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30039 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30040 eval = "eval" space <form>
30041 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30042 @end example
30043
30044 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30045 discarded.
30046
30047 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30048 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30049 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30050 one looong line, then that's ok.
30051
30052 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30053 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30054
30055
30056 @node Headers
30057 @subsection Headers
30058
30059 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30060 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30061 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30062 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30063
30064 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30065 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30066 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30067 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30068 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30069 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30070 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30071
30072 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30073 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30074 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30075 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30076 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30077
30078 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30079 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30080
30081
30082 @node Ranges
30083 @subsection Ranges
30084
30085 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30086 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30087
30088 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30089 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30090 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30091 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30092
30093 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30094 sequence.
30095
30096 @example
30097 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30098 @end example
30099
30100 is transformed into
30101
30102 @example
30103 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30104 @end example
30105
30106 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30107 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30108
30109 @example
30110 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30111 @end example
30112
30113 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30114 is slightly tricky:
30115
30116 @example
30117 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30118 @end example
30119
30120 and
30121
30122 @example
30123 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30124 @end example
30125
30126 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30127
30128 @example
30129 (1 2 3 4 5)
30130 @end example
30131
30132 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30133 also valid:
30134
30135 @example
30136 (1 . 5)
30137 @end example
30138
30139 and is equal to the previous range.
30140
30141 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30142 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30143 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30144 range handling.)
30145
30146 @example
30147 range = simple-range / normal-range
30148 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30149 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30150 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30151 number *[ " " contents ]
30152 @end example
30153
30154 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30155 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30156 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30157 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30158 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30159 sequences.)
30160
30161
30162 @node Group Info
30163 @subsection Group Info
30164
30165 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30166 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30167 describes the group.
30168
30169 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30170 second is a more complex one:
30171
30172 @example
30173 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30174
30175 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30176 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30177 (nnml "")
30178 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30179 @end example
30180
30181 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30182 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30183 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30184 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30185 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30186 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30187 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30188 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30189 this section is about.
30190
30191 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30192 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30193 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30194
30195 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30196
30197 @example
30198 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30199 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30200 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30201 group = quote <string> quote
30202 ralevel = rank / level
30203 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30204 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30205 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30206 read = range
30207 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30208 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30209 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30210 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30211 @end example
30212
30213 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30214 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30215 in pseudo-BNF.
30216
30217 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30218 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30219
30220 @table @code
30221 @item gnus-info-group
30222 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30223 @findex gnus-info-group
30224 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30225 Get/set the group name.
30226
30227 @item gnus-info-rank
30228 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30229 @findex gnus-info-rank
30230 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30231 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30232
30233 @item gnus-info-level
30234 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30235 @findex gnus-info-level
30236 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30237 Get/set the group level.
30238
30239 @item gnus-info-score
30240 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30241 @findex gnus-info-score
30242 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30243 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30244
30245 @item gnus-info-read
30246 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30247 @findex gnus-info-read
30248 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30249 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30250
30251 @item gnus-info-marks
30252 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30253 @findex gnus-info-marks
30254 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30255 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30256
30257 @item gnus-info-method
30258 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30259 @findex gnus-info-method
30260 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30261 Get/set the group select method.
30262
30263 @item gnus-info-params
30264 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30265 @findex gnus-info-params
30266 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30267 Get/set the group parameters.
30268 @end table
30269
30270 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30271 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30272
30273 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30274 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30275 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30276 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30277
30278
30279 @node Extended Interactive
30280 @subsection Extended Interactive
30281 @cindex interactive
30282 @findex gnus-interactive
30283
30284 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30285 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30286 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30287
30288 @lisp
30289 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30290 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30291 ...
30292 )
30293 @end lisp
30294
30295 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30296 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30297 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30298 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30299 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30300 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30301 @code{interactive}.
30302
30303 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30304 adds a few more.
30305
30306 @table @samp
30307 @item y
30308 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30309 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30310 variable.
30311
30312 @item Y
30313 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30314 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30315 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30316
30317 @item A
30318 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30319 function.
30320
30321 @item H
30322 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30323 function.
30324
30325 @item g
30326 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30327 function.
30328
30329 @end table
30330
30331
30332 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30333 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30334 @cindex XEmacs
30335 @cindex Emacsen
30336
30337 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30338 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30339 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30340
30341 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30342 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30343 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30344 Gnus, that's very useful.
30345
30346 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30347 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30348 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30349 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30350 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30351 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30352 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30353 following function:
30354
30355 @lisp
30356 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30357 (start-itimer
30358 "gnus-run-at-time"
30359 `(lambda ()
30360 (,function ,@@args))
30361 time repeat))
30362 @end lisp
30363
30364 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30365 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30366 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30367 all over.
30368
30369 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30370 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30371 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30372
30373 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30374 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30375 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30376
30377
30378 @node Various File Formats
30379 @subsection Various File Formats
30380
30381 @menu
30382 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30383 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30384 @end menu
30385
30386
30387 @node Active File Format
30388 @subsubsection Active File Format
30389
30390 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30391 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30392 in each group.
30393
30394 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30395
30396 @example
30397 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30398 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30399 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30400 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30401 no.general 1000 900 y
30402 @end example
30403
30404 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30405
30406 @example
30407 active = *group-line
30408 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30409 group = <non-white-space string>
30410 spc = " "
30411 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30412 low-number = <positive integer>
30413 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30414 @end example
30415
30416 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30417 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30418
30419
30420 @node Newsgroups File Format
30421 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30422
30423 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30424 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30425 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30426 the user.
30427
30428 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30429 Here's the definition:
30430
30431 @example
30432 newsgroups = *line
30433 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30434 group = <non-white-space string>
30435 tab = <TAB>
30436 description = <string>
30437 @end example
30438
30439
30440 @page
30441 @node Emacs for Heathens
30442 @section Emacs for Heathens
30443
30444 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30445 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30446 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30447 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30448 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30449 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30450 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30451 cat instead.
30452
30453 @menu
30454 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30455 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30456 @end menu
30457
30458
30459 @node Keystrokes
30460 @subsection Keystrokes
30461
30462 @itemize @bullet
30463 @item
30464 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30465
30466 @item
30467 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30468 @end itemize
30469
30470 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30471 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30472 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30473 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30474 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30475 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30476
30477 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30478 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30479 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30480 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30481 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30482 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30483 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30484
30485 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30486 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30487 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30488 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30489 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30490 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30491 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30492
30493 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30494 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30495 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30496 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30497 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30498 it.
30499
30500
30501
30502 @node Emacs Lisp
30503 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30504
30505 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30506 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30507 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30508 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30509
30510 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30511 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30512 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30513 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30514 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30515 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30516 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30517 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30518 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30519 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30520
30521 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30522 write the following:
30523
30524 @lisp
30525 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30526 @end lisp
30527
30528 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30529 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30530 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30531 change how Gnus works.
30532
30533 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30534 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30535 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30536 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30537 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30538
30539 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30540 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30541 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30542
30543 Some pitfalls:
30544
30545 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30546 that means:
30547
30548 @lisp
30549 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30550 @end lisp
30551
30552 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30553 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30554
30555 @lisp
30556 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30557 @end lisp
30558
30559 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30560 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30561
30562 @page
30563 @include gnus-faq.texi
30564
30565 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30566 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30567 @include doclicense.texi
30568
30569 @node Index
30570 @chapter Index
30571 @printindex cp
30572
30573 @node Key Index
30574 @chapter Key Index
30575 @printindex ky
30576
30577 @bye
30578
30579 @iftex
30580 @iflatex
30581 \end{document}
30582 @end iflatex
30583 @end iftex
30584
30585 @c Local Variables:
30586 @c mode: texinfo
30587 @c coding: utf-8
30588 @c End: